40519 A guide to The World Bank S E C O N D E D I T I O N A guide to TheWorld Bank A guide to TheWorld Bank S E C O N D E D I T I O N © 2007 The International Bank for Reconstruction and Development / The World Bank 1818 H Street NW Washington DC 20433 Telephone: 202-473-1000 Internet: www.worldbank.org E-mail: feedback@worldbank.org All rights reserved 1 2 3 4 5 11 10 09 08 07 This volume is a product of the staff of the International Bank for Reconstruction and Develop- ment / The World Bank. The findings, interpretations, and conclusions expressed in this volume do not necessarily reflect the views of the Executive Directors of The World Bank or the govern- ments they represent. The World Bank does not guarantee the accuracy of the data included in this work. The boundaries, colors, denominations, and other information shown on any map in this work do not imply any judgement on the part of The World Bank concerning the legal status of any ter- ritory or the endorsement or acceptance of such boundaries. Rights and Permissions The material in this publication is copyrighted. Copying and/or transmitting portions or all of this work without permission may be a violation of applicable law. The International Bank for Reconstruction and Development / The World Bank encourages dissemination of its work and will normally grant permission to reproduce portions of the work promptly. For permission to photocopy or reprint any part of this work, please send a request with com- plete information to the Copyright Clearance Center Inc., 222 Rosewood Drive, Danvers, MA 01923, USA; telephone: 978-750-8400; fax: 978-750-4470; Internet: www.copyright.com. All other queries on rights and licenses, including subsidiary rights, should be addressed to the Office of the Publisher, The World Bank, 1818 H Street NW, Washington, DC 20433, USA; fax: 202-522-2422; e-mail: pubrights@worldbank.org. ISBN-10: 0-8213-6694-7 (soft cover) ISBN-10: 0-8213-6718-8 (hard cover) ISBN-13: 978-0-8213-6694-3 (soft cover) ISBN-13: 978-0-8213-6718-6 (hard cover) eISBN-10: 0-8213-6695-5 eISBN-13: 978-0-8213-6695-0 DOI: 10.1596/978-0-8213-6694-3 Cover design: Rock Creek Creative Cover photos (clockwise from lower left): World Bank/Jim Pickerell; World Bank/Ami Vitale; World Bank/Gennadiy Ratushenko. Interior design and typesetting: Circle Graphics Interior photos: IFC/Rob Wright (page xiv); World Bank/Curt Carnemark (page xvi); World Bank/Simone McCourtie (page 6); World Bank/Thanit Thangpijaigul (page 44); IFC/courtesy of Embraer (page 138); World Bank/Bill Lyons (page 188). Library of Congress Cataloging-in-Publication Data Guide to the World Bank. -- 2nd ed. p. cm. Includes bibliographical references and index. ISBN 978-0-8213-6694-3 -- ISBN 978-0-8213-6695-0 (electronic) 1. World Bank Group. 2. Developing countries--Economic conditions 3. Economic assistance. I. World Bank. HG3881.5.W57G853 2007 332.1'532--dc22 2007019884 Contents Preface xi Acknowledgments xiii Abbreviations xv The World Bank Group Mission xvii Introduction 1 1How the World Bank Group Is Organized 7 Governance of the World Bank Group 7 The Five World Bank Group Institutions 11 Organizing Principles within the World Bank Group 27 Relationship to the IMF and the UN 40 2How the World Bank Group Operates 45 Strategies 46 Policies and Procedures 55 The Bank Group's Finances 59 Financial Products and Services 61 Knowledge Sharing 72 World Bank Project Cycle 76 IFC Project Cycle 82 Partnerships 84 Staff, Consultants, and Vendors 87 3World Bank Group Countries and Regions 93 Member Countries 94 Africa (Sub-Saharan) 103 East Asia and the Pacific 110 South Asia 115 v vi Contents Europe and Central Asia 121 Latin America and the Caribbean 127 Middle East and North Africa 133 4 Topics in Development 139 Agriculture and Rural Development 140 Aid Effectiveness 141 Combating Corruption 143 Conflict Prevention and Reconstruction 144 Debt Relief 145 Economic Research and Data 147 Education 149 Empowerment and Participation 152 Energy and Mining 153 Environment 155 Financial Sector 157 Gender 159 Globalization 160 Governance 161 Health, Nutrition, and Population 163 Indigenous Peoples 166 Information and Communication Technologies 167 Infrastructure 168 Labor and Social Protection 170 Law, Regulation, and the Judiciary 172 Manufacturing and Services 173 Poverty 174 Private Sector Development 176 Social Development 179 Sustainable Development 180 Trade 181 Transport 183 Urban Development 184 Water 185 A P P E N D I X E S A Contacting the World Bank Group 191 Headquarters and General Inquiries 191 Media Relations, News, and Public Affairs 192 Public Information 193 Contents vii B Timeline of World Bank Group History 195 C Presidents of the World Bank Group 203 D Country Membership in World Bank Group Institutions 205 E Constituencies of the Executive Directors 215 F Additional Country Resources 229 References 231 Index 233 Figures 1.1 Relationship Between Member Countries and the World Bank Group 8 1.2 Voting Power of the Largest Shareholders of IBRD 9 1.3 World Bank Organizational Structure 28 1.4 IFC Organizational Structure 30 1.5 MIGA Organizational Structure 32 2.1 Total IBRD-IDA Lending by Theme, Fiscal 2006 50 2.2 Total IBRD-IDA Lending by Sector, Fiscal 2006 50 2.3 IFC Investment Projects by Industry, Fiscal 2006 51 2.4 MIGA Guarantees Issued by Sector, Fiscal 2006. 51 2.5 World Bank Project Cycle 77 3.1 Total IBRD-IDA Lending by Region, Fiscal 2006 101 3.2 IFC Investment Projects by Region, Fiscal 2006 102 3.3 MIGA's Outstanding Portfolio Distribution by Host Region as of June 30, 2006 102 3.4 Africa: IBRD and IDA Lending by Theme, Fiscal 2006 106 3.5 Africa: IBRD and IDA Lending by Sector, Fiscal 2006 106 3.6 East Asia and the Pacific: IBRD and IDA Lending by Theme, Fiscal 2006 112 3.7 East Asia and the Pacific: IBRD and IDA Lending by Sector, Fiscal 2006 112 viii Contents 3.8 South Asia: IBRD and IDA Lending by Theme, Fiscal 2006 118 3.9 South Asia: IBRD and IDA Lending by Sector, Fiscal 2006 118 3.10 Europe and Central Asia: IBRD and IDA Lending by Theme, Fiscal 2006 124 3.11 Europe and Central Asia: IBRD and IDA Lending by Sector, Fiscal 2006 124 3.12 Latin America and the Caribbean: IBRD and IDA Lending by Theme, Fiscal 2006 130 3.13 Latin America and the Caribbean: IBRD and IDA Lending by Sector, Fiscal 2006 130 3.14 Middle East and North Africa: IBRD and IDA Lending by Theme, Fiscal 2006 135 3.15 Middle East and North Africa: IBRD and IDA Lending by Sector, Fiscal 2006 135 E.1 Voting Power of the Largest Shareholders of IBRD as of April 2007 216 E.2 Voting Power of the Largest Shareholders of IDA as of April 2007 219 E.3 Voting Power of the Largest Shareholders of IFC as of April 2007 222 E.4 Voting Power of the Largest Shareholders of MIGA as of April 2007 225 Tables 1.1 County Eligibility for Borrowing from the World Bank as of July 1, 2006 14 1.2 Cumulative IDA Subscriptions and Contributions 18 2.1 IBRD­IDA Cumulative Lending by Country/Region 62 D.1 Country Memberships and Voting Shares in Each Institution as of April 2007 206 E.1 Voting Shares of Executive Directors of IBRD as of April 2007 216 E.2 Voting Shares of Executive Directors of IDA as of April 2007 219 E.3 Voting Shares of Directors of IFC as of April 2007 222 E.4 Voting Shares of Directors of MIGA as of April 2007 225 Boxes 1 The Five World Bank Group Institutions 2 2 Millennium Development Goals 3 Contents ix 1.1 Origin of the Term "World Bank" 11 1.2 IBRD Basic Facts 13 1.3 IDA Basic Facts 17 1.4 IFC Basic Facts 20 1.5 MIGA Basic Facts 24 1.6 ICSID Basic Facts 25 2.1 Millennium Development Goals (MDGs) 47 2.2 Poverty Reduction Strategies: Key Steps 53 2.3 Reporting Fraud or Corruption 59 2.4 Financial Terms and Rates 67 2.5 Obtaining World Bank Group Publications 76 2.6 Web Links for Project Information, Disclosure, and Evaluation 81 3.1 Web Links for Country Membership Information 94 3.2 IBRD Graduates 97 3.3 Africa Fast Facts 104 3.4 East Asia and the Pacific Fast Facts 111 3.5 South Asia Fast Facts 116 3.6 Europe and Central Asia Fast Facts 122 3.7 Latin America and the Caribbean Fast Facts 128 3.8 Middle East and North Africa Fast Facts 134 4.1 Web Links for Data and Statistics 147 F.1 Regional Web Sites 230 Preface The World Bank Group is a vital source of financial and technical assistance to developing countries around the world. Our focus is on helping the poorest people in the poorest countries by using our financial resources, staff, and exten- sive experience to aid countries in reducing poverty, increasing economic growth, and improving quality of life. Our efforts in this regard are as diverse as the people and landscapes in which we work. In partnership with more than 100 developing countries, we are striving to improve health and education, fight corruption, boost agricultural support, build roads and ports, and protect the environment. Other projects are aimed at rebuilding war-torn countries or regions, providing basic services such as access to clean water, and encouraging investments that create jobs. In addition to this critical groundwork around the world, various parts of the World Bank Group are involved in activities ranging from conducting economic research and analysis to providing financial and advisory services to governments and private enterprises. These activities reflect the emphasis we place on sharing development knowledge, which is gleaned not only from our decades of experience but also from that of our 185 members--including both developing and developed countries. This completely revised and updated second edition of A Guide to the World Bank provides an accessible and straightforward overview of the World Bank Group's history, organization, mission, and purpose. Additionally, for those wish- ing to delve further into subjects of particular interest, the book guides readers to sources containing more detailed information, including annual reports, Web sites, publications, and e-mail addresses for various departments. It is my hope that this second edition continues to help build a better under- standing of the World Bank Group's work and awareness of the world's most crit- ical challenge: putting an end to global poverty. Marwan Muasher Senior Vice President External Affairs The World Bank xi Acknowledgments The first edition of A Guide to the World Bank--published in 2003--was con- ceived and edited by Paul McClure. This second edition was produced by a team led by Stephen McGroarty. Caroline Banton was indispensable in researching, fact checking, and writing. Alice Faintich applied her superb editing skills to the man- uscript. Cindy Fisher expertly managed the design and editorial production of the book. And Nora Ridolfi adeptly coordinated the printing process. The book also benefited greatly from the advice and feedback of the following people: Anita Ahmed, Timothy T. Carrington, John Didier, Francis Dobbs, Pernille Falck, Alexander Ferguson, Melissa Fossberg, Nicole Frost, Nadine Shamounki Ghannam, Leroy Grassley, Declan Heery, Jung Lim Kim, Natalia Kirpikova, Johanna Martinson, Katherine Marshall, Paul McClure, Roger Morier, Merrell Tuck-Primdahl, Catherine M. Russell, Estela T. Sanidad, Elena Serrano, Abigail Tamakloe, and Filippo Zanzi. Many people in the Bank's Office of the Publisher contributed to or provided assistance to this project. Thanks go to Jose de Buerba, Valentina Kalk, Patricia Katayama, Kathryn Matthews, Paola Scalabrin, Thaisa Tiglao, Jonathan Tin, and Shana Wagger for their input. We are also grateful for the continuous support and guidance provided by Dirk Koehler, Santiago Pombo, Nancy Lammers, Randi Park, Richard Crabbe, and Carlos Rossel. xiii Abbreviations CAS Country Assistance Strategy CSO civil society organization HIPC heavily indebted poor countries HIV/AIDS human immunodeficiency virus/acquired immune deficiency syndrome IBRD International Bank for Reconstruction and Development ICSID International Centre for Settlement of Investment Disputes IDA International Development Association IFC International Finance Corporation IMF International Monetary Fund MDG Millennium Development Goal MIGA Multilateral Investment Guarantee Agency NGO nongovernmental organization PIC public information center PREM Poverty Reduction and Economic Management PRSP Poverty Reduction Strategy Paper TB tuberculosis UN United Nations VPU vice presidential unit WBI World Bank Institute All dollar amounts are U.S. dollars unless otherwise indicated. xv A man works in a timber factory in Bosnia and Herzegovina. The ability to work is the only financial asset of many of the world's poor people. Efficient labor markets create opportunities for work, thereby helping to reduce poverty. The World Bank Group Mission To fight poverty with passion and professionalism for lasting results. To help people help themselves and their environment by providing resources, sharing knowledge, building capacity, and forging partnerships in the public and private sectors. International Bank for Reconstruction and Development International Development Association To promote sustainable private sector investment in developing countries, helping to reduce poverty and improve people's lives. International Finance Corporation To promote foreign direct investment into developing countries to help support economic growth, reduce poverty, and improve people's lives. Multilateral Investment Guarantee Agency xvii A mother and child in Botswana. Nearly half of the world's population today is under 25 years old. Nine out of ten of these young people live in developing countries. Within the developing world the majority of the poor are children and youth. Introduction Conceived in 1944 to reconstruct war-torn Europe, the World Bank Group has evolved into one of the world's largest sources of development assistance, with a mission of fighting poverty with passion by helping people help themselves. We live in a world that is both very rich and very poor. The average person in some countries earns more than $40,000 a year--$110 a day. But in this same world, around 2.6 billion people--almost half the developing world's population--live on less than $2 a day. Of these, almost 1 billion earn less than $1 day. For these people, the many effects of poverty are life-altering. For example, in developing countries, an estimated 33,000 children die every day from avoidable causes, and every minute at least one woman dies in child- birth. Poverty additionally keeps more than 100 million children--most of them girls--out of school. To further complicate matters, many obstacles exist that make it difficult for people to escape poverty's grasp. Inadequate infrastructure hinders access to health care, education, jobs, and trade; poor health and lack of education, in turn, deprive people of productive employment; and corruption, conflict, and poor governance waste public resources and private investment. In the face of such obstacles, the challenge of reducing poverty is both enormous and complex. But with the world's population growing by an estimated 3 bil- lion people over the next 50 years, and with the vast majority of those people residing in developing countries, it is a challenge that must be met. The World Bank Group, also referred to as the Bank Group, is one of the world's largest sources of funding and knowledge for developing countries. Its main focus is on helping the poorest people and the poorest countries. Through its five institutions (box 1), the Bank Group uses financial resources and extensive experience to help developing countries reduce poverty, 1 2 A Guide to the World Bank Box 1 The Five World Bank Group Institutions The World Bank Group consists of the following five institutions: TERNATIONAL BANK IN FOR The International Bank for Reconstruction and WORLD BANK Development (IBRD) lends to governments of middle- R E T C N O E N STRUCTION PM income and creditworthy low-income countries. AND DEVELO DEVELOPMENT L A A The International Development Association (IDA) N S IO S O AT provides interest-free loans--called credits--and grants N R IC E T ITA N O I to governments of the poorest countries. N I N N O T The International Finance Corporation (IFC) provides E IT A R R AN loans, equity, and technical assistance to stimulate pri- T O IO P R N O vate sector investment in developing countries. A C L F IN A N CE R AL IN E V The Multilateral Investment Guarantee Agency (MIGA) T E A S L T I M T E L N provides guarantees against losses caused by non- MU T · · G commercial risks to investors in developing countries. U Y A C R N A E N G T E E A ERNATIONAL CENTRE T FO The International Centre for Settlement of Investment IN R · · S Disputes (ICSID) provides international facilities for ES I C T S E T I T L D U E P conciliation and arbitration of investment disputes. M IS E D N T OF ENT INV E STM Even though the World Bank Group consists of five institu- tions, only the International Bank for Reconstruction and Development and the International Development Associa- tion constitute the World Bank. increase economic growth, and improve the quality of life. The twin pillars of its strategy for reducing poverty are supporting the creation of a favorable investment climate, and empowering poor people. Introduction 3 Box 2 Millennium Development Goals Eradicate extreme poverty and Improve maternal health hunger Combat HIV/AIDS, malaria, and Achieve universal primary other diseases education Ensure environmental Promote gender equality and sustainability empower women Develop a global partnership for Reduce child mortality development The range of interventions includes support for sound governance, sus- tainable development, inclusive delivery of social services, improved infra- structure, private sector development, and job creation. The Bank Group's work focuses on achievement of the Millennium Development Goals (MDGs), which call for eliminating poverty and achieving sustained devel- opment (box 2). The goals are used to set the Bank Group's priorities and they provide targets and yardsticks for measuring results. They are the Bank Group's road map for development. The Bank Group is managed by its member countries (borrowers, lenders, and donors), whose representatives maintain offices at the Bank Group's headquarters in Washington, DC. Many developing countries use Bank Group assistance ranging from loans and grants to technical assistance and policy advice. All Bank Group efforts are coordinated with a wide range of partners, including government agencies, civil society organizations (CSOs), other aid agencies, and the private sector. Over the past 20 years, the Bank Group's focus has changed, and so has its approach. Issues related to gender, community-driven development, and indigenous peoples are now integral to the Bank Group's work. Today, the World Bank Group is the world's largest funder of education, the world's largest external funder of the fight against HIV/AIDS, a leader in the fight against corruption worldwide, a strong supporter of debt relief, the largest international financier of biodiversity projects, and the largest international financier of water supply and sanitation projects. This book guides the reader into the conceptual work of the World Bank Group. Its goal is to serve as starting point for more in-depth inquiries into 4 A Guide to the World Bank subjects of particular interest. It provides a glimpse into the wide array of activities in which the Bank Group institutions are involved, and it directs the reader toward other publications and to Web sites that have more detailed information. The following chapters explain how the World Bank Group is organized; how it operates; and how its work focuses on countries, regions, and specific topics in development. Appendixes provide further information on Bank Group contacts, on the organization's history, and on country membership and voting shares in the institutions. We welcome comments on this publication as well as on the many proj- ects and activities of the Bank Group institutions. To provide comments, visit http://www.worldbank.org and click on "Contact Us" or send an email to feedback@worldbank.org. A woman washes her hands in Vietnam. Better hygiene and access to drinking water and sanitation help to reduce the instances of illness and death caused by preventable diseases each year. 1 How the World Bank Group Is Organized This chapter explains how the World Bank Group is governed and how it is organized to do its work. It provides detailed information on the five World Bank Group institutions and other major organizational units. The final section explains the World Bank Group's relationship with the International Monetary Fund and the United Nations. Governance of the World Bank Group Founding Documents Each of the five institutions of the World Bank Group has its own Articles of Agreement or an equivalent founding document. These documents legally define the institution's purpose, organization, and operations, including the mechanisms by which it is owned and governed. By signing these documents and meeting the requirements set forth in them, a country can become a member of the Bank Group institutions. Ownership by Member Countries Each Bank Group institution is owned by its member countries (its share- holders). The number of member countries varies by institution, from 185 in IBRD to 143 in ICSID, as of April 2007. The requirements for member- ship and the country classifications the Bank Group uses are explained in chapter 3. In practice, member countries govern the Bank Group through the Boards of Governors and the Boards of Directors. These bodies make all major pol- icy decisions for the organization (figure 1.1). Boards of Governors The World Bank Group operates under the authority of its Boards of Governors. Each of the member countries of the Bank Group institutions 7 8 A Guide to the World Bank appoints a governor, who is Figure 1.1 Relationship Between usually a government official at Member Countries and the ministerial level. If a mem- the World Bank Group ber of IBRD is also a member Member countries of IDA or IFC, the appointed governor serves ex officio on Boards of Governors the IDA and IFC Boards of Governors. MIGA governors are appointed separately to its Boards of Directors Council of Governors. ICSID has an Administrative Council President rather than a Board of Gov- ernors. Unless a government Bank Group management and staff makes a contrary designation, its appointed governor for IBRD sits ex officio on ICSID's Administrative Council. The governors admit or suspend members, review financial statements and budgets, make formal arrangements to cooperate with other international organizations, and exercise other powers that they have not delegated. Once a year, the Boards of Governors of the Bank Group (including ICSID's Admin- istrative Council) and the International Monetary Fund (IMF) meet in a joint session known as the Annual Meetings (more information on these meetings appears in the final section of this chapter). Because the governors meet only annually, they delegate many specific duties to the executive directors. Boards of Directors General operations of IBRD are delegated to a smaller group of representatives, the Board of Executive Directors. These same individuals serve ex officio on IDA's Board of Executive Directors and on IFC's Board of Directors under the Articles of Agreement for those two institutions. Members of MIGA's Board of Directors are elected separately, but it is customary for the directors of MIGA to be the same individuals as the executive directors of IBRD. Unlike the other four institutions, ICSID does not have a board. The president of the Bank Group serves as the chair of all four boards (and as the chair of ICSID's Admin- istrative Council), but he or she has no voting power. IBRD has 24 executive directors. The five largest shareholders--the United States, Japan, Germany, France, and the United Kingdom--each appoint one executive director. The other countries are grouped into con- stituencies, each of which elects an executive director as its representative. How the World Bank Group Is Organized 9 The members themselves decide how they will be grouped. Some countries-- China, the Russian Federation, and Saudi Arabia--form single-country con- stituencies. Multicountry constituencies more or less represent geographic regions, with some political and cultural factors determining exactly how they are constituted. The executive directors are based at Bank Group headquarters in Wash- ington, DC. They are responsible for making policy decisions affecting the Bank Group's operations and for approving all loans. The executive directors function in continuous session and meet as often as Bank Group business requires, although their regular meetings occur twice a week. Each executive director also serves on one or more standing committees: the Audit Com- mittee, Budget Committee, Committee on Development Effectiveness, Per- sonnel Committee, and Committee on Governance and Executive Directors' Administrative Matters. The boards normally make decisions by consensus; however, the relative voting power of individual executive directors is based on the shares that are held by the countries they represent (figure 1.2). For more on the constituen- cies, voting power, and elections of the executive directors, see appendix E. World Bank Group President and Managing Directors The World Bank Group president is selected by the executive directors. The Articles of Agreement do not specify the nationality of the president, but by long-standing, informal agreement, he or she is a U.S. national (by custom, Figure 1.2 Voting Power of the Largest Shareholders of IBRD 16.39% United States 7.87% Japan 4.49% Germany Others 62.61% 4.30% France 4.30% United Kingdom Source: World Bank 2006. 10 A Guide to the World Bank nominated by the U.S. executive director), while the managing director of the IMF is a European. The president serves a term of five years, which may be renewed. There is no mandatory retirement age. The executive vice presidents of IFC and MIGA report directly to the World Bank Group president, and as mentioned previously, the president serves as chair of ICSID's Administrative Council. (ICSID operates as a sec- retariat whose secretary-general is selected by the Administrative Council every six years.) Within IBRD and IDA, most organizational units report to the president and, through the president, to the executive directors. The two exceptions are the Independent Evaluation Group and the Inspection Panel, which report directly to the executive directors. Additionally, the president delegates some of his or her oversight responsibility to two managing direc- tors, each of which oversees several organizational units. For more information about the World Bank Group president visit http://www.worldbank.org/president. For information about previous pres- idents of the Bank Group, see appendix C. World Bank Group headquarters in Washington, DC. How the World Bank Group Is Organized 11 The Five World Bank Group Institutions The institutions that make up the World Bank Group specialize in different aspects of development, but they work collaboratively toward the overarching goal of poverty reduction. The terms "World Bank" and "Bank" refer only to IBRD and IDA, whereas the terms "World Bank Group" and "Bank Group" include all five institutions (box 1.1). The World Bank: IBRD and IDA Through its loans, policy advice, and technical assistance, the World Bank supports a broad range of programs aimed at reducing poverty and improv- ing living standards in the developing world. It divides its work between IBRD, which assists middle-income and creditworthy poorer countries, and IDA, which focuses exclusively on the world's poorest countries. Working through both IBRD and IDA, the Bank uses its financial resources, skilled staff, and extensive knowledge base to help each developing country achieve stable, sustainable, and equitable growth. IBRD and IDA share the same staff and the same headquarters, report to the same senior management, and use the same standards when evaluating projects. Some countries borrow from both institutions. For all its clients, the Bank emphasizes the need for investing in people, particularly through basic health and education; focusing on social development, inclusion, governance, and institution building as key elements of poverty reduction; strengthening governments' ability to deliver quality services efficiently and transparently; protecting the environment; Box 1.1 Origin of the Term "World Bank" The term "world bank" was first used in reference to IBRD in an article in the Economist on July 22, 1944, in a report on the Bretton Woods Conference. The first meeting of the Boards of Governors of IBRD and the IMF, which was held in Savannah, Georgia, in March 1946, was officially called the "World Fund and Bank Inaugural Meeting," and several news accounts of this conference, including one in the Washington Post, used the term "world bank." What began as a nickname became official shorthand for IBRD and IDA in 1975. 12 A Guide to the World Bank supporting and encouraging private business development; and promoting reforms to create a stable macroeconomic environment that is conducive to investment and long-term planning. Bank programs give high priority to sustainable social and human devel- opment and to strengthened economic management, and they place an emphasis on inclusion, governance, and institution building. Additionally, within the international community, the Bank has helped build consensus around the idea that developing countries must take the lead in creating their own strategies for poverty reduction. It also plays a key role in helping coun- tries implement the MDGs, which the United Nations (UN) and the broader international community seek to achieve by 2015. In conjunction with IFC, the Bank is also helping countries strengthen and sustain the fundamental conditions they need to attract and retain private investment. With Bank support--both lending and advice--governments are reforming their overall economies and strengthening financial systems. Invest- ments in human resources, infrastructure, and environmental protection also help enhance the attractiveness and productivity of private investment. The International Bank for Reconstruction and Development IBRD, established in 1944, is the original institution of the World Bank Group and the source of the loans for which the Bank Group is best known. IBRD remains what many people mean when they refer to the World Bank. It has the largest country membership, the broadest mission, and the great- est number of staff in the Bank Group, both at headquarters and in offices around the world (box 1.2). When IBRD was established, its first task was to help Europe recover from World War II. Today IBRD plays an important role in poverty reduction by providing the countries it now serves--middle-income and creditworthy poorer countries--with loans, guarantees, and analytical and advisory ser- vices. It provides these client countries with access to capital on favorable terms in larger volumes, with longer maturities, and in a more sustainable manner than the market provides. Specifically, IBRD supports long-term human and social development needs that private creditors do not finance; preserves borrowers' financial strength by providing support during crisis periods, which is when poor people are most adversely affected; uses the leverage of financing to promote key policy and institutional reforms (such as safety net or anticorruption reforms); How the World Bank Group Is Organized 13 Box 1.2 IBRD Basic Facts TERNATIONALBANK Year established: 1944 IN FOR Number of member countries: 185 WORLD BANK R E T Cumulative lending: $420.2 billiona C N O E N STRUCTION PM AND DEVELO Fiscal 2006 lending: $14.1 billion for 112 new operations in 33 countries IBRD Web: http://www.worldbank.org Basic Facts a. As of June 30, 2006. Includes guarantees from fiscal 2005. creates a favorable investment climate to catalyze the provision of private capital; and provides financial support (in the form of grants made available from IBRD's net income) in areas that are critical to the well-being of poor peo- ple in all countries. IBRD raises most of its funds on the world's financial markets. It is an AAA-rated financial institution, but one with some unusual characteristics: its shareholders are sovereign governments and its member borrowers have a voice in setting its policies. IBRD provides loans, guarantees, risk management products, and analytic and advisory services. These services may be packaged together or offered as stand-alone services. Also, unlike commercial banks, IBRD is driven by development impact rather than by profit maximization. IBRD borrowers are typically middle-income countries that have some access to private capital markets. Some countries that are eligible for IDA lending because of low per capita incomes are also eligible for some IBRD borrowing because of their creditworthiness. These countries are known as "blend" bor- rowers (table 1.1). Hundreds of millions of the developing world's poor, defined as those who live on less than $2 a day, live not in the world's very poorest countries, but in middle-income countries, which are defined as those with an annual gross national income per capita between $876 and $10,725 (For more on country classifications, see World Development Indicators or the World Bank Annual Report, http://publications.worldbank.org/ecommerce/.) Countries are considered to have graduated from IBRD borrowing when their per capita income exceeds the level that the Bank classifies as middle income. For more information, including a list of IBRD graduates, see chap- ter 3 and box 3.2. 14 A Guide to the World Bank Table 1.1 Country Eligibility for Borrowing from the World Bank as of July 1, 2006 2005 2005 GNI per GNI per Income group and country capitaa Income group and country capitaa COUNTRIES ELIGIBLE FOR IBRD FUNDS ONLY Per capita income over $6,055 Korea, Republic of 15,810 Slovak Republic 8,130 Antigua and Barbuda 10,920 Croatia 8,070 Trinidad and Tobago 10,440 Palau 7,410 Hungary 10,050 Lithuania 7,210 Estonia 9,100 Mexico 7,150 Seychellesb 8,290 Poland 7,110 St. Kitts and Nevis 8,200 Latvia 6,760 Per capita income $3,466­$6,055 Chile 5,870 Venezuela, República Bolivariana de 4,810 Libya 5,530 Turkey 4,740 Lebanon 5,510 Panama 4,630 Mauritius 5,260 Argentina 4,470 Botswana 5,190 Russian Federation 4,460 Gabon 5,010 Uruguay 4,360 Malaysia 4,960 Romania 3,830 South Africa 4,960 Belize 3,500 Costa Rica 4,820 Equatorial Guinea NA Per capita income $1,676­$3,465 Brazil 3,460 Peru 2,710 Bulgaria 3,450 Ecuador 2,590 Jamaica 3,370 Suriname 2,540 Fiji 3,140 Dominican Republic 2,470 Namibia 2,990 Jordan 2,470 Marshall Islands 2,980 El Salvador 2,450 Kazakhstan 2,930 Guatemala 2,330 Tunisia 2,890 Colombia 2,290 Macedonia, former Yugoslav Swaziland 2,280 Republic of 2,790 Micronesia, Federated States of 1,910 Iran, Islamic Republic of 2,770 China 1,740 Belarus 2,750 Morocco 1,730 Thailand 2,750 Algeria 2,730 Per capita income $876­$1,675 Ukraine 1,520 Philippines 1,250 Syrian Arab Republic 1,380 Iraq NA Paraguay 1,280 Turkmenistan NA Egypt, Arab Republic of 1,250 How the World Bank Group Is Organized 15 2005 2005 GNI per GNI per Income group and country capitaa Income group and country capitaa COUNTRIES ELIGIBLE FOR A BLEND OF IBRD AND IDA FUNDSc Per capita income $3,466­$6,055 St. Luciad 4,800 Dominicad 3,790 Grenadad 3,920 St. Vincent and the Grenadinesd 3,590 Per capita income $1,676­$3,465 Serbia and Montenegroe 3,280 Bosnia and Herzegovina 2,550 Albania 2,570 Per capita income $876­$1,675 Indonesia 1,270 Bolivia 1,010 Azerbaijan 1,240 Per capita income $875 or less India 730 Uzbekistan 520 Pakistan 690 Zimbabweb 340 Papua New Guinea 660 COUNTRIES ELIGIBLE FOR IDA FUNDS ONLYc Per capita income $1,676­$3,465 Maldivesd 2,390 Samoad 2,090 Tongad 2,130 Cape Verded 1,870 Per capita income $876­$1,675 Armenia 1,470 Djibouti 1,020 Vanuatud 1,450 Cameroon 1,010 Angola 1,350 Guyana 1,000 Kiribatid 1,350 Congo, Republic of 950 Georgia 1,310 Lesotho 950 Honduras 1,170 Nicaragua 890 Sri Lanka 1,160 Moldova 880 Per capita income $875 or less Bhutan 870 Mali 380 Côte d'Ivoireb 840 Guinea 370 Timor-Leste 750 Central African Republicb 350 Senegal 710 Togob 350 Mongolia 670 Tanzania 340 Comoros 640 Tajikistan 330 Sudanb 640 Mozambique 310 Vietnam 620 Gambia, The 290 Yemen, Republic of 600 Madagascar 290 (continued) 16 A Guide to the World Bank Table 1.1 continued 2005 2005 GNI per GNI per Income group and country capitaa Income group and country capitaa COUNTRIES ELIGIBLE FOR IDA FUNDS ONLYc continued Per capita income $875 or less Mauritania 560 Nepal 280 Nigeria 560 Uganda 280 Solomon Islands 560 Niger 240 Kenya 530 Rwanda 230 Benin 510 Eritrea 220 Zambia 490 Sierra Leone 220 Bangladesh 470 Guinea-Bissau 180 Ghana 450 Ethiopia 160 Haiti 450 Malawi 160 Kyrgyz Republic 440 Liberiab 130 Lao People's Democratic Republic 440 Congo, Democratic Republic of 120 Burkina Faso 400 Burundi 100 Chad 400 Afghanistan NA São Tomé and Principe 390 Myanmarb NA Cambodia 380 Somaliab NA Source: World Bank 2006. Note: NA = estimates are available in range only, GNI = gross national income. a. World Bank Atlas methodology. Per capita GNI (formerly gross national product) figures are in 2005 U.S. dollars. b. Loans/credits in nonaccrual status as of June 30, 2006. General information on countries with loans/credits in nonaccrual status is available from the Credit Risk Department in Finance. c. Countries are eligible for IDA on the basis of (a) relative poverty and (b) lack of creditworthiness. The operational cutoff for IDA eligibility for fiscal 2007 is a 2005 GNI per capita of $1,025 using World Bank Atlas methodology. To receive IDA resources, countries must also meet tests of performance. In excep- tional circumstances, IDA extends eligibility temporarily to countries that are above the operational cutoff and are undertaking major adjustment efforts but are not creditworthy for IBRD lending. An exception has been made for small island economies. d. An exception to the GNI per capita operational cutoff for IDA eligibility ($1,025 for fiscal 2007) has been made for some small island economies, which otherwise would have little or no access to Bank Group assis- tance because they lack creditworthiness. For such countries, IDA funding is considered on a case-by-case basis for financing projects and adjustment programs designed to strengthen creditworthiness. e. Following a referendum in May 2006, Montenegro declared its independence from the union of Serbia and Montenegro, resulting in both states becoming independent countries. Data are for both states prior to independence. Even though IBRD does not maximize profits, it has earned a positive net income each year since 1948. This income funds development activities and ensures financial strength, enabling low-cost borrowing in capital markets and good terms for borrowing clients. Additional information on IBRD loans appears in the next chapter. How the World Bank Group Is Organized 17 The International Development Association After the rebuilding of Europe following World War II, the Bank turned its attention to the newly independent developing countries. It became clear that the poorest developing countries could not afford to borrow capital for devel- opment on the terms offered by the Bank; hence, a group of Bank member countries decided to found IDA as an institution that could lend to very poor developing nations on easier terms. To imbue IDA with the discipline of a bank, these countries agreed that IDA should be part of the World Bank. IDA began operating in 1960 (box 1.3). IDA helps the world's poorest countries reduce poverty by providing cred- its and grants. Credits are loans at zero interest with a 10-year grace period before repayment of principal begins and maturities of 20, 35, or 40 years. These credits are often referred to as concessional lending. IDA credits help build the human capital, policies, institutions, and physical infrastructure that these countries urgently need to achieve faster, environmentally sustain- able growth. IDA's goal is to reduce disparities across and within countries-- especially in terms of access to primary education, basic health, and water supply and sanitation--and to bring more people into the economic main- stream by raising their productivity. IDA is funded largely by contributions from the governments of its high- income member countries (table 1.2). Representatives of donor countries meet every three years to replenish IDA funds. Since 1960, IDA has lent $170 billion to 108 countries. Annual lending figures have increased steadily and averaged about $9.1 billion over the last three years. Additional funds come from repayments of earlier IDA credits and from IBRD's net income. Box 1.3 IDA Basic Facts DEVELOPMENT Year established: 1960 L A A N S Number of member countries: 166 IO S O AT N R IC E Cumulative commitments: $170 billiona T ITA N O I N Fiscal 2006 commitments: $9.5 billion for 167 new operations in 59 countries IDA Web: http://www.worldbank.org/ida Basic Facts a. As of June 30, 2006. Includes guarantees from fiscal 2005. 18 A Guide to the World Bank Table 1.2 Cumulative IDA Subscriptions and Contributions Member $ millions Percentage of total Argentina 69.84 0.05 Australia 2,417.33 1.72 Austria 1,368.44 0.97 Barbados 1.04 0.00 Belgium 2,081.59 1.48 Bosnia and Herzegovina 2.43 0.00 Botswana 1.62 0.00 Brazil 557.19 0.40 Canada 6,219.97 4.42 Colombia 24.66 0.02 Croatia 5.67 0.00 Czech Republic 54.59 0.04 Denmark 2,020.66 1.44 Finland 942.12 0.67 France 10,166.45 7.22 Germany 15,936.56 11.32 Greece 88.31 0.06 Hungary 54.63 0.04 Iceland 39.95 0.03 Ireland 207.18 0.15 Israel 41.03 0.03 Italy 5,183.77 3.68 Japan 28,803.37 20.46 Korea, Republic of 690.80 0.49 Kuwait 755.74 0.54 Luxembourg 122.00 0.09 Macedonia, former Yugoslav Republic of 1.07 0.00 Mexico 138.32 0.10 Netherlands 5,162.09 3.67 New Zealand 180.28 0.13 Norway 2,086.89 1.48 Oman 1.37 0.00 Poland 69.08 0.05 Portugal 140.89 0.10 Russian Federation 262.78 0.19 Saudi Arabia 2,258.21 1.60 Serbia and Montenegroa 6.86 0.00 Singapore 36.41 0.03 Slovak Republic 17.34 0.01 Slovenia 9.28 0.01 South Africa 120.65 0.09 Spain 1,480.97 1.05 How the World Bank Group Is Organized 19 Member $ millions Percentage of total Sweden 4,168.64 2.96 Switzerland 2,395.80 1.70 United Arab Emirates 5.58 0.00 United Kingdom 12,373.54 8.79 United States 31,541.78 22.41 Total donors 140,314.77 99.69 Total nondonors 437.97 0.31 Grand Total 140,752.74 100.00 Source: World Bank data as of June 30, 2006. Note: Numbers may not add to totals because of rounding. a. Following a referendum in May 2006 Montenegro declared its independence from the union of Serbia and Montenegro, resulting in both states becoming independent countries. Data are for both states prior to independence. Donor contributions account for more than half of the $33 billion in the 14th replenishment of IDA, known as IDA14, which finances projects over the three-year period ending June 30, 2008. The United States, the United Kingdom, Japan, Germany, France, Italy, and Canada made the largest pledges to IDA14, but less wealthy nations also contribute to IDA; for example, Turkey, once an IDA borrower, is now a donor. Countries currently eligible to borrow from IBRD but not from IDA, namely, Brazil, the Czech Republic, Hungary, Mexico, Poland, the Russian Federation, the Slovak Republic, and South Africa, are also IDA14 donors. Other contributors include Australia, Austria, Barbados, Belgium, Denmark, Finland, Greece, Iceland, Ireland, Israel, Kuwait, Luxembourg, the Nether- lands, New Zealand, Norway, Portugal, Saudi Arabia, Singapore, Slovenia, Spain, Sweden, Switzerland, and the República Bolivariana de Venezuela. IDA lends to those countries that lack the financial ability to borrow from IBRD and that, in 2005, had an income of less than $1,025 per person. Some blend borrower countries, such as India and Indonesia, are eligible for IDA loans because of their low per person incomes while also being eligible for IBRD loans because they are financially creditworthy. Eighty-two countries are currently eligible to borrow from IDA. Together these countries are home to around 2.6 billion people, almost half the total population of the develop- ing world. Of these people, almost 1 billion survive on incomes of $1 or less a day. IDA eligibility is a transitional arrangement that gives the poorest countries access to substantial resources before they are capable of obtaining the financ- ing they need from commercial markets. As their economies grow, countries 20 A Guide to the World Bank graduate from IDA eligibility. The repayments, or "reflows," that they make on IDA loans are used to help finance new IDA loans to the remaining poor countries. More than 30 countries have graduated from IDA since its founding. Examples include Chile, Costa Rica, the Arab Republic of Egypt, Morocco, Thailand, and Turkey. Some of the graduating countries sub- sequently "reverse graduated," however, once again becoming IDA eligible. The International Finance Corporation IFC is the largest multilateral provider of financing for private enterprise in developing countries. Its mission is to promote sustainable private sector investment in developing countries, thereby helping to reduce poverty and improve people's lives. IFC finances private sector investment, mobilizes cap- ital in international financial markets, facilitates trade, helps clients improve social and environmental sustainability, and provides technical assistance and advice to governments and businesses. Since its founding in 1956, IFC has committed more than $56 billion of its own funds for private sector invest- ment in the developing world; has mobilized an additional $25 billion in syn- dications; and with funding support from donors, has provided more than $1 billion in technical assistance and advisory services (box 1.4). Direct lending to businesses is the fundamental contrast between IFC and the World Bank: under their Articles of Agreement, IBRD and IDA can lend only to the governments of member countries. IFC was founded specifically to address this limitation of World Bank lending. Box 1.4 IFC Basic Facts Year established: 1956 I N N O T Number of member countries: 179 E IT A R R AN T O IO P Cumulative active portfolio: $21.6 billiona R N O A C L (excluding $5.1 billion FIN A NCE in syndicated loans) IFC Fiscal 2006 commitments: $6.7 billion for 284 projects Basic in 66 countries Facts Web: http://www.ifc.org a. As of June 30, 2006. How the World Bank Group Is Organized 21 IFC provides equity, long-term loans, loan guarantees, structured finance and risk management products, and advisory services to its clients. It seeks to reach businesses in regions and countries that otherwise would have limited access to capital. It provides financing in markets deemed too risky by com- mercial investors in the absence of IFC participation. IFC also supports the projects it finances by providing advice on corpo- rate governance, environmental and social expertise, and advice and techni- cal assistance to businesses and governments. Much of the advisory work is funded by IFC's donor partners, through trust funds, or through facilities with a regional or thematic focus. IFC continues to seek ways to enhance its development impact. The five key pillars of IFC's strategy are (1) strengthening the focus on frontier mar- kets; (2) building long-term relationships with emerging global companies based in developing countries; (3) leading through environmental and social sustainability; (4) addressing the constraints to private sector growth in in- frastructure, health, and education; and (5) developing financial markets through innovative products and institution building. Project financing IFC offers an array of financial products and services to companies in its developing member countries, including long-term loans in major and local currencies at fixed or variable rates; equity investments; quasi-equity instruments, such as subordinated loans, preferred stock, income notes, and convertible debt; syndicated loans; structured finance, such as partial credit guarantees, risk-sharing facilities, and securitizations; risk management, such as intermediation of currency and interest rate swaps and provision of hedging facilities; intermediary financing; subnational financing (for services operated for regional and local govern- ments and government-controlled enterprises); trade finance; and subnational finance. IFC can provide financial instruments singly or in whatever combination is necessary to ensure that projects are adequately funded from the outset. It 22 A Guide to the World Bank can also help structure financial packages by coordinating financing from for- eign and local banks and companies and from export credit agencies. IFC charges market rates for its products and does not accept government guarantees. Therefore, it carefully reviews the likelihood of success for each enterprise. To be eligible for IFC financing, projects must be profitable for investors, must benefit the economy of the host country, and must comply with IFC's environmental and social standards. IFC finances projects in all types of industries and sectors, including manufacturing, infrastructure, tourism, health and education, and financial services. Financial services pro- jects are the largest component of IFC's portfolio, and they cover the full range of financial institutions, including banks, leasing companies, stock markets, credit rating agencies, venture capital funds, and microfinance insti- tutions. Even though IFC is primarily a financier of private sector projects, it may provide financing for a company with some government ownership provided there is private sector participation and the venture is run on a com- mercial basis. It can finance companies that are wholly locally owned as well as joint ventures between foreign and local shareholders. To ensure participation by investors and lenders from the private sector, IFC limits the total amount of own-account debt and equity financing it will provide for any single project. For new projects, the maximum amount is 25 percent of the total estimated project costs or, on an exceptional basis, up to 35 percent for small projects. For expansion projects, IFC may provide up to 50 percent of the total project costs, provided its investments do not exceed 25 percent of the total capitalization of the project company. On average, for every $1 of IFC financing, other investors and lenders provide $3 to $5. IFC investments typically range from $1 million to $100 million. IFC funds may be used for permanent working capital or for foreign or local expenditures in any IBRD member country to acquire fixed assets. Because IFC operates on commercial terms that target profitability, it has made a profit every year since its inception. Resource mobilization Given IFC's record of success and its special standing as a multilateral insti- tution, it is able to act as a catalyst for private investment. Its participation in a project enhances investors' confidence and attracts other lenders and share- holders. IFC mobilizes financing directly for sound companies in developing countries by syndicating loans with international commercial banks. It also helps structure private financing for clients through guarantees, risk-sharing facilities, and securitizations. How the World Bank Group Is Organized 23 Advisory services IFC advises businesses in developing countries on a wide variety of matters, including physical and financial restructuring; business plans; identification of markets, products, technologies, and financial and technical partners; and corporate governance. IFC can provide such advisory services in the context of an investment or independently for a fee in line with market practice. IFC also advises governments in developing countries on how to create an enabling business environment, and it provides guidance on attracting foreign direct investment. For example, it helps develop domestic capital markets. It also provides assistance in restructuring and privatizing state-owned enterprises. The Multilateral Investment Guarantee Agency Concerns about investment environments and perceptions of political risk often inhibit foreign direct investment, with the majority of flows going to just a handful of countries and leaving the world's poorest economies largely ignored. MIGA addresses these concerns by providing three key services: political risk insurance for foreign investment in developing countries, tech- nical assistance, and dispute mediation services. MIGA's operational strategy plays to the agency's foremost strength in the marketplace: attracting investors and private insurers into difficult operating environments. The agency's strategy focuses on specific areas where it can make the greatest difference: Infrastructure development, which is an important priority for MIGA given the estimated need for $230 billion a year solely for new investment to provide infrastructure for rapidly growing urban centers and underserved rural populations in developing countries. Frontier markets, that is, high-risk or low-income countries and markets, which represent both a challenge and an opportunity for the agency. Such markets typically have the greatest need for, and stand to benefit the most from, foreign investment, but are not well served by the private market. Investment in conflict-affected countries, which is another operational pri- ority for the agency given that, although such countries tend to attract considerable donor goodwill once the conflict ends, aid flows eventually start to decline, making private investment critical for reconstruction and growth. With many investors wary of potential risks, political risk insur- ance becomes essential for moving investments forward. Investments between developing countries, which are contributing a grow- ing proportion of foreign direct investment flows. However, the private 24 A Guide to the World Bank insurance market in these countries is not always sufficiently developed and national export credit agencies often lack the ability and capacity to offer political risk insurance. Development impact and priorities Since its creation in 1988, MIGA has issued $16 billion in guarantee cover- age in support of 527 projects in 95 member developing countries (box 1.5). MIGA is committed to promoting socially, economically, and environmen- tally sustainable projects that are, above all, developmentally responsible. Proj- ects supported have widespread benefits; for example, generating jobs and taxes and transferring skills and know-how. In addition, local communities often receive significant secondary benefits through improved infrastructure. Projects encourage similar local investments and spur the growth of local businesses. MIGA ensures that projects are aligned with World Bank Group Country Assistance Strategies and integrate the best environmental, social, and governance practices. (More information about Country Assistance Strategies is provided in chapter 2.) MIGA's technical assistance services play an integral role in catalyzing for- eign direct investment by helping developing countries define and implement strategies to improve their investment climates and promote investment opportunities. MIGA develops and deploys tools and technologies to help dis- seminate information about investment opportunities, and thousands of users take advantage of the agency's suite of online investment information services. The agency uses its legal services to protect the investments it supports and remove possible obstacles to future investment by helping governments and investors resolve any differences. Box 1.5 MIGA Basic Facts Year established: 1988 RAL IN E V T E A S L T I M T Number of member countries: 171 E L N MU T · · Cumulative guarantees issued: G $16 billiona U Y A C R N A E Fiscal 2006 guarantees issued: $1.3 billion N G TE E A Web: http://www.miga.org MIGA Basic Facts a. As of June 30, 2006. Includes funds leveraged through the Cooperative Underwriting Program. How the World Bank Group Is Organized 25 Added value MIGA gives private investors the confidence they need to make sustainable investments in developing countries. As part of the World Bank Group, MIGA brings security and credibility to an investment, acting as a potent deterrent against government actions that may adversely affect investments. If disputes do arise, the agency's leverage with host governments frequently enables it to resolve differences to the mutual satisfaction of all parties. MIGA is a leader in assessing and managing political risks, developing new products and services, and finding innovative ways to meet clients' needs. The agency can also enable complex transactions to go ahead by offering innova- tive coverage of the nontraditional subsovereign risks that often accompany water and other infrastructure projects. It also provides interest rate hedging instruments and guarantee coverage for capital market transactions. MIGA complements the activities of other investment insurers and works with partners through its coinsurance and reinsurance programs. By doing so, it expands the capacity of the political risk insurance industry and encour- ages private sector insurers to enter into transactions they would not other- wise have undertaken. The International Centre for Settlement of Investment Disputes ICSID helps encourage foreign investment by providing international facil- ities for the conciliation and arbitration of investment disputes, thereby help- ing foster an atmosphere of mutual confidence between states and foreign investors (box 1.6). Many international agreements concerning investment refer to ICSID's arbitration facilities. ICSID also carries out research and publishing in the areas of arbitration law and foreign investment law. Box 1.6 ICSID Basic Facts ERNATIONALCENTRE Year established: 1966 T FO IN R · · S Number of member countries: 143 ES I C T S E T I T L D U E P 210a M IS Total cases registered: E D N T OF ENT INVE STM Fiscal 2006 cases registered: 26 ICSID Web: http://www.worldbank.org/icsid Basic Facts a. As of June 30, 2006. 26 A Guide to the World Bank ICSID was established under the Convention on the Settlement of Invest- ment Disputes between States and Nationals of Other States. The ICSID Convention came into force in 1966. ICSID has an Administrative Council and a Secretariat. The Administrative Council is chaired by the World Bank's president and consists of one representative of each state that has ratified the ICSID Convention. Annual meetings of the Administrative Council are held in conjunction with the joint Annual Meetings of the Bank Group and the IMF. ICSID is an autonomous international organization, but it has close links with the World Bank, and all ICSID members are also members of the Bank. Unless a government makes a contrary designation, its governor for the Bank sits ex officio on ICSID's Administrative Council. The expenses of the ICSID Secretariat are financed through the Bank's budget, although the parties involved bear the costs of individual proceedings. ICSID provides the following three types of services: Facilities for the conciliation and arbitration of disputes between member coun- tries and investors who qualify as nationals of other member countries. Recourse to ICSID conciliation and arbitration is entirely voluntary; however, after the parties have consented to arbitration under the ICSID Convention, neither can unilaterally withdraw its consent. Moreover, the ICSID Con- vention requires all ICSID contracting states, whether they are parties to the dispute or not, to recognize and enforce ICSID arbitral awards. Certain types of proceedings between states and foreign nationals that fall out- side the scope of the ICSID Convention. These proceedings include concil- iation and arbitration proceedings when either the state party or the home state of the foreign national is not a member of ICSID. "Additional facility" conciliation and arbitration are also available for cases in which the dispute is not an investment dispute, provided it relates to a transac- tion that has features that distinguish it from an ordinary commercial transaction. The additional facility rules further allow ICSID to admin- ister a type of proceeding not provided for in the ICSID Convention, namely, fact-finding proceedings, to which any states or foreign nation- als may have recourse if they wish to institute an inquiry to examine and report on facts. Appointment of arbitrators for ad hoc (that is, noninstitutional) arbitration proceedings. These appointments are most commonly made in the context of arrangements for arbitration under the arbitration rules of the UN Commission on International Trade Law, which are specially designed for ad hoc proceedings. How the World Bank Group Is Organized 27 Organizing Principles within the World Bank Group This section explains the basic principles upon which the World Bank Group organizes its work and lists the major organizational units. Later chapters focus on the substance of what the Bank Group does. Vice Presidential Units The vice presidential unit (VPU) is the main organizational unit of the World Bank (IBRD and IDA). Such units are commonly referred to as vice presi- dencies. With a few exceptions that report directly to the president, each of these units reports to a managing director or to the Bank Group's chief finan- cial officer. In general, each vice presidency corresponds to a world region, a thematic network, or a central function (figure 1.3). The network vice pres- idencies cut across the regional vice presidencies in the form of a matrix. This arrangement helps to ensure an appropriate mix of experience and expertise. Consequently, a staff member may work for a network vice presidency but could be deployed to support work in a specific region or country. The organizational structures of the other World Bank Group institutions have varying degrees of similarity to the organization of IBRD and IDA, reflecting the unique aspects of each institution's mission. Figures 1.4 and 1.5 show the organization of IFC and MIGA, respectively. The following subsections provide additional information about the dif- ferent types of VPUs and other major units within the Bank. For additional information, see http://www.worldbank.org/vpu. Regional vice presidencies and country offices Bank Group institutions have long organized much of their work around major world regions and have carried it out through offices in member coun- tries. In recent years, decentralization has been a top priority, with the goal being to bring a higher proportion of Bank Group staff members into closer proximity with their clients. IBRD and IDA, for example, have relocated two-thirds of their country directors from Bank headquarters in Washington, DC, to the field since the mid-1990s. The percentage of staff members who work in the field has also increased significantly. Similarly, IFC is decentral- izing key decision-making responsibilities as part of a commitment to trans- form itself into a client-centered corporation by 2010. All Bank Group institutions share this increased emphasis on countries and regions, but the World Bank and IFC vary somewhat in how they organize their Figure 1.3 World Bank Organizational Structure Board of Governors INTERNATIONALBANK FO R WORLD BANK R E T C N Executive Directors O E N M STRUCTION P AND DEVELO Director- General Independent President Evaluation Director Institutional Integrity Sr. Vice President Managing Managing External Affairs Director Vice President & Director Network Head Operations Policy & Country Services Vice President Vice President Vice President Vice President Middle East and Europe and Latin America Africa North Africa Central Asia and the Caribbean Vice President Vice President Vice President & Vice President Poverty Reduction & East Asia Network Head South Asia Economic and Pacific Human Development Management* Vice President and Vice President & Chief Vice President Network Head Information Officer & Network Head Vice President Sustainable Information Solutions Financial and Private Human Resources Development Group Sector Development** Vice President World Bank Institute* Note: As of March 2007. *Dotted line to Sr. Vice President & Chief Economist. **Reports to IFC Executive Vice President on IFC Business. Chairperson Inspection Panel Auditor-General Internal Auditing Vice President & Sr. Vice President Sr. Vice President WBG Chief Corporate & WBG & Chief Financial Officer Secretary General Counsel Economist Director General Services Department Vice President & Controller Vice President Controllers, Strategy Concessional Finance and Resource & Global Partnerships Management Vice President & Treasurer Figure 1.4 IFC Organizational Structure Board of Governors Board of Directors Director-General Independent Evaluation Compliance Advisor President & Ombudsman (IFC & MIGA) Director(2) Independent Evaluation Executive Vice President, IFC Group Vice President (Bank/IFC) Regional Vice President Regional Vice President Finance, Private Sector Dev. Europe, Africa, Middle East Asia and Latin America & IFC Chief Economist Director Director (Bank/IFC) (3) Director Central & Corporate Governance East Asia & Pacific Eastern Europe Director Director Director (Bank/IFC) Middle East & Latin America Investment Climate North Africa & Caribbean Director (Bank/IFC) Director Director Small & Medium Southern Europe & South Asia Enterprises Central Asia Director Director Sub-Saharan Africa Tokyo Office Director Private Equity & Investment Funds 1) Also reports to World Bank Vice President for Sustainable Development Network 2) Reports to the Director-General, Independent Evaluation; to the EVP for administrative purposes Director 3) Also reports to Vice President, Industries Advisory Services Director Equity Director (Bank/IFC) Grassroots Business Organization Director Operational Strategy Note: As of April 2007. IFC has committed to transforming itself into a client-centered corporation by 2010. Efforts focus on decentralizing key decision-making responsibilities, streamlining business processes, and integrating financial products and advisory services, with corresponding changes being made in IFC's organizational structure as needed. I N N O T E IT A R R AN T O IO P R N O A C L F IN A NCE Vice President & Corporate Secretary Vice President Vice President Vice President Vice President Human Resources & Industries Risk Management Finance and Treasurer Administration Director Director Director Syndications and Agribusiness Business Risk Group Resource Mobilization Director Director Global Financial Controller's Budgeting Markets Senior Manager Corporate Relations Unit Director (Bank/IFC) (1) Chief Information Officer Global Information & Corporate Business Comm. Technologies Informatics Director Environment & Social Development Director Director Global Manufacturing Corporate Portfolio & Services Management General Counsel Legal Director Director Health & Education Credit Review Director Director Infrastructure Financial Operations Director Director (1) Risk Mgmt & Sub-National Finance Financial Policy Director (Bank/IFC) (1) Director Oil, Gas, Mining Special Operations & Chemicals Figure 1.5 MIGA Organizational Structure BOARD OF GOVERNORS BOARD OF DIRECTORS Compliance Advisor/ PRESIDENT Ombudsman (MIGA & IFC) EXECUTIVE VICE PRESIDENT Director General Counsel Director External Outreach Legal Affairs & Claims Group Operations Group & Partners Group Note: As of January 2006. *Reports operationally to DGE (Independent Evaluation) and administratively to EVP (MIGA). RA L IN E V T E A S L T I M T E L N MU T · · G U Y A C R N A E N G TE E A VICE PRESIDENT & CORPORATE SECRETARY Director Independent Evaluation Group* Director & CFO Director & Chief Economist Finance & Risk Management Group Economics & Policy Group 34 A Guide to the World Bank regional and country efforts. The following paragraphs give a brief overview of these organizational units. Chapter 3 summarizes the substance of Bank Group work in the regions, along with the countries covered. The World Bank has six regional vice presidencies: Africa (Sub-Saharan), East Asia and Pacific, Europe and Central Asia, Latin America and the Caribbean, the Middle East and North Africa, and South Asia. The Bank operates offices in more than 100 member countries, as well as at the UN (New York) and in Europe (Brussels, Geneva, London, Paris, and Rome) and Japan (Tokyo). As part of their work, country offices coordinate and partner with member governments, representatives of civil society, and other interna- tional donor agencies operating in the country. Additionally, many country offices, as well as the Paris and Tokyo offices, serve as public information cen- ters (PICS) for the World Bank Group. IFC defines its regions somewhat differently from the Bank. It assigns directors to the following seven regions: Central and Eastern Europe, East Asia and the Pacific, Latin America and the Caribbean, the Middle East and North Africa, South Asia, Southern Europe and Central Asia, and Sub-Saharan Africa. A few countries are assigned to regions different from those they are assigned to within the Bank. The regional departments are grouped into two vice presidencies, one covering Asia and Latin America and the other cover- ing Europe, Africa, and the Middle East. IFC maintains its own network of more than 60 offices in member countries, which in some cases share quarters with a World Bank office. MIGA has representatives resident in Africa, Asia, and Europe. Network vice presidencies and sectors IBRD and IDA have created thematic networks in order to develop connec- tions among communities of staff members who work in the same fields of development and to link these staff members more effectively with partners outside the Bank. The networks help draw out lessons learned across coun- tries and regions, and they help bring global best practices to bear in meeting country-specific needs. Each of the thematic networks covers several related sectors of develop- ment. In organizational terms, a subunit is generally dedicated to each sector. Each sector has its own board, with representatives drawn from the regions as well as from the network itself. The sector boards are accountable to a network council. Sector boards also identify themes--topics in development that are narrower than the work of the sector itself--on which a small number of staff members will focus, often in partnership with other organizations. How the World Bank Group Is Organized 35 IFC and MIGA are organized along similar lines, with work divided among sectors (or "industry departments" within IFC) and subsectors. A cen- tral function of this arrangement is to create coherent sector strategies for all the Bank Group's work in a given aspect of development. Networks and sec- tors have also created advisory services or help desks to field queries from Bank Group staff members--and, in most cases, from members of the gen- eral public--in their areas of expertise. The sectoral programs correspond broadly to the sections in chapter 4, which provides information on many sector programs within the World Bank and within the corresponding industry departments or other units of IFC. Within the Bank, the thematic networks and the sectors they cover are as follows: Financial and Private Sector Development Network. The sectors are bank- ing, capital markets, financial services, credit, and regulatory reforms. Some of these sectors are handled by joint World Bank­IFC units. Human Development Network. The sectors are education; health, nutri- tion, and population; and social protection. Operations Policy and Country Services. The sectors are procurement, finan- cial management, operational services, and the Country Services Panel. Poverty Reduction and Economic Management Network. The sectors are eco- nomic policy, gender, governance and public sector reform, and poverty. Sustainable Development Network. The sectors are water and sanitation, energy and mining, environment, rural development, urban transport, social development, and other infrastructure. IFC sectors (or industry departments) and subsectors include the following: Agribusiness: The subsectors are aquaculture; beverages; dairy; fruits and vegetables; grains; livestock processing; oilseed, vegetable fats, and edible oils; processed food; sugar; and other. Global Financial Markets: The subsectors are Africa MSME finance, banking, business linkages, consumer finance, distressed assets, factoring, financial infrastructure, housing finance, IDA-IFC, insurance, leasing, microfinance, securities markets, and trade finance. Global Manufacturing and Services: The subsectors are building materials and glass; electronics, machinery, and appliances; forest products; life sci- ences; metals; retail, hotels, and property development; plastics and fibers; and transport equipment. Health and Education: The subsectors for health are facilities, pharmaceu- ticals, e-health, insurance, ancillary services, and education and training. 36 A Guide to the World Bank The subsectors for education are primary and secondary, tertiary, and e-learning. Infrastructure: The subsectors are airlines, airports, buses, logistics, ports, ports services, power, railways, shipping, toll services, and water and gas. Private Equity and Investment Funds Additionally, the Global Information and Communication Technologies Department and the Oil, Gas, Mining, and Chemicals Department are joint World Bank and IFC departments. Sectors within MIGA include the following: Agribusiness, Manufacturing, Services, and Tourism Finance Infrastructure Oil, Gas, and Mining Other organizational units have adopted certain features of a network. They include the Information Solutions Network, which comprises all staff members working in the field of information technology; CommNet (Com- munications Network), an association of professionals across Bank Group headquarters and country offices who handle communications, issues man- agement, and constituency relations; and the Administrative and Client Sup- port Network, which comprises all staff members in office support positions. Other Major World Bank Group Units and Activities The following paragraphs describe other major units of the World Bank Group. These may be VPUs or the equivalent. Note that a single unit han- dles some functions for all Bank Group organizations, whereas in other cases each organization has separate units. Note also that this list is not intended to be comprehensive. For more information about World Bank Group organizational units, go to http://www.worldbank.org/about (click on "Organization"), http://www.ifc.org, http://www.miga.org, and http:// www.worldbank.org/icsid/. Corporate Secretariat This unit supports the day-to-day operations of the Boards of Directors of the World Bank Group. It is responsible for the administration of matters connected with membership, including the Annual Meetings of the Boards How the World Bank Group Is Organized 37 of Governors and capital subscriptions. It also provides support to the inde- pendent Inspection Panel (see the subsection entitled "Independent Evalua- tion Group"). Development Economics The chief economist heads this main research unit of the World Bank. The unit provides data, analyses of development prospects, research findings, ana- lytical tools, and policy advice in support of Bank operations as well as advice to clients. More information on Bank Group research and data appears in chapter 2. IFC's chief economist is also the World Bank and IFC vice president for the Financial and Private Sector Development VPU. External Affairs External Affairs at the World Bank manages communications, issues man- agement, and constituency relations; handles relations with the public, the media and other organizations, governments of donor countries, and the local Washington, DC, community; arranges speaking engagements for Bank rep- resentatives; produces and disseminates publications; coordinates the Bank's worldwide network of PICs; and maintains the Bank's external Web site. Pro- grams include Development Communications and CommNet. The Bank's offices in Brussels, Geneva, London, New York, Paris, Rome, and Tokyo are part of this unit. IFC and MIGA each maintain a corporate relations unit. Financial Management The Bank Group's chief financial officer is responsible for the finance and risk management functions for the World Bank Group. Three vice presi- dencies within IBRD and IDA report directly to the Bank Group chief finan- cial officer: Concessional Finance and Global Partnerships, which oversees the mobiliza- tion of funds for IDA and key environmental and debt relief initiatives; man- ages trust funds and development grants; and is responsible for interaction with bilateral partners, multilateral development banks, and foundations. Controllers, Strategy, and Resource Management, which oversees the Account- ing and Loan departments as well as the strategic allocation of resources across the Bank. 38 A Guide to the World Bank Treasury, which oversees capital markets and financial engineering, asset and liability management, technical assistance to borrowing countries, financial products and services, and investment management. Two departments within IBRD and IDA also report directly to the Bank Group's chief financial officer: Corporate Finance and Credit Risk. In addition, the Bank Group's chief financial officer is responsible for sign- ing off on the financial policies of the finance and risk management functions within IFC and MIGA. IFC groups the following units under its Risk Management Vice Presi- dency: Business Risk Group, Controller's Budgeting, Corporate Business Informatics, Corporate Portfolio Management, Credit Review, Financial Operations, Risk Management and Financial Policy, and Special Operations. In MIGA, the following units report directly to the executive vice presi- dent: Operations, Legal, Finance and Risk Management, Economics and Policy, and External Outreach and Partnerships. General Services This unit is responsible for the design and maintenance of office space; pro- curement of goods and services; translation and interpretation; security; travel and shipping support; printing and graphic design; and mail, messen- ger, and food services. IFC and MIGA handle some of these responsibilities through their own offices for facilities management and administration. Human Resources This unit manages all personnel issues, including providing information on job opportunities and internships. The World Bank and IFC have separate human resources VPUs, and in MIGA, the Office of Central Administration handles human resources. The World Bank human resources VPU conducts orientations for all new Bank Group staff members and operates a staff exchange program. This program arranges temporary secondment of Bank Group staff members and staff members of participating companies and organizations. The program enhances the professional and technical skills of participating individuals and promotes cultural exchange, fresh perspectives, and diversity for the institutions involved. Separate from these human resources units is the Bank Group's Conflict Resolution System, a group of independent offices that address problems in the workplace, such as ethical issues and disputes regarding staff rules, pay, career advancement, and bene- How the World Bank Group Is Organized 39 fits. In addition to these units, the World Bank Group Staff Association, an independent, voluntary organization, advocates for the rights and welfare of staff members. Independent Evaluation Group The Independent Evaluation Group is an independent unit that reports directly to the Board of Executive Directors. Led by the Independent Evalu- ation Group's director general, the unit is tasked with assessing the results of all of the Bank Group's work and offering relevant recommendations. Sep- arate units of the Independent Evaluation Group work with the Bank, IFC, and MIGA. The group undertakes its work during the evaluation phase of all World Bank Group projects, as outlined in chapter 2. The unit also sup- ports the development of evaluation capacity in recipient countries. Other units with related missions include the Compliance Advisor/ Ombudsman for IFC and MIGA; the Office of Ethics and Business Con- duct, which deals with joint Bank and IFC units; and the Quality Assurance Group at the World Bank. In addition, the World Bank has set up the independent Inspection Panel, a three-member body to whom citizens of developing countries can bring their concerns if they believe that they or their interests have been or could be directly harmed by a project financed by the World Bank. Information Solutions Group This unit builds and operates the Bank Group's infrastructure for informa- tion and communications technologies. It falls under the direction of the chief information officer, who is also responsible for library oversight. IFC has a separate unit to provide support in this area. Institutional Integrity Department The Institutional Integrity Department investigates allegations of fraud, cor- ruption, coercion, and collusion related to Bank-financed projects and Bank Group operations. It also investigates allegations of serious staff misconduct. In addition to investigations, the department also helps improve compliance with World Bank policies and prevent corruption by a variety of means, including training staff to detect and deter fraud and corruption in Bank Group projects and to improve control and compliance systems. As of February 2007, the Institutional Integrity Department had investigated and closed more than 40 A Guide to the World Bank 2,400 cases since 1999. It has also sanctioned 355 firms and individuals for fraud and corruption in Bank-financed projects since 1999. The department publishes an annual integrity report with aggregate data, outcomes, and generic descriptions of significant cases. To ensure the independence of its activities, the director of the Institutional Integrity Department reports directly to the president of the World Bank Group. Legal The World Bank, IFC, and MIGA have separate legal VPUs, each headed by its own general counsel. Each of these units provides legal services for its respective institution and helps ensure that all activities comport with the institution's charter, policies, and rules. The focus includes legal and judicial reform in developing countries. Office of the President This office provides support to the World Bank Group president and main- tains information on the president's speeches, interviews, and travels. World Bank Institute The World Bank Institute (WBI) is the main capacity development unit of the World Bank. WBI helps Bank clients develop capacity through thematic learning events, technical assistance, and economic and sector work. Its activ- ities include holding training courses, offering policy consultations, and sup- porting knowledge networks related to international development. WBI's focus includes distance learning and other innovative uses of technology for education and training. WBI works in close collaboration with Bank opera- tions staff and other partners to design and deliver customized country pro- grams, to provide global and regional activities that address key sectoral issues that go beyond country boundaries, and to develop diagnostic tools to assess countries' capacity needs. Relationship to the IMF and the UN The World Bank Group is an independent specialized agency of the UN and works in particularly close cooperation with another independent specialized UN agency, the IMF. This section explains these relationships (see also the history timeline in appendix B). How the World Bank Group Is Organized 41 The Bretton Woods Institutions The World Bank and the IMF were both created in 1944 at a conference of world leaders in Bretton Woods, New Hampshire, with the aim of placing the international economy on a sound footing after World War II. As a result of their shared origin, the two entities--the IMF and the expanded World Bank Group--are sometimes referred to collectively as the Bretton Woods institutions. The Bank Group and the IMF--which came into formal exis- tence in 1945--work closely together, have similar governance structures, have a similar relationship with the UN, and are headquartered in close prox- imity in Washington, DC. Indeed, membership in the Bank Group organi- zations is open only to countries that are already members of the IMF. However, the Bank Group and the IMF remain separate institutions. Their work is complementary, but their individual roles are quite different. Key differences between the work of the World Bank Group and that of the IMF include the following: The Bank Group lends only to developing or transition economies, whereas all member countries, rich or poor, can draw on the IMF's services and resources. The IMF's loans address short-term economic problems: they provide general support for a country's balance of payments and international reserves while the country takes policy action to address its difficulties. The Bank Group is concerned mainly with longer-term issues: it seeks to inte- grate countries into the wider world economy and to promote economic growth that reduces poverty. The IMF focuses on the macroeconomic performance of economies, as well as on macroeconomic and financial sector policy. The Bank Group's focus extends further into the particular sectors of a country's economy and its work includes specific development projects as well as broader policy issues. There are a few joint Bank Group and IMF units, including the Library Network; Health Services; and the Bank/Fund Conferences Office, which plans and coordinates the Annual and Spring Meetings. The staff members of the two institutions have formed the joint Bank-Fund Staff Federal Credit Union, but this entity is independent of the institutions themselves. The Development Committee and the International Monetary and Financial Committee The Development Committee is a forum of the Bank Group and the IMF that facilitates intergovernmental consensus building on development issues. 42 A Guide to the World Bank Known formally as the Joint Ministerial Committee of the Boards of the Bank and Fund on the Transfer of Real Resources to Developing Countries, the committee was established in 1974. The committee's mandate is to advise the Boards of Governors of the two institutions on critical development issues and on the financial resources required to promote economic development in developing countries. Over time, the committee has interpreted this mandate to include trade and global environmental issues in addition to traditional development matters. The committee has 24 members, usually ministers of finance and devel- opment, who represent the full membership of the Bank Group and the IMF. They are appointed by each of the countries--or groups of countries-- represented on the Boards of Executive Directors of the two institutions. The chair is selected from among the committee's members and is assisted by an exec- utive secretary elected by the committee. The Development Committee meets twice a year. For more information see http://www.worldbank.org/devcom. The International Monetary and Financial Committee has a similar struc- ture, selection process for members, and schedule for meetings. It serves in an advisory role to the IMF Board of Governors; however, unlike the Development Committee, the International Monetary and Financial Committee is solely an IMF entity. Annual and Spring Meetings Each September or October, the Boards of Governors of the World Bank Group and the IMF hold joint Annual Meetings to discuss a range of issues related to poverty reduction, international economic development, and finance. These meetings provide a forum for international cooperation and enable the two institutions to serve their member countries more effectively. In addition, the Development Committee and the International Monetary and Financial Committee are officially convened. These meetings have traditionally been held in Washington, DC, two years out of three and in a different member country every third year. Recent meet- ings outside Washington, DC, have taken place in Prague, the Czech Repub- lic (2000); Dubai, the United Arab Emirates (2003); and Singapore (2006). The Bank Group and the IMF organize a number of forums around these meetings to facilitate interaction by government officials and Bank Group and IMF staff members with CSO and private sector representatives and with journalists. The Development Committee and the International Monetary and Finan- cial Committee also meet in March or April of each year to discuss progress How the World Bank Group Is Organized 43 on the work of the Bank Group and the IMF. As with the Annual Meetings, a number of activities are organized at these Spring Meetings to involve the press, CSOs, and the private sector. However, plenary sessions of the two insti- tutions' Boards of Governors are scheduled only during the Annual Meetings in September or October. Specialized Agency of the United Nations Cooperation between the Bank Group and the UN has been in place since the founding of the two organizations (in 1944 and 1945, respectively) and focuses on economic and social areas of mutual concern, such as reducing poverty, promoting sustainable development, and investing in people. In addition to a shared agenda, the Bank Group and the UN have almost the same membership: only a handful of UN member countries are not mem- bers of IBRD. The World Bank's formal relationship with the UN is defined by a 1947 agreement that recognizes the Bank (now the Bank Group) as an indepen- dent specialized agency of the UN and as an observer in many UN bodies, including the General Assembly. As an independent specialized agency, the Bank Group officially falls under the purview of the Economic and Social Council. In recent years, the Economic and Social Council has conducted a special high-level meeting with the Bretton Woods institutions immediately after the Spring Meetings of the Bank Group and the IMF. The Bank Group president is also a member of the UN System Chief Executives Board for Coordination, which meets twice annually. In addition, the Bank Group plays a key role in supporting UN-led processes, such as the International Conference on Financing for Development and the World Summit on Sus- tainable Development. It also provides knowledge about country-level chal- lenges and helps formulate international policy recommendations. In terms of operations, the Bank Group works with other UN funds and programs to coordinate policies, aid, and project implementation. It also helps prepare for and participates in most of the UN's global conferences and plays an important role in follow-up, especially in relation to the implemen- tation of goals at the country level. Further information on the Bank Group's collaboration with UN agen- cies can be found under "Partnerships" in chapter 2. The World Bank Treasury trading room in Washington, DC. IBRD, which facilitates more than half of the World Bank's annual lending, raises money primarily by selling bonds in international financial markets. 2How the World Bank Group Operates This chapter covers the basics of Bank Group operations, many aspects of which are interconnected. The chapter is organized as follows: Strategies. This section explains the Bank Group's overall framework for its fight against poverty as well as strategies that are pertinent to individual countries and specific sectors of development. Policies and Procedures. This section provides an overview of the policies and procedures that the Bank Group has estab- lished for its operations to help ensure quality and fairness in its projects. The Bank Group's Finances. This section offers a quick primer on how the Bank Group institutions are funded and what they do with their money. Financial Products and Services. This section describes the financial products and services offered by World Bank Group institutions. Knowledge Sharing. This section describes the knowledge-sharing services that the Bank Group provides in support of develop- ment and poverty reduction activities. World Bank Project Cycle. This section covers the typical phases of a World Bank project, the documentation that each phase creates, and the resources for locating detailed information about Bank projects. IFC Project Cycle. This section covers the typical phases of an IFC project. Partnerships. This section provides an overview of the types of partners the Bank Group works with, including affiliates whose secretariats are located at Bank Group headquarters. Staff, Consultants, and Vendors. This section provides details about the Bank Group's staff and related opportunities: job openings, internships, and scholarships. It also provides links to basic information on doing business with the Bank Group. 45 46 A Guide to the World Bank Strategies This section covers the main strategies guiding the work of the Bank Group. More information on strategies can be found online at http://www. developmentgoals.org. Millennium Development Goals The MDGs (box 2.1) identify--and quantify--specific gains that could be made to improve the lives of the world's poor people. Their aim is to reduce poverty while improving health, education, and the environment. These goals were endorsed by 189 countries at the September 2000 UN Mil- lennium General Assembly in New York. They focus on significant, mea- surable improvements for the efforts of the World Bank Group, other multilateral organizations, governments, and other partners in the develop- ment community. The MDGs grew out of the agreements and resolutions that have resulted from world conferences organized by the UN in the past 10­15 years. Each goal is to be achieved by 2015, with progress to be measured by comparison with 1990 levels. Although the goals are sometimes numbered, the numbers are not intended to indicate any differences of priority or urgency. The goals establish yardsticks for measuring results, not just for developing countries but also for the high-income countries that help fund development programs and for the multilateral institutions that help countries implement these programs. The first seven goals are mutually reinforcing and are directed at reducing poverty in all its forms. The last goal--to develop a global partner- ship for development--is directed at the means to achieve the first seven. Many of the poorest countries will need assistance if the MDGs are to be achieved, and countries that are both poor and heavily indebted will need further help in order to reduce their debt burdens. But providing assistance isn't limited to providing financial aid. Developing countries may also ben- efit if trade barriers are lowered, thereby allowing a freer exchange of goods and services. Achieving the goals is an enormous challenge. Partnerships between the Bank Group, the UN Development Group (UNDG), and other organiza- tions, as well as between donors and developing countries, are the only way to ensure coordinated and complementary efforts. The UNDG consists of the many UN programs, funds, and agencies engaged in development assistance and related activities. The Bank Group participates in the UNDG and sup- ports its framework for greater coherence and cooperation in UN develop- ment operations. How the World Bank Group Operates 47 Box 2.1 Millennium Development Goals (MDGs) Goals and Targets from the Millennium Declaration GOAL 1 ERADICATE EXTREME POVERTY AND HUNGER TARGET 1 Halve, between 1990 and 2015, the proportion of people whose income is less than $1 a day TARGET 2 Halve, between 1990 and 2015, the proportion of people who suffer from hunger GOAL 2 ACHIEVE UNIVERSAL PRIMARY EDUCATION TARGET 3 Ensure that by 2015, children everywhere, boys and girls alike, will be able to complete a full course of primary schooling GOAL 3 PROMOTE GENDER EQUALITY AND EMPOWER WOMEN TARGET 4 Eliminate gender disparity in primary and secondary educa- tion, preferably by 2005, and at all levels of education no later than 2015 GOAL 4 REDUCE CHILD MORTALITY TARGET 5 Reduce by two-thirds, between 1990 and 2015, the under-five mortality rate GOAL 5 IMPROVE MATERNAL HEALTH TARGET 6 Reduce by three-quarters, between 1990 and 2015, the mater- nal mortality ratio GOAL 6 COMBAT HIV/AIDS, MALARIA, AND OTHER DISEASES TARGET 7 Have halted by 2015 and begun to reverse the spread of HIV/AIDS TARGET 8 Have halted by 2015 and begun to reverse the incidence of malaria and other major diseases GOAL 7 ENSURE ENVIRONMENTAL SUSTAINABILITY TARGET 9 Integrate the principles of sustainable development into coun- try policies and programs and reverse the loss of environmen- tal resources TARGET 10 Halve by 2015 the proportion of people without sustainable access to safe drinking water and basic sanitation TARGET 11 Have achieved a significant improvement by 2020 in the lives of at least 100 million slum dwellers (continued) 48 A Guide to the World Bank Box 2.1 continued GOAL 8 DEVELOP A GLOBAL PARTNERSHIP FOR DEVELOPMENT TARGET 12 Develop further an open, rule-based, predictable, nondiscrim- inatory trading and financial system (including a commitment to good governance, development, and poverty reduction, nationally and internationally) TARGET 13 Address the special needs of the least developed countries (including tariff- and quota-free access for exports of the least developed countries; enhanced debt relief for heavily indebted poor countries and cancellation of official bilateral debt; and more generous official development assistance for countries committed to reducing poverty) TARGET 14 Address the special needs of landlocked countries and small island developing states (through the Programme of Action for the Sustainable Development of Small Island Developing States and the outcome of the 22nd special session of the General Assembly) TARGET 15 Deal comprehensively with the debt problems of developing countries through national and international measures to make debt sustainable in the long term TARGET 16 In cooperation with developing countries, develop and imple- ment strategies for decent and productive work for youth TARGET 17 In cooperation with pharmaceutical companies, provide access to affordable, essential drugs in developing countries TARGET 18 In cooperation with the private sector, make available the benefits of new technologies, especially information and communication Source: United Nations 2000, 2001. Note: The Millennium Development Goals and targets come from the Millennium Declaration signed by 189 countries, including 147 heads of state, in September 2000. The goals and targets are related and should be seen as a whole. They represent a partnership of countries determined, as the Declaration states, "to create an environment--at the national and global levels alike--which is conducive to development and the elimination of poverty." Since 2004, the World Bank--in partnership with the IMF--has pub- lished the Global Monitoring Report, which monitors the performance of donor countries, developing countries, and international financial institu- tions in delivering on their commitments to support achievement of the MDGs. The report reviews key developments in the previous year, discusses How the World Bank Group Operates 49 priority emerging issues, and assesses performance. For more information about this report, go to http://www.worldbank.org/globalmonitoring. In 2007, the World Bank launched the Online Atlas of Millennium Development Goals, which includes a complete set of indicators for the MDGs, interactive world maps, graphs, and links to related Web sites. It contains a range of data for more than 200 economies. Visit http://devdata. worldbank.org/atlas-mdg. For the Bank Group, as for other agencies, the challenge of implementing the MDGs provides a starting point for all operations. The Web site of the MDGs is http://www.developmentgoals.org. Strategic Framework The Bank Group's strategic framework concentrates on the twin pillars of (1) building an appropriate climate for investment, jobs, and sustainable growth so that economies will grow and of (2) investing in and empowering poor people to participate in development. In recent years, the executive directors have underscored the continued relevance of these priorities, have reaffirmed the need for selectivity in the Bank Group's work, and have called for greater collaboration with development partners. The executive directors have reviewed a number of progress reports on ongoing efforts to harmonize operational policies, procedures, and practices among donors; on meeting the needs of low-income countries, including heavily indebted poor countries and fragile states; and on strengthening partnerships with middle-income countries. They have also stressed the need for the Bank Group to intensify its efforts in implementing the strategic framework by refining the tools and procedures for meeting the development challenges set forth in the MDGs. Thematic and Sector Strategies Thematic and sector strategies address cross-cutting facets of poverty reduc- tion, such as HIV/AIDS, the environment, and participation in and decen- tralization of government. In addition, these strategies serve as a guide for future work in a given sector, and they help in assessing the appropriateness and impact of related Bank Group policies. The strategies are revised on a rolling basis through extensive consultation with a wide variety of stake- holders. The process helps to build consensus within the Bank Group and to strengthen relationships with external partners. Figures 2.1 and 2.2 present overall shares of lending by theme and sector for the World Bank, figure 2.3 presents IFC investment projects by industry, and figure 2.4 presents overall shares of MIGA guarantees by sector. 50 A Guide to the World Bank Figure 2.1 Total IBRD-IDA Lending by Theme, Fiscal 2006 Share of total lending of $23.6 billion Financial & Private Rule of Law 3% 26% Sector Development Public Sector Governance 16% 7% Trade & Integration Environmental & Natural 6% Resource Management Economic Management 1% 8% Urban Development Social Protection & Risk Management 8% 9% Rural Development Social Development, Gender & Inclusion 5% 11% Human Development Source: World Bank 2006. Figure 2.2 Total IBRD-IDA Lending by Sector, Fiscal 2006 Share of total lending of $23.6 billion Industry & Trade 7% 8% Education Energy & Mining 13% 10% Finance Water, Sanitation 7% & Flood Protection Transportation 14% Agriculture, Fishing 7% & Forestry Health & Other Social Services 9% Information & Law & Justice Communication <1% 25% & Public Administration Source: World Bank 2006. How the World Bank Group Operates 51 Figure 2.3 IFC Investment Projects by Industry, Fiscal 2006 Total of $8.3 billion committed for IFC's own account and mobilized through syndicated loans Other 7.4% Collective Investment Vehicles 3.7% 33.2% Finance & Insurance Information Technology 4.1% Primary Metals 4.6% Pulp & Paper 5.1% Chemicals 5.4% 9.6% Utilities Food & Beverages 5.9% Nonmetallic Mineral Product Manufacturing 6.1% Transportation & Warehousing 6.8% 8.1% Oil, Gas & Mining Source: IFC 2006. Figure 2.4 MIGA Guarantees Issued by Sector, Fiscal 2006 Percent of gross income as of June 30, 2006 32.8% Oil, Gas & Mining Infrastructure 36.0% 8.0% Tourism and Services Agribusiness, Manufacturing Financial 18.3% 5.0% & Construction Source: MIGA 2006. 52 A Guide to the World Bank Many sector strategies are posted on the World Bank's Web sites and some of the published findings are available for purchase online (http://publications. worldbank.org/ecommerce/). Comprehensive Development Framework The Comprehensive Development Framework, adopted in January 1999, is an approach to development whereby countries become the leaders and owners of their own development and poverty reduction policies. It emphasizes the inter- dependence of all aspects of development: social, structural, human, gover- nance related, environmental, economic, and financial. It also aims to correct the historical shortcomings of many aid programs, which often were imple- mented with a limited focus and with little support in the affected countries. Specifically, the Comprehensive Development Framework advocates a holistic, long-term strategy with the country taking the lead, both own- ing and directing the development agenda, while the Bank Group and other partners each define their support in their respective business plans; the development of stronger partnerships between governments, donors, civil society, the private sector, and other development stakeholders in implementing the country strategy; and a transparent focus on accountability for development results to ensure better practical success in reducing poverty. The Comprehensive Development Framework is not a blueprint to be applied to all countries in a uniform manner, but a new way of doing busi- ness to make development efforts more effective in a world challenged by poverty and distress. The related Web site is http://www.worldbank.org/cdf. Poverty Reduction Strategies Poverty reduction strategies represent the tangible outcomes of the approach defined by the Comprehensive Development Framework. In contrast to past approaches, which were applied to countries by donor organizations, developing countries now write their own strategies for reducing poverty (box 2.2). The resulting Poverty Reduction Strategy Papers (PRSPs) then become the basis for IDA lending from the World Bank, for comparable lending from the IMF's Poverty Reduction and Growth Facility, and for debt relief under the Heavily Indebted Poor Countries (HIPC) Initiative. A PRSP is an annually updated document that a country prepares in col- laboration with the Bank and the IMF. The PRSP is expected to be compre- How the World Bank Group Operates 53 hensive in scope and partnership oriented, with civil society and the private sector participating in its preparation. The PRSP describes the country's plans to foster growth and reduce poverty through three-year economic adjustment programs that include macroeconomic, structural, and social policies. In addi- tion, it describes associated external financing needs and major sources of financing. The World Bank has produced A Sourcebook for Poverty Reduction Strategies, with chapters that address the various sectors of development, as a resource to help countries prepare their PRSPs. A PDF version of this volume is available for free online (http://www.worldbank.org/prsp), as well as in book form for purchase (http://publications.worldbank.org/ecommerce/). When preparing its PRSP, a country can submit an interim PRSP to avoid delays in receiving assistance. The interim document must take stock of a coun- Box 2.2 Poverty Reduction Strategies: Key Steps No blueprint is available for building all countries' poverty reduction strate- gies. Rather, the process reflects countries' individual circumstances and characteristics. Recommended features of PRSPs include the following: Description of the participatory process. The PRSP will describe the format, frequency, and location of consultations; summarize the main issues raised and the views of participants; provide an account of the impact of the con- sultations on the design of the strategy; and discuss the role of civil society in future monitoring and implementation. Comprehensive poverty diagnostics. A good understanding of the poor and where they live allows the PRSP to analyze the macroeconomic, social, structural, and institutional constraints to faster growth and poverty reduction. Clearly presented and costed priorities for macroeconomic, structural, and social policies. In light of a deeper understanding of poverty and its causes, the PRSP will set out the macroeconomic, structural, and social policies that together comprise a comprehensive strategy for achieving poverty- reducing outcomes. Policies will be costed and prioritized as far as possible so that they do not become just a "wish list." Appropriate targets, indicators, and systems for monitoring and evaluating progress. The PRSP will define medium- and long-term goals for poverty reduction outcomes (monetary and nonmonetary), establish indicators of progress, and set annual and medium-term targets. The indicators and targets will be consistent with the assessment of poverty, the institutional capacity to monitor, and the strategy's policy choices. 54 A Guide to the World Bank try's current poverty reduction strategy and must lay out a road map of how the country is going to develop its complete PRSP. On receiving the interim or final document, the World Bank and IMF conduct a joint staff assessment, which helps the boards of the institutions judge whether the document pro- vides a sound basis on which to proceed with assistance and debt relief. Country Assistance Strategies Country Assistance Strategies (CASs) identify the key areas in which Bank Group support can best assist a country in achieving sustainable development and poverty reduction. They are the central vehicle used by the executive directors to review and guide the Bank Group's support for borrowers from IBRD and IDA. Each CAS includes a comprehensive diagnosis--drawing on analytic work by the Bank Group, the government, and other partners--of the development challenges facing the country, including the incidence, trends, and causes of poverty. From this assessment, the level and composi- tion of Bank Group financial, advisory, and technical support to the country is determined. So that implementation of the CAS program can be tracked, CASs are increasingly results focused. Thus, each CAS includes a framework of clear targets and indicators that are used to monitor Bank Group and country performance in achieving stated outcomes. The key elements of the CAS are discussed with the country's government and often with civil society representatives before the CAS is considered by the Board; however, it is not a negotiated document. Any differences between the country's own agenda and the strategy advocated by the Bank Group are highlighted in the CAS. Even though the country owns its development strat- egy as outlined in the PRSP, the Bank Group provides the CAS to its share- holders specifically to account for its diagnosis of a country's development situation and for the programs it supports. Some CASs are publicly available. More information on the purpose, process, and content of CASs--as well as a CAS calendar--can be found at http://www.worldbank.org/cas. IFC and Private Sector Development Strategies IFC's Operational Strategy Department produces an annual Strategic Direc- tions Paper, which reviews IFC's external environment, assesses the progress it has made in implementing its strategic priorities, and sets out goals to be achieved in order to increase development impact. The paper is available at http://www.ifc.org/disclosure. How the World Bank Group Operates 55 The World Bank Group also has a private sector development strategy that includes activities undertaken by IFC, MIGA, and some World Bank units. The lead unit in this area is the joint World Bank and IFC Financial and Private Sector Development Vice Presidency. Policies and Procedures The World Bank Group has established policies and procedures to help ensure that its operations are economically, financially, socially, and environmentally sound. Each operation must follow these policies and procedures to ensure quality, integrity, and adherence to the Bank Group's mission, corporate pri- orities, and strategic goals. These policies and procedures--including rigorous safeguard policies on projects affecting, for example, women, the environment, and indigenous peoples--are codified in the World Bank's "Operational Man- ual." They are subject to extensive review while being formulated and to com- pliance monitoring after being approved. Operational Manual The World Bank's "Operational Manual" is available online at http://www. worldbank.org/opmanual. Volume I deals with the Bank's core development objectives and goals and the instruments for pursuing them. Volume II cov- ers the requirements applicable to Bank-financed lending operations. The manual includes several different kinds of operational statements: operational policies, Bank procedures, good practices, and operational directives. Policy definitions and documentation Operational Policies are short, focused statements that follow from the Bank's Articles of Agreement and the general conditions and policies approved by the Board of Executive Directors. They establish the parame- ters for conducting operations, describe the circumstances in which excep- tions to policy are admissible, and spell out who authorizes exceptions. Bank Procedures explain how staff members carry out the operational policies by describing the procedures and documentation required to ensure con- sistency and quality across the Bank. Good Practices are statements that contain advice and guidance on policy implementation, such as the history of an issue, the sectoral context, and the analytical framework, along with examples of good practice. Although they may be included in the manual, good practices are generally maintained and made available by the Bank units responsible for specific policies. Operational Directives contain a 56 A Guide to the World Bank mixture of policies, procedures, and guidance; however, they are gradually being replaced by the operational policies, Bank procedures, and good practices. Environmental and social safeguard policies Environmental and social safeguard policies help to ensure that Bank oper- ations assist, rather than harm, people and the environment. The Bank has 10 environmental and social safeguard policies, which consist of a policy on environmental assessments followed by 9 related policies that fall within the scope of the first. These 9 policies cover natural habitats, pest management, involuntary resettlement, indigenous peoples, forests, cultural resources, dam safety, international waterways, and disputed areas. The Bank conducts environmental screening of each proposed project to determine the appropriate extent and type of environmental assessment to be undertaken and to ascertain whether the project may trigger other safeguard policies. The Bank classifies the proposed project into one of four categories (A, B, C, and FI) depending on the type, location, sensitivity, and scale of the project and the nature and magnitude of its potential environmental impact. Category A requires the project to undergo the most comprehensive environmental assessment, category B requires a narrower assessment, and category C requires no environmental assessment. A project classified as A, B, or C can trigger other safeguard policies, in which case additional assess- ments related to those specific policies are required. Category FI identifies subprojects that are funded by the Bank through financial intermediaries and that may affect the environment adversely. Assessments provide mechanisms for public review and scrutiny. The bor- rower is responsible for any assessment required by the safeguard policies, with general assistance provided by Bank staff members. The Bank's Legal Vice Presidency monitors compliance with the policies addressing inter- national waterways and disputed areas. Policy formulation and review The Bank's Operations Policy and Country Services Vice Presidency re- views, updates, and formulates policies and procedures that govern the Bank's operations. Proposals for policy revisions or new policies respond to the strategic priorities set by the Bank's management and Board. Formula- tion or review of a policy entails bringing together experienced regional and How the World Bank Group Operates 57 network staff members, legal experts, and policy writers. If the policy or pro- posed revision is complex, the task may entail an iterative process of con- sultation inside and outside the Bank (including with internal experts, clients, external experts and partners such as CSOs, and the public). Fol- lowing the consultation process, a final draft, usually accompanied by an explanatory paper, is submitted for comment and approval to the appropri- ate management group, the Bank's managing directors, and the Board of Executive Directors. Recent policy and procedural reforms have included revisions of the Bank's audit policy, the policy on the eligibility of expenditures, the pro- curement guidelines, and the Bank's policy on development policy lending, and a new policy on additional financing for investment lending. Compliance monitoring The Bank's credibility rests on effective implementation of its policies. The mission of Operations Policy and Country Services is to enhance the Bank's operational effectiveness. Operations Policy and Country Services supports and advises World Bank staff and management on a wide range of opera- tional areas, from preparing and implementing lending and nonlending pro- grams to applying policies and procedures in Bank priority areas. It works in collaboration with the Bank's other vice presidencies and with other World Bank Group organizations. The Bank has also set up the Inspection Panel, an independent forum for private citizens who believe that their rights or interests have been or could be directly harmed by a Bank-financed project. If people living in a project area believe that harm has resulted from, or will result from, a failure by the Bank to follow its policies and procedures, they or a representative may request a review of the project by the Inspection Panel. The panel's Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/inspectionpanel. Disclosure of information The Bank has established its disclosure policy to support important goals: to be open about its activities, to explain its work to the widest possible audi- ence, and to promote overall accountability and transparency in the devel- opment process. The Bank seeks to provide balanced information, reporting, and learning drawn from both operational failures or disappointments and successes. 58 A Guide to the World Bank Recent extensions of the disclosure policy include the release of a greater number of project-related documents, the disclosure of the chair's summaries of Board discussions regarding CASs and Sector Strategy Papers, and the development of a more systematic approach to accessing Bank archives. Coun- try Policy and Institutional Assessment scores--which assess the quality of a country's policy and institutional framework--have been publicly disclosed since the summer of 2006. The Bank continues to review the provisions and implementation of its disclosure policy on a regular basis. More about dis- closure is available at http://www.worldbank.org//disclosure. Fiduciary policies The Bank's fiduciary policies, set forth in volume II of the "Operational Manual," govern the use and flow of Bank funds, including procurement. The Operations Policy and Country Services Vice Presidency provides guidelines for the procurement of goods and services in Bank projects. The guidelines help ensure that funds are used for their intended purposes and with economy, efficiency, and transparency. They also ensure competitive bidding and help protect Bank-funded projects from fraud and corruption (box 2.3). The procurement policy Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/ procure. Independent firms periodically audit Bank projects to ensure that the pro- curement rules are being followed. Any allegations of fraud or corruption that surface are referred to the Oversight Committee for follow-up, including investigations where appropriate. If the allegations prove to be true, the Bank may terminate the employment of a staff member, debar the firms impli- cated, and cancel the funds allocated to the contract in question. IFC, MIGA, and ICSID Policies The policies and procedures of the World Bank Group apply also to IFC and to MIGA, with some specific variations in guidelines as appropriate to their clients: For links to IFC's disclosure policy and its environmental and social pol- icy and standards, see http://www.ifc.org/disclosure. For a list of MIGA policies, click on "About MIGA" at http://www. miga.org and see "Environmental and Disclosure Policies." ICSID's policies are set forth in its basic documents, additional facility documents, and other documents available at http://www.worldbank.org/ icsid. How the World Bank Group Operates 59 Box 2.3 Reporting Fraud or Corruption The Bank's Department of Institutional Integrity investigates allegations of fraud or corruption in World Bank Group­financed operations, as well as allegations of staff misconduct within the Bank Group. Examples of issues that should be reported to the Department of Institu- tional Integrity for further review include suspected contract irregularities and violations of the Bank's procurement guidelines; bid manipulation; bid collusion; coercive practices; fraudulent bids; fraud in contract perfor- mance; fraud in an audit inquiry; product substitution; price manipulation; use of substandard or inferior parts or materials; cost or labor mischarges; kickbacks, bribery, or acceptance of gratuities; abuse of authority; misuse of Bank Group funds or of funds entrusted to the Bank Group; travel-related fraud; theft and embezzlement; benefits and allowances fraud; conflict of interest; misrepresentation; and forgery and the involvement of Bank Group staff in any of the aforementioned activities. The Department of Institutional Integrity can be contacted via several means: Directly at World Bank headquarters: Telephone: 1-202-458-7677 Fax: 1-202-522-7140 Email: investigations_hotline@worldbank.org Web site: http://www.worldbank.org/integrity Through a fraud and corruption hotline hired by the department for this purpose that is accessible 24 hours a day with translation services available: Toll-free: 1-800-831-0463 Collect calls: 1-704-556-7046 Mail: PMB 3767 13950 Ballantyne Corporate Place Charlotte, NC 28277 USA Anonymous calls are also accepted. The Bank Group's Finances This section provides an overview of how the Bank Group institutions are financed, how they provide assistance in developing countries, and how they report on their finances. More details about Bank Group loans and other assistance follow in the next sections, "Financial Products and Services" and "Knowledge Sharing." 60 A Guide to the World Bank IBRD and IDA Funding and Lending The World Bank finances its development programs by tapping the world's capital markets (in the case of IBRD) and by receiving contributions from wealthier member governments (in the case of IDA). Additionally, specific activities can be funded by donors through trust funds managed by the World Bank. IBRD, which facilitates more than half of the Bank's annual lending, raises money primarily by selling bonds in international financial markets. It sells AAA-rated bonds and other debt securities to pension funds, insurance com- panies, corporations, other banks, and individuals around the world. Addi- tionally, IBRD charges interest to its borrowers at rates that reflect its cost of borrowing. Loans must be repaid in 15 to 20 years, and there is a 3- to 5-year grace period before repayment of principal begins. Less than 5 percent of IBRD's funds are paid in by countries when they join the Bank. Member governments purchase shares, the number of which is based on their relative economic strength, but pay in only a small portion of the value of those shares. The unpaid balance is "on call" in case the Bank should suffer losses so grave that it could no longer pay its creditors--something that, to date, has never happened. This guaranteed capital can be used only to pay bondholders, not to cover administrative costs or to make loans. IBRD's rules require that the sum of all loans outstanding and disbursed not exceed the combined total of capital and reserves. The income that IBRD earns each year from the return on its equity and from the small margin it makes on lending pays for its operating expenses, goes into reserves to strengthen the balance sheet, and is used to fund annual transfers to IDA. Because it is a cooperative institution, IBRD seeks not to maximize profit but to earn enough income to ensure its financial strength and to sustain its development activities. IDA, the world's largest source of interest-free loans and grant assistance to the poorest countries, is replenished every three years by donor countries. Additional funds are regenerated through repayments of loan principal on its 35- to 40-year no-interest loans, and these funds are then available for relend- ing. IDA accounts for nearly 40 percent of World Bank lending. Forty coun- tries contribute to IDA's funding. Donor nations include not only industrial member countries such as France, Germany, Japan, the United Kingdom, and the United States, but also developing countries such as Botswana, Brazil, Hungary, the Republic of Korea, the Russian Federation, and Turkey, some of which were once IDA borrowers. As with IBRD, to date there has never been a default on an IDA credit. How the World Bank Group Operates 61 Cumulative lending by IBRD and IDA as of June 30, 2006, amounted to more than $589 billion (table 2.1). More information on IBRD and IDA product lines and lending instruments follows in the next section, "Financial Products and Services." Grants and loans obtained from cofinanciers and partnerships often complement government funds and World Bank lending to make up the total package of assistance to a country. Funding of IFC, MIGA, and ICSID IFC and MIGA each have share capital that is paid in by member countries, which vote in proportion to the number of shares they hold. IFC makes loans and equity investments. The corporation's equity and quasi-equity investments are funded out of paid-in capital and retained earn- ings from these investments. Strong shareholder support, AAA ratings, and the substantial paid-in capital base have allowed IFC to raise funds for its lending activities on favorable terms in the international capital markets. In addition to its share capital, MIGA receives funding for some of its operating expenses from the World Bank. MIGA also charges fees for the ser- vices it provides. The operating expenses of the ICSID Secretariat are funded through the World Bank's budget, although the parties involved bear the costs of indi- vidual proceedings. Financial Reporting: Bank Group Annual Reports Each Bank Group institution provides detailed financial statements in its annual report. The fiscal year for these institutions runs from July 1 of a given year to June 30 of the following calendar year. The reports catalog financial performance and new activities. They also include comparative information on the regions and development sectors in which the institutions have pro- vided assistance. These reports are available for free to the public, both in print and on the Internet. The reports are published in multiple languages, and the Web sites include past editions. For Web links to the Bank Group's annual reports, see appendix A. Financial Products and Services The World Bank Group is known best for its financial services. The sections below describe the financial products and services provided by World Bank Group institutions. 62 A Guide to the World Bank Table 2.1 IBRD­IDA Cumulative Lending by Country/Region IBRD loans IDA Loans Total Amount Amount Amount ($ mil- ($ mil- ($ mil- Country/region Number lions) Number lions) Number lions) Afghanistan 42 1,353.3 42 1,353.3 Africa 11 259.8 18 1,155.4 29 1,415.2 Albania 59 854.8 59 854.8 Algeria 71 5,765.8 71 5,765.8 Angola 16 487.1 16 487.1 Argentina 130 22,728.2 130 22,728.2 Armenia 1 12.0 41 915.0 42 927.0 Australia 7 417.7 7 417.7 Austria 9 106.4 9 106.4 Azerbaijan 2 248.0 29 779.5 31 1,027.5 Bahamas, The 5 42.8 5 42.8 Bangladesh 1 46.1 189 12,027.1 190 12,073.2 Barbados 12 118.4 12 118.4 Belarus 5 242.8 5 242.8 Belgium 4 76.0 4 76.0 Belize 9 86.2 9 86.2 Benin 59 1,005.5 59 1,005.5 Bhutan 13 123.1 13 123.1 Bolivia 15 314.3 72 1,929.6 87 2,243.9 Bosnia and Herzegovina 0 50 1,039.3 50 1,039.3 Botswana 19 280.7 6 15.8 25 296.5 Brazil 312 37,898.2 312 37,898.2 Bulgaria 32 2,060.5 32 2,060.5 Burkina Faso 0 1.9 70 1,792.6 70 1,794.5 Burundi 1 4.8 56 1,078.2 57 1,083.0 Cambodia 27 659.2 27 659.2 Cameroon 45 1,347.8 33 1,301.7 78 2,649.5 Cape Verde 21 237.9 21 237.9 Caribbean 4 83.0 3 52.0 7 135.0 Central African Republic 27 448.5 27 448.5 Central America 2 42.0 2 42.0 Central Asia 1 25.0 1 25.0 Chad 1 39.5 47 1,041.6 48 1,081.1 Chile 69 4,016.3 19.0 69 4,035.3 China 203 30,976.8 71 9,946.7 274 40,923.5 Colombia 187 13,384.5 19.5 187 13,404.0 Comoros 19 132.4 19 132.4 Congo, Democratic Republic of 7 330.0 70 3,322.5 77 3,652.5 Congo, Republic of 10 216.7 18 383.3 28 600.0 Costa Rica 42 998.5 5.5 42 1,004.0 How the World Bank Group Operates 63 IBRD loans IDA Loans Total Amount Amount Amount ($ mil- ($ mil- ($ mil- Country Number lions) Number lions) Number lions) Côte d'Ivoire 62 2,887.9 25 2,042.5 87 4,930.4 Croatia 31 1,701.2 31 1,701.2 Cyprus 29 404.8 29 404.8 Czech Republic 3 776.0 3 776.0 Denmark 3 85.0 3 85.0 Djibouti 19 172.1 19 172.1 Dominica 3 6.6 4 21.1 7 27.7 Dominican Republic 38 1,263.5 3 22.0 41 1,285.5 Eastern Africa 1 45.0 1 45.0 Ecuador 78 3,113.7 5 36.9 83 3,150.6 Egypt, Arab Republic of 71 5,770.0 41 1,984.0 112 7,754.0 El Salvador 40 1,332.6 2 25.6 42 1,358.2 Equatorial Guinea 9 45.0 9 45.0 Eritrea 14 519.4 14 519.4 Estonia 8 150.7 8 150.7 Ethiopia 12 108.6 88 5,458.1 100 5,566.7 Fiji 12 152.9 12 152.9 Finland 18 316.8 18 316.8 France 1 250.0 1 250.0 Gabon 16 267.0 16 267.0 Gambia, The 29 271.2 29 271.2 Georgia 39 830.8 39 830.8 Ghana 9 187.0 116 5,065.4 125 5,252.4 Greece 17 490.8 17 490.8 Grenada 6 22.0 2 32.0 8 54.1 Guatemala 43 1,583.8 43 1,583.8 Guinea 3 75.2 61 1,388.0 64 1,463.2 Guinea-Bissau 26 314.9 26 314.9 Guyana 12 80.0 22 355.3 34 435.3 Haiti 1 2.6 42 757.5 43 760.1 Honduras 33 717.3 43 1,590.3 76 2,307.6 Hungary 40 4,247.6 40 4,247.6 Iceland 10 47.1 10 47.1 India 202 33,580.4 262 32,097.9 464 65,678.3 Indonesia 264 29,313.9 51 2,110.3 315 31,424.2 Iran, Islamic Republic of 48 3,413.1 48 3,413.1 Iraq 6 156.2 2 235.0 8 391.2 Ireland 8 152.5 8 152.5 Israel 10 254.5 10 254.5 Italy 8 399.6 8 399.6 (continued) 64 A Guide to the World Bank Table 2.1 continued IBRD loans IDA Loans Total Amount Amount Amount ($ mil- ($ mil- ($ mil- Country Number lions) Number lions) Number lions) Jamaica 70 1,690.1 70 1,690.1 Japan 31 862.9 31 862.9 Jordan 57 2,334.7 15 85.3 72 2,420.0 Kazakhstan 27 2,113.0 27 2,113.0 Kenya 45 1,180.7 89 3,757.7 134 4,938.4 Korea, Republic of 112 15,472.0 6 110.8 118 15,582.8 Kosovo 8 35.5 8 35.5 Kyrgyz Republic 36 756.3 36 756.3 Lao People's Democratic Republic 43 835.9 43 835.9 Latvia 19 416.0 19 416.0 Lebanon 21 1,085.4 21 1,085.4 Lesotho 2 155.0 33 378.4 35 533.4 Liberia 19 156.0 15 144.5 34 300.5 Lithuania 17 490.9 17 490.9 Luxembourg 1 12.0 1 12.0 Macedonia, former Yugoslav Republic of 21 442.9 15 378.7 36 821.6 Madagascar 5 32.9 91 2,989.3 96 3,022.2 Malawi 9 124.1 83 2,366.7 92 2,490.8 Malaysia 87 4,145.6 87 4,145.6 Maldives 9 101.5 9 101.5 Mali 0 1.9 74 1,893.2 74 1,895.1 Malta 1 7.5 1 7.5 Mauritania 3 146.0 55 876.0 58 1,022.0 Mauritius 33 459.7 4 20.2 37 479.9 Mexico 205 38,039.8 205 38,039.8 Moldova 9 302.8 20 343.6 29 646.4 Mongolia 24 370.3 24 370.3 Morocco 138 9,378.1 3 50.8 141 9,428.9 Mozambique 55 3,080.5 55 3,080.5 Myanmar 3 33.4 30 804.0 33 837.4 Nepal 83 2,051.9 83 2,051.9 Netherlands 8 244.0 8 244.0 New Zealand 6 126.8 6 126.8 Nicaragua 27 233.6 41 1,322.7 68 1,556.3 Niger 58 1,325.7 58 1,325.7 Nigeria 84 6,248.2 36 2,888.0 120 9,136.2 OECS countries 3 11.8 8.5 3 20.2 Oman 11 157.1 11 157.1 Norway 6 145.0 6 145.0 How the World Bank Group Operates 65 IBRD loans IDA Loans Total Amount Amount Amount ($ mil- ($ mil- ($ mil- Country Number lions) Number lions) Number lions) Pakistan 90 7,326.6 133 9,353.6 223 16,680.2 Panama 45 1,273.2 45 1,273.2 Papua New Guinea 35 786.6 9 113.2 44 899.8 Paraguay 43 921.1 6 45.5 49 966.6 Peru 107 6,629.5 107 6,629.5 Philippines 169 11,913.2 5 294.2 174 12,207.4 Poland 43 6,210.2 43 6,210.2 Portugal 32 1,338.8 32 1,338.8 Romania 83 7,248.5 83 7,248.5 Russian Federation 61 13,596.1 61 13,596.1 Rwanda 62 1,393.5 62 1,393.5 Samoa 13 87.8 13 87.8 São Tomé and Principe 12 80.4 12 80.4 Senegal 19 164.9 92 2,501.7 111 2,666.6 Serbia and Montenegroa 26 725.0 26 725.0 Seychelles 2 10.7 2 10.7 Sierra Leone 4 18.7 35 815.1 39 833.8 Singapore 14 181.3 14 181.3 Slovak Republic 9 424.6 9 424.6 Slovenia 5 177.7 5 177.7 Solomon Islands 8 49.9 8 49.9 Somalia 39 492.1 39 492.1 South Africa 13 302.8 13 302.8 Spain 12 478.7 12 478.7 Sri Lanka 12 210.7 90 3,200.1 102 3,410.8 St. Kitts and Nevis 5 23.5 1.5 5 25.0 St. Lucia 11 32.9 38.3 11 71.2 St. Vincent and the Grenadines 5 12.0 1 18.2 6 30.1 Sudan 8 166.0 47 1,352.9 55 1,518.9 Swaziland 12 104.8 2 7.8 14 112.6 Syrian Arab Republic 16 579.6 3 47.3 19 626.9 Taiwan, China 14 329.4 4 15.3 18 344.7 Tajikistan 26 404.9 26 404.9 Tanzania 17 318.9 122 5,718.5 139 6,037.4 Thailand 118 8,027.4 6 125.1 124 8,152.5 Timor-Leste 4 16.5 4 16.5 Togo 1 20.0 41 733.5 42 753.5 Tonga 5 22.8 5 22.8 Trinidad and Tobago 22 333.6 22 333.6 (continued) 66 A Guide to the World Bank Table 2.1 continued IBRD loans IDA Loans Total Amount Amount Amount ($ mil- ($ mil- ($ mil- Country Number lions) Number lions) Number lions) Tunisia 123 5,509.8 5 69.8 128 5,579.6 Turkey 153 25,079.6 10 178.5 163 25,258.1 Turkmenistan 3 89.5 3 89.5 Uganda 1 9.1 94 4,560.1 95 4,569.2 Ukraine 33 4,498.1 33 4,498.1 Uruguay 56 2,546.0 56 2,546.0 Uzbekistan 13 554.1 1 85.0 14 639.1 Vanuatu 5 18.9 5 18.9 Venezuela, República Bolivariana de 40 3,328.4 40 3,328.4 Vietnam 60 6,327.7 60 6,327.7 Western Africa 1 6.1 3 52.5 4 58.6 Yemen, Republic of 135 2,498.3 135 2,498.3 Yugoslavia, former Yugoslav Republic 89 6,090.7 89 6,090.7 Zambia 27 679.1 60 2,847.2 87 3,526.3 Zimbabwe 24 983.2 12 662.0 36 1,645.2 Total 5,029 420,200.0 4,067 169,543.6 9,096 589,743.6 Source: World Bank 2006. Note: OECS = Organization of Eastern Caribbean States. Joint IBRD and IDA operations are counted only once as IBRD operations. When more than one loan is made for a single project, the operation is counted only once. Amounts may not add to totals because of rounding. a. Following a referendum in May 2006, Montenegro declared its independence from the union of Serbia and Montenegro, resulting in both states becoming independent countries. Data are for both states prior to independence. World Bank Lending instruments The World Bank offers two basic types of lending instruments to its client governments: investment loans and development policy loans. Depending on its eligibility, a member country will draw on loans from either IBRD or IDA to support a lending project. Whether the money is lent through IBRD or IDA determines the terms of the loan (box 2.4 presents key terms and rates). Loans are made as part of the comprehensive lending program set out in the CASs, which tailor Bank assistance (both lending and services) to each borrower's development needs. Lending operations are developed in several phases, as outlined in the "World Bank Project Cycle" section later in this chap- How the World Bank Group Operates 67 ter. Complete descriptions of the Bank's various lending instruments are avail- able by clicking on "Financing Instruments" at http://www.worldbank.org/ projects. The Bank has a searchable online database of all projects: visit http:// www.worldbank.org and click on "Projects and Operations." In addition, the Bank posts information on loans and credits most recently approved by its Board of Executive Directors under "News" on the Bank's Web site. For more information, see the later subsection on "Project Information." Investment lending. Investment loans provide long-term financing for a range of activities aimed at creating the physical and social infrastructure necessary for poverty reduction and sustainable development. Over the past two de- cades, investment lending has, on average, accounted for 75 to 80 percent of all Bank lending. Box 2.4 Financial Terms and Rates IBRD Front-end fee: 1 percent of the loan amount, payable on loan effectiveness Lending rate: product specific; for some products, also currency specific Commitment fee: varies by product, but 0.75 percent on undisbursed balance for most loans; a partial waiver may apply Maturity: 15 to 20 years, with a 3- to 8-year grace period, for standard coun- try terms IDA Service charge: 0.75 percent Commitment fee: 0.0 to 0.5 percent on undisbursed balance (set annually, 0.2 percent for fiscal 2007) Maturity: 20, 30, and 40 years, with a 10-year grace period Interest rate: 4 percent for hard-term credits approved in fiscal 2007 CONTACT INFORMATION Financial Products and Services Group World Bank 1818 H Street, NW MS MC7-708 Washington, DC, 20433, USA Tel: 1-202-458-1122 Fax: 1-202-522-2102 E-mail: fps@worldbank.org 68 A Guide to the World Bank The nature of investment lending has evolved over time. Originally focused on hardware, engineering services, and bricks and mortar, investment lending has come to focus more on institution building, social development, and the public policy infrastructure needed to facilitate private sector activity. Exam- ples of areas in which recent projects have been funded include urban poverty reduction (involving private contractors in new housing construction), rural development (formalizing land tenure to increase the security of small farmers), water and sanitation (improving the efficiency of water utilities), natural resource management (providing training in sustainable forestry and farming), postconflict reconstruction (reintegrating soldiers into communities), education (promoting the education of girls), and health (establishing rural clinics and training health care workers). Development policy lending. Development policy loans provide quick- disbursing assistance to countries to support structural reforms in a sector or in the economy as a whole. They support the policy and institutional changes needed to create an environment conducive to sustained and equitable growth. Over the past two decades, development policy lending--previously called adjustment lending--has accounted, on average, for 20 to 25 percent of total Bank lending. Development policy loans were originally designed to provide support for macroeconomic policy reforms, such as in trade policy and agriculture. How- ever, they have evolved over time, and now they generally aim to promote competitive market structures (for example, legal and regulatory reform), cor- rect distortions in incentive regimes (taxation and trade reform), establish appropriate monitoring and safeguards (financial sector reform), create an environment conducive to private sector investment (judicial reform, adop- tion of a modern investment code), encourage private sector activity (priva- tization and public-private partnerships), promote good governance (civil service reform), and mitigate the short-term adverse effects of development policy (establishment of social protection funds). Grants A limited number of grants are available through the Bank, funded either directly or through partnerships. Most are designed as seed money for pilot How the World Bank Group Operates 69 projects with innovative approaches and technologies. They also foster col- laboration with other organizations and encourage broader participation in development projects. The Development Grant Facility provides overall strategy, allocations, and management for Bank grant-making activities. It has supported programs in such sectors as economic policy, education, envi- ronment, health, private sector development, and rural development. For more information go to http://worldbank.org/dgf/. Cofinancing The World Bank often cofinances its projects with governments, commercial banks, export credit agencies, multilateral institutions, and private sector investors. Cofinancing is any arrangement under which funds from the Bank are associated with funds provided by sources from outside the recipient coun- try for a specific lending project or program. Official cofinancing--through either donor government agencies or multilateral financial institutions-- constitutes the largest source of cofinancing for Bank-assisted operations. Trust funds Trust funds are financial arrangements between the World Bank and a donor or a group of donors under which the donor entrusts the Bank with funds for a specific development-related activity. They enable the Bank, along with bilateral and multilateral donors, to mobilize funds for investment opera- tions as well as for debt relief, emergency reconstruction, technical assistance, and advisory services. Bank-administered trust funds support poverty reduc- tion activities across a wide range of sectors and regions, thereby supporting clients in achieving development results at the global, regional, and country levels. Much of the recent growth in these funds reflects the international com- munity's desire for the Bank to help manage broad global initiatives through multilateral partnerships, such as the Global Fund to Fight AIDS, Tubercu- losis, and Malaria; the Global Environment Facility; and the HIPC Initiative. Trust funds also support the World Bank's own development operations and work programs. Contributions from donors in fiscal 2006 totaled $5.3 billion, an increase of 9.5 percent over fiscal 2005. The main Web page for Bank trust funds is at http://www.worldbank.org/cfp. Trust funds are also used by IFC. Refer to the "IFC" section for more information. 70 A Guide to the World Bank Guarantees and risk management Guarantees promote private financing by covering risks that the private sec- tor is not normally ready to absorb or manage. All World Bank guarantees are partial guarantees of private debt, so that risks are shared by the Bank and private lenders. The Bank's objective is to cover risks that it is in a unique position to bear given its experience in developing countries and its relation- ships with governments. IBRD also offers hedging products, which can transform the risk character- istics of a borrower's IBRD obligations even though the negotiated terms of particular loan contracts themselves may be fixed. These products give bor- rowers improved risk management capability in the context of projects, lend- ing programs, or sovereign asset-liability management. IBRD hedging products include interest rate swaps, interest rate caps and collars, currency swaps, and-- on a case-by-case basis--commodity swaps. Additional information on guarantees and risk management services follows in the sections on IFC and MIGA financial products and services. See also "Guarantees and Risk Management" at http://worldbank.org/businesscenter. International Finance Corporation IFC invests primarily in enterprises majority-owned by the private sector in almost all developing countries. For details of the corporation's products and services, click "About IFC" or "Products and Services" at http://www.ifc.org. For a printed copy of the brochure IFC's Products and Services, contact IFC Corporate Relations by telephone at (202) 473-3800 or e-mail at Webmaster@ IFC.org. Lending and investments IFC's investments in emerging market companies and financial institutions create jobs, build economies, and generate tax revenues. IFC brings its exten- sive knowledge of social and environmental issues and corporate governance to each investment to strengthen the financial health of the enterprise and ensure its long-term sustainability. IFC offers clients a variety of lending instruments, including senior, sub- ordinated, and convertible loans, as well as a choice of interest rates, namely, fixed- and variable-rate loans and, on occasion, loans indexed to the price of a commodity. Loans are issued at market rates. Most are denominated in major currencies, but an increasing number are in local currencies. IFC lend- How the World Bank Group Operates 71 ing includes credit lines for on-lending to intermediary banks, leasing com- panies, and other financial institutions, particularly those that serve small businesses or microenterprises. IFC also makes equity investments, risking its own capital by buying and holding shares in companies, other project entities, financial institutions, and portfolio or private equity funds. IFC is always a minority shareholder, gen- erally limiting its shareholding to 20 percent or less of a company's equity, and will not normally be the largest shareholder in a project. In addition, IFC invests through quasi-equity instruments, products that have both debt and equity characteristics. IFC offers clients risk management products that provide them with access to long-term derivatives markets. Instruments such as swaps and options help clients manage their currency, interest rate, and commodity price risks. Working closely with the World Bank, IFC has also begun making new financial products and services and access to capital markets available to sub- national entities--states, municipalities, and municipally controlled institu- tions--in developing countries. The goal is to help such local public entities deliver key infrastructure services and improve their efficiency and account- ability. As with the corporation's other investments, subnational transactions do not require sovereign guarantees. Resource mobilization IFC serves as a catalyst for private capital through all of its investments, but it also offers products and services aimed specifically at resource mobilization. IFC's structured finance products enable clients with strong, sustainable projects to access capital that otherwise might not be available to them. Prod- ucts include credit enhancement structures for bonds and loans through par- tial credit guarantees, participation in securitizations, and risk-sharing facilities. Through the syndicated loan or "B-loan" program, IFC offers commer- cial banks and other financial institutions the chance to lend to projects and companies they might not otherwise consider. IFC also mobilizes financing through investment funds, a commercial sec- tor that it has helped develop in emerging markets. Trust funds IFC uses donor-supported trust funds to help with technical assistance for various projects. IFC initiated the Technical Assistance Trust Funds Program in 1988 in an effort to identify and support viable business projects in devel- 72 A Guide to the World Bank oping countries at an early stage. These trust funds allow IFC to offer inte- grated solutions that combine commercial investments and donor-supported technical assistance. In addition, they catalyze innovative business approaches and facilitate pilot projects, which often develop into long-term technical assistance. The program is currently sponsored by 23 donor countries that collectively contribute $15 million to $20 million a year to support 100 to 150 new projects. IFC issues an annual report on trust funds that is available at http://www.ifc.org/tatf. For details of IFC's advisory activities, see chapters 3 and 4 or select "Advisory Services" under "Products & Services" at http://www.ifc.org. Multilateral Investment Guarantee Agency Investment guarantees MIGA provides investment guarantees against certain noncommercial risks (that is, political risk insurance) to eligible foreign investors for qualified investments in developing member countries. MIGA's investment guaran- tees cover the following risks: transfer restrictions, expropriation, breach of contract, and war and civil disturbance. MIGA makes a preliminary applica- tion for guarantee available on its Web site. Knowledge Sharing The Bank Group's development mission has always included analytic and advi- sory services as well as relevant training and publishing. Since the mid-1990s, however, the Bank Group has made knowledge sharing an explicit objective and has increased its efforts to organize its knowledge-sharing activities in a sys- tematic way so that information can have the broadest possible impact. Analytic and Advisory Services World Bank Most of the Bank's analytic and advisory services consist of economic and sector work and technical assistance. Economic and sector work examines a country's economic prospects--including, for example, its banking or finan- cial sectors--and trade, poverty, and social safety net issues. The results often form the basis for assistance strategies, government investment programs, and projects supported by IBRD and IDA lending. Much of this economic How the World Bank Group Operates 73 research output is available through the World Bank research Web site at http://econ.worldbank.org. The Bank's advisory services correspond with its thematic networks and sec- tors. They provide information on such topics as environmentally and socially sustainable development; the financial sector; health, nutrition, and popula- tion; and law and justice. Advisory services serve the Bank's clients and staff members, other development organizations, and the general public. More information can be found at http://www.worldbank.org/askus, which provides contacts for numerous specific aspects of the Bank's work. Some of the Bank's networks and sectors have also prepared topical tool kits for development practitioners. These tool kits cover, for example, food and nutrition; gender; legal, financial, and procurement requirements; man- agement and monitoring; project design; and resettlement safeguards. International Finance Corporation IFC's expertise in technical assistance focuses on five business lines: business- enabling environment, access to finance, environmental and social sustain- ability, infrastructure and public-private partnerships, and value addition to firms. These initiatives, funded mainly through IFC's partnerships with donors, complement its investments and nurture entrepreneurial growth. IFC delivers these services through a network of donor-funded facilities, each of which focuses on a developing region or a specific aspect of development, and through trust funds supported by individual countries or other donors. Capacity Development World Bank The World Bank Institute (WBI) provides client countries with a capacity development program that comprises technical assistance, thematic learning programs, cabinet-level retreats, and other leadership development programs. Its activities include organizing training courses, undertaking policy consul- tations, entering into partnerships with training and research institutions worldwide, and supporting knowledge networks related to international development. WBI places special emphasis on distance learning and other innovative uses of technology. Many of its initiatives are described in chap- ter 4. WBI's Web site is http://www.worldbank.org/wbi. The Global Development Learning Network is a fully interactive, multi- channel network that harnesses video, Internet, and satellite communications 74 A Guide to the World Bank to build local capacity, learning, and knowledge in the developing world and to develop a global community dedicated to fighting poverty. Its vision is for decision makers to have affordable and regular access to a global network of peers, experts, and practitioners with whom they may share ideas and expe- riences regarding the fight against poverty. The network operates through the facilities of Global Development Learning Network partners around the world. The Web site is at http://www.gdln.org. Multilateral Investment Guarantee Agency MIGA's Investment Marketing Services Department works to equip invest- ment promotion intermediaries with leading-edge knowledge, tools, and tech- niques to strengthen their capacity to attract and retain foreign direct investment. To this end, MIGA provides both hands-on operational assistance to promotion intermediaries and a range of investment information services to member countries and firms that are contemplating direct investments in the developing world. These core services and products fall into three broad areas: capacity building, information dissemination, and investment facilitation. Research The World Bank's Development Economics Vice Presidency supports stud- ies on the implications of a range of development issues such as the environ- ment, poverty, trade, and globalization. The resultant findings facilitate a deeper understanding of development challenges and can be used to influ- ence policy, thereby leading to better outcomes for poor people. Legal Counsel MIGA provides a broad range of legal support, both internally and for client countries. Its activities include supporting other MIGA departments and the Board of Directors with legal advice, advising countries on membership in MIGA, negotiating agreements with developing member countries in sup- port of underwriting and salvage, providing technical assistance and advice to member countries on issues affecting the attraction of foreign investment, researching and disseminating information, mediating investment disputes, administering claims, and advising on increasing guarantee capacity. MIGA also cooperates with other entities of the World Bank Group and with other international and national agencies or institutions on legal aspects of invest- ment protection and guarantee. How the World Bank Group Operates 75 Conciliation and Arbitration ICSID provides facilities for and coordination of the conciliation and arbi- tration of investment disputes between contracting states and nationals of other contracting states. ICSID's objective in making such facilities available is to promote an atmosphere of mutual confidence between states and for- eign investors--an atmosphere that is conducive to increasing the flow of pri- vate international investment. Publications, Data, and Statistics In addition to issuing annual reports and providing project information, the Bank Group produces and distributes about 200 formal publications a year in print and in electronic format. Major annual titles include the World Development Report, World Development Indicators, African Development Indicators, Global Development Finance, Global Economic Prospects, Global Monitoring Report, Doing Business, and the Atlas of Global Development. All formal publications are distributed to World Bank country offices and a net- work of depository libraries in developing countries. Commercial sales offer significant discounts for customers in developing countries (see box 2.5 or for a list of country-specific distributors go to http://www.worldbank.org/ reference/ and select "Book Distributors" in the "Finding Publications" box). In addition, the World Bank's e-library offers an online, fully cross-searchable portal to more than 4,000 World Bank documents. The collection consists of more than 1,600 World Bank publications and 2,400 policy research work- ing papers, plus all new books and papers as they are published. For more information, go to http://www.worldbank.org/elibrary. Working in close cooperation with the official statistical systems that national governments organize and finance, the Bank Group generates comprehensive data and statistics on many aspects of development. It also works to improve the coverage and effectiveness of national systems. Much of this information is available online, some for free and some by subscription. The key resource is the data and statistics Web site at http://www.worldbank.org/data. Many other specific datasets are available on Bank Group Web sites. Events: Conferences, Forums, and Summits The Bank Group sponsors, hosts, or participates in numerous conferences, both on its own and in conjunction with other organizations. Among the best known is the Annual World Bank Conference on Development Economics. Two of these conferences are held each year, one global and one regional. For major 76 A Guide to the World Bank Box 2.5 Obtaining World Bank Group Publications World Bank Group Publications P.O. Box 960 Herndon, VA 20172-0960, USA Tel: 1-800-645-7247 or 1-703-661-1580 Fax: 1-703-661-1501 E-mail: books@worldbank.org Web: http://www.worldbank.org/publications E-library: http://www.worldbank.org/elibrary World Bank events, see the "Events Calendar" at http://www.worldbank. org/events. Many of the Web sites of specific Bank Group units also list upcom- ing events. World Bank Project Cycle Each year the World Bank lends between $15 billion and $20 billion for pro- jects in the more than 100 countries it works with. Projects range across the economic and social spectrum in these countries, from infrastructure, to edu- cation, to health, to government financial management. The projects the Bank finances are conceived and supervised according to a well-documented project cycle (figure 2.5). Documents produced as part of the project cycle can be valuable sources of information for interested stakeholders wanting to keep abreast of the work the Bank is financing and for businesses wishing to participate in Bank-financed projects. The follow- ing text provides a step-by-step guide to the project cycle and the documents that are produced as part of the process. Most of this information is specific to World Bank projects, and information about IFC's project cycle follows in the next section. Information about how to access information about World Bank projects appears at the end of this section. How the Process Begins: Poverty Reduction and Country Assistance Strategies The Bank recognizes that many past assistance efforts, including some of its own, failed because donors, rather than the governments they were trying to assist, drove the agenda. Under its current development policy, the Bank helps governments take the lead in preparing and implementing development How the World Bank Group Operates 77 Figure 2.5 World Bank Project Cycle Country Assistance Strategies Project Evaluation Identification Implementation Understanding the Preparation Completion Project Cycle Implementation Appraisal & Supervision Approval strategies in the belief that programs that the country owns and that have widespread stakeholder support have a greater chance of success. In low-income countries, the Bank uses the poverty reduction strategy approach, which involves widespread consultation and consensus building on how to boost development. Under this process, the country devises a national poverty reduction strategy, thereby creating a framework that enables donors to better coordinate their programs and align them with national priorities. The government consults a wide cross-section of local groups and combines such consultations with an extensive analysis of poverty in the country and of the country's economic situation. The government determines its own prior- ities from this process and produces targets for reducing poverty over a three- to five-year period. These priorities and targets are outlined in a PRSP. The Bank and other aid agencies then align their assistance efforts with the coun- try's own strategy--a proven way of improving development effectiveness. The Bank's blueprint for its work with a country is based on a CAS that, in the case of low-income countries, is derived from the priorities contained in the countries' PRSPs. The CAS is produced in cooperation with the gov- ernment and interested stakeholders. The preparation of the CAS may draw on analytical work conducted by the Bank or other parties on a wide range of sectors, such as agriculture, education, fiscal management, health, public expenditure and budgeting, and procurement. 78 A Guide to the World Bank The Identification Phase The Bank's CAS forms the blueprint for its assistance to a country and, as noted, in low-income countries, the CAS is based on the priorities identified in the country's PRSP. The goals outlined in the CAS guide priorities for the Bank's lending program and are a useful source of information for interested stake- holders and businesses wishing to identify potential future areas of Bank lend- ing. During the identification phase, Bank teams work with the government to identify projects that can be funded as part of the agreed-on development objec- tives. Once a project has been identified, the Bank team prepares a project con- cept note, which is an internal document that outlines the basic elements of the project, the proposed objective, the likely risks, the alternative scenarios to con- ducting the project, and a likely timetable for the project approval process. The following project documentation is required at this stage: Project information document Integrated safeguards data sheet The Preparation Phase The preparation phase is driven by the country that the Bank is working with, and it can take from a few months to as long as three years, depending on the complexity of the project being proposed. The Bank plays a supporting role, offering analysis and advice when requested. During this period, the techni- cal, institutional, economic, environmental, and financial issues facing the project will be studied and addressed, including a review of whether alterna- tive methods are available for achieving the same objectives. The Bank requires an assessment of projects proposed for Bank financing to help ensure that they are environmentally sound and sustainable. The scope of the environmental assessment depends on the project's scope, scale, and potential impact. Project documentation at this stage includes the following: Environmental assessment report Indigenous peoples development plan Environmental action plan The Appraisal Phase The Bank is responsible for the appraisal phase. Bank staff review the work done during identification and preparation, often spending three to four weeks in the client country. They prepare either project appraisal documents How the World Bank Group Operates 79 (for investment projects) or program documents (for adjustment operations) for review by Bank management, and the Financial Management team assesses the project's financial aspects. The project information document is updated during this phase. The documents prepared during this stage are released to the public after the project has been approved (see below). The Negotiation and Approval Phase After Bank staff members have appraised the proposed project, the Bank and the country that is seeking to borrow the funds negotiate its final shape. Both sides come to agreement on the terms and conditions of the loan. Then the project appraisal document or the program document, along with the mem- orandum of the president and legal documents, are submitted to the Bank's Board of Executive Directors for approval. The appropriate documents are also submitted to the borrowing government for final clearance, which may involve ratification by a council of ministers or the country's legislature. Fol- lowing approval by both parties, the loan agreement is formally signed by both parties' representatives. Once this has occurred, the loan or credit is declared effective--or ready for disbursement--after the relevant conditions have been met, and the agreement is made available to the public. Project documentation at this stage includes the following: Project appraisal document, which presents all the information that the Board needs to approve Bank financing of the proposal. Before 1999, this document was called the staff appraisal report. The program document describes adjustment lending operations and sets out the Bank's appraisal and assessment of the feasibility and justification for the program. Technical annex, which supplements a memorandum and recommenda- tion of the president for freestanding technical assistance loans. Such loans do not require project appraisal documents. The Implementation and Supervision Phase The borrowing country is responsible for implementing the project, while the Bank is responsible for supervision. Once the loan has been approved, the bor- rowing government, with technical assistance from the Bank, prepares specifi- cations and evaluates bids for the procurement of goods and services for the project. The Bank reviews this activity to ensure that its procurement guidelines have been followed. If they have, the funds will be disbursed. The Bank's Finan- cial Management team oversees the financial management of the project, which includes a requirement for periodic submissions of audited financial statements. 80 A Guide to the World Bank The Evaluation Phase Following the completion of a project, the Bank's Independent Evaluation Group conducts an audit to measure the project's outcome against the origi- nal objectives. The audit entails a review of the project completion report and the preparation of a separate report. Both reports are then submitted to the executive directors and to the borrower. They are not released to the public. Project documentation at this stage includes the following: Project performance assessment reports Impact evaluation reports Inspection Panel reports Projects may be dropped at any point in the project cycle from prepara- tion to approval. For projects that never achieve active status, the project information document is effectively the final document. Other Monitoring The Quality Assurance Group monitors the quality of the Bank's activities during implementation to facilitate better management. It examines project quality both for loans (shortly after project approval by the Board) and for advisory services (after delivery to country clients). It also monitors the qual- ity of project supervision and reports to the Board of Executive Directors on the overall health of the portfolio of ongoing projects through the Annual Report on Portfolio Performance. For more information, see "Measuring Results" at http://go.worldbank.org/J4OO0PFYM0. Another independent body within the World Bank, the Inspection Panel, provides a forum for citizens who believe they have been or could be harmed by a Bank-financed project. For details, go to http://www.worldbank.org/ inspectionpanel. Project Information Several major resources are available in relation to project documents, which are also referred to as operational documents, and in relation to other project information (see box 2.6 for additional Web links): Projects database. Available online at http://www.worldbank.org/projects, this database enables users to search the entire World Bank project port- How the World Bank Group Operates 81 Box 2.6 Web Links for Project Information, Disclosure, and Evaluation WORLD BANK Loans and credits: http://www.worldbank.org/loansandcredits Projects, policies, and strategies: http://www.worldbank.org/projects Project cycle: http://www.worldbank.org/projectcycle Operational procedures: http://www.worldbank.org.operations Country assistance strategies: http://www.worldbank.org/cas Operational documents: http://www.worldbank.org/infoshop PRSPs: http://www.worldbank.org/prsp PICs: http://www.worldbank.org/pics Policy on disclosure of information: http://www.worldbank.org/disclosure Independent Evaluation Group: http://www.worldbank.org/ieg Inspection Panel: http://www.worldbank.org/inspectionpanel IFC Projects: http://www.ifc.org/projects Project cycle: http://www.ifc.org/ifcext/proserv.nsf/content/IFCprojectcycle Policy on disclosure of information: see "Disclosure Policy Review" at http://www.ifc.org/policyreview Environment and social review (monitoring of projects): http://www.ifcext/enviro.nsf/content/ESRP Independent Evaluation Group: http://www.ifc.org/ieg IFC AND MIGA Office of the Compliance Advisor/Ombudsman: http://www.cao-ombudsman.org MIGA Projects insured by MIGA: http://www.miga.org Disclosure policies: see "Environment and Disclosure Policies" at http://www.miga.org ICSID Cases: http://www.worldbank.org/icsid/cases/cases.htm folio from the founding of IBRD to the present. Users can search in the projects database or in project documents, contract awards, or documents on analytical and advisory work. The search can be defined by any com- bination of the following: keyword, region, country or area, theme, sec- tor, project status, product line, lending instrument, year approved, and 82 A Guide to the World Bank environmental category. Results show the basic project information with links to available project documents. Recent loans, credits, and grants. The World Bank also posts information on loans, credits, and grants most recently approved by the Board of Executive Directors under "News" on the Bank's Web site (http://www. worldbank.org/loansandcredits). Here, users can view information by date, by topic (sector), by region, or by country. The listings generally include the names of contacts who can provide additional information. Documents and reports. This feature of the World Bank's Web site, avail- able at http://www-wds.worldbank.org, provides more than 14,000 World Bank documents--the full range of material that is made available to the public under its disclosure policy. This approach to accessing project doc- uments is an alternative to searching the projects database. This site also includes documents created through the Bank's country economic and sector work, as well as various working papers and informal series from departments around the Bank. Users of the site can access documents in both text and in PDF. Printed copies can be ordered from the InfoShop. InfoShop. The InfoShop is the World Bank Group's bookstore and is located at Bank headquarters. It provides printed copies of project docu- ments and also sells the Bank Group's formal publications, books on development topics by other publishers, souvenirs, and gifts. For more information, see "How to Order" at http://www.worldbank.org/infoshop. Public Information Centers (PICs). These centers, which are maintained at World Bank country offices, make Bank information available to the pub- lic and disseminate its work to the widest possible audience. PIC Europe in Paris and PIC Tokyo offer the complete range of project documents for all member countries and maintain libraries of recent World Bank publi- cations. Other country office PICs and libraries worldwide have project documents specific to the country in which the office is located and often offer a library of recent Bank publications. Each PIC serves as the central contact in the country for people seeking to obtain Bank documents and information on the Bank's operations. The InfoShop coordinates with all PICs to ensure broad dissemination of information in compliance with the Bank's disclosure policy. For more information, see appendix F. IFC Project Cycle IFC offers a wide variety of financial products to private sector projects in developing countries. The project cycle, outlined below, illustrates the stages a business idea goes through as it becomes an IFC-financed project. How the World Bank Group Operates 83 Application for IFC financing. IFC does not have a standard application form for financing. A company or entrepreneur, foreign or domestic, seek- ing to establish a new venture or to expand an existing enterprise can approach IFC directly. This is best done by reading "How to Apply for IFC Financing" (available on IFC's Web site, http://www.ifc.org/) and by submitting an investment proposal. After these initial contacts and a pre- liminary review, IFC may proceed by requesting a detailed feasibility study or business plan to determine whether to appraise the project. Project appraisal. Typically, an appraisal team consists of an investment officer with financial expertise and knowledge of the country in which the project is located, an engineer with relevant technical expertise, and an environmental specialist. The team is responsible for evaluating the tech- nical, financial, economic, and environmental aspects of the project. This process entails visits to the proposed site of the project and extensive dis- cussions with the project sponsors. After returning to headquarters, the team submits its recommendations to the senior management of the rele- vant IFC department. If financing of the project is approved at the depart- ment level, IFC's Legal Department drafts appropriate documents with assistance from outside counsel as necessary. Outstanding issues are nego- tiated with the company and other involved parties, such as governments or financial institutions. Public notification. Before the proposed investment is submitted to IFC's Board of Directors for review, the public is notified of the main elements of the project. Environmental review documents are also made available to the public. Board review and approval. The project is submitted to IFC's Board of Directors, which reviews the proposed investment and approves it if it sees fit. Resource mobilization. After Board approval, IFC seeks to mobilize addi- tional financing by encouraging other institutions to make investments in the project. Legal commitment. If the investment is approved by the Board--and if stipulations from earlier negotiations are fulfilled--IFC and the company will sign the deal, entering into a legal commitment. Disbursement of funds. Funds are disbursed under the terms of the legal commitment signed by all parties. Project supervision and evaluation. After funds have been disbursed, IFC monitors its investments closely. It consults periodically with project man- agers and sends field missions to visit the enterprise. It also requires quar- terly progress reports and information on factors that might materially 84 A Guide to the World Bank affect the enterprise in which it has invested, including annual financial statements audited by independent public accountants. IFC's basic instru- ment of evaluation is the expanded project supervision report. These self- evaluative reports are prepared by IFC's investment departments on a randomly selected, representative sample of investment operations (num- bering about 70 a year) that have reached early operating maturity (gen- erally five years after Board approval). IFC's Independent Evaluation Group reviews each of these reports. Closing. When an investment is repaid in full--or when IFC exits an investment by selling its equity stake--IFC closes its books on the project. Project information. IFC produces a summary of project information for each project it undertakes. It also publishes its environmental documents for each project. All project information is posted on the Web at http:// www.ifc.org/projects. Users can narrow their searches by document type, project country, sector, IFC region, environmental category, or keywords. Partnerships The World Bank Group has a large array of partners in the global fight against poverty. As discussed under "Strategies" earlier in this chapter, the most important partnership is with the developing countries themselves, not only with the many government agencies, but also with the whole range of civil society, especially the poor, who are most affected by Bank Group activities. The Bank Group also partners with other international institutions and donors, the private sector, civil society, and professional and academic asso- ciations to improve the coordination of aid policies at the country, regional, and global levels. Partnerships for financing, such as trust funds and cofi- nancing arrangements, are described in the earlier sections on Bank Group financial products and services. See also "Partners" at http://www.world bank.org/about. Partnerships with International Institutions In addition to the IMF, the UN, and the UN's many agencies and programs (see chapter 1), the Bank Group works with many other organizations whose membership is made up of country governments. Major examples include the following: The European Union. The World Trade Organization. How the World Bank Group Operates 85 Multilateral development banks and other multilateral financial institu- tions. These institutions provide financial support and professional advice for economic and social development activities in developing countries. The term "multilateral development bank" typically refers to the World Bank Group and four regional development banks: the African Develop- ment Bank, the Asian Development Bank, the European Bank for Recon- struction and Development, and the Inter-American Development Bank. The Bank Group also works with several other banks and funds--the "multi- lateral financial institutions"--that lend to developing countries but have a narrower membership and focus. These include, among others, the Euro- pean Commission and the Islamic Development Bank. Subregional banks owned by groups of countries and established for development purposes also work with the Bank Group. Among these are the Caribbean Develop- ment Bank, the Central American Bank for Economic Integration, the East African Development Bank, and the West African Development Bank. Partnerships with Bilateral Development Agencies The World Bank Group works with the development agencies of individual countries to coordinate aid and achieve development goals, sometimes for- mally through trust funds, and often with such countries' representatives in the field. Work is coordinated by various committees and through consulta- tions that take place throughout the year. Programmatic Partnerships The World Bank hosts the secretariats of several closely affiliated organiza- tions at its headquarters, including the following: Consultative Group on International Agricultural Research. This is an asso- ciation of 62 members that supports agricultural research and related activ- ities carried out by 16 autonomous research centers. Priorities include increasing productivity, protecting the environment, saving biodiversity, improving policies, and strengthening research at the national level. Mem- bers of the Consultative Group on Agricultural Research include industrial and developing countries, foundations, and international and regional organizations. The group's Web site is at http://www.cgiar.org. Consultative Group to Assist the Poor. This is a consortium of 33 public and private development agencies that seeks to improve the capacity of micro- finance institutions (specialized institutions that provide financial services to very poor people). The Consultative Group to Assist the Poor supports 86 A Guide to the World Bank the development of these institutions and works to increase their com- mercial viability and the legal and regulatory framework for them in poor countries. The group's Web site is at http://www.cgap.org. Development Gateway. The Development Gateway is an Internet portal for information and knowledge sharing on sustainable development and poverty reduction. Features include AiDA (Accessible Information on Development Activities), a comprehensive database of development pro- jects; dgMarket, an international procurement marketplace; and Country Gateways, a network of 41 locally owned and managed public-private part- nerships, each of which promotes innovative and effective use of the Inter- net and other information and communication technologies in a country to reduce poverty and promote sustainable development. The Develop- ment Gateway Web site is at http://www.developmentgateway.org. Education for All. This is a global commitment to provide quality basic education for all children, youth, and adults. The movement was launched at the World Conference on Education for All in 1990. GAVI Alliance. The GAVI Alliance (formerly known as the Global Alliance for Vaccines and Immunisation) is a public-private partnership focused on increasing children's access to vaccines in poor countries. Partners include the GAVI Fund, national governments, the United Nations Chil- dren's Fund, the World Health Organization, the World Bank, the Bill & Melinda Gates Foundation, the vaccine industry, public health insti- tutions, and NGOs. The GAVI Fund provides resources for the GAVI Alliance's programs. The latter provides a forum where partners can agree on mutual goals, share strategies, and coordinate efforts. Its Web site is at http://www.gavialliance.org. Global Environment Facility. This entity provides grants and concessional loans to help developing countries meet the costs of measures designed to achieve global environmental benefits. The focus is on climate change, biological diversity, international waters, and ozone layer depletion. The World Bank, the UN Development Programme, and the UN Environ- ment Programme are the three implementing agencies of the Global Envi- ronment Facility, which is supported administratively by the World Bank but remains functionally independent. Each agency finances the facility's activities within its respective areas of competence. Its Web site is at http:// www/worldbank.org/gef. NGOs and Civil Society Most development projects approved by the Bank Group involve active par- ticipation by NGOs in their implementation, and most of the Bank Group's How the World Bank Group Operates 87 country strategies benefit from consultations with civil society organizations. The Bank Group uses the term "civil society organizations" to refer to the wide array of nongovernmental and not-for-profit organizations that have a presence in public life, expressing the interests and values of their members, or other organizations that are based on ethical, cultural, political, scientific, religious, or philanthropic considerations. The Bank Group's outreach in this area encompasses trade unions, community-based organizations, social movements, faith-based institutions, charitable organizations, research centers, foundations, student organizations, professional associations, and many other entities. Staff members working in 70 country offices around the world reach out to and collaborate with NGOs in a variety of areas, ranging from education and HIV/AIDS to the environ- ment. The home pages of the Bank Group's civil society efforts are at http://www.worldbank.org/civilsociety (for the World Bank) and http:// www.ifc.org/ngo (for IFC). For NGO correspondence with MIGA, see "NGOs and Civil Society" at http://www.miga.org. Staff, Consultants, and Vendors World Bank Group Staff The institutions of the World Bank Group together have a full-time staff of about 12,500 professionals and support personnel (as of May 2007). Of these, 40 percent are located in country offices. The proportion of field per- sonnel has grown in recent years, reflecting the Bank Group's commitment to operating in close partnership with its clients. Staff members are drawn from most member countries and typically have strong academic backgrounds, a broad understanding of development issues, and international work experience. Most have specializations appropriate to their particular unit. Staff salaries and benefits are intended to be competitive and are based on data from comparable organizations in the public sector as well as from the private industrial and financial sectors. According to a treaty signed by the U.S. government when the Bank's headquarters was established in Wash- ington, DC, in 1945, foreign nationals are exempt from federal and state taxes on World Bank Group income, but U.S. citizens working at the Bank Group are required to pay both federal and state income taxes on their salaries. Thus, to keep after-tax income in line for all staff members, the Bank Group pays salaries on a net-of-tax basis and gives an additional allowance to staff members who are liable for income taxes. All staff members also pay local property, sales, and other taxes. These tax arrangements are comparable to those of other international organizations. 88 A Guide to the World Bank Over the past several years, the Bank Group has made considerable progress in mobilizing the diversity of its staff members as a strategic business asset. The business case for diversity--that it enriches the organization's tal- ent base, reflects the Group's global membership, and brings a wider range of perspectives to bear on the organization's poverty reduction work-- increasingly is recognized. The Bank Group has changed the face of senior management with a record number of women, developing-country nation- als, and individuals of Sub-Saharan African origin. The diversity focus has been expanded beyond nationality, gender, and race to address areas includ- ing disabilities and sexual orientation as well as education and previous expe- rience. Diversity has also been integrated into managerial training. Job Openings, Internships, and Scholarships The Bank Group provides information on its job openings, special job opportunities for younger professionals, and internships through a careers Web site maintained by Human Resources. The Web address is http://www. worldbank.org/careers. For information specific to MIGA, see "About Us" at http://www.miga.org. In addition, the Bank Group offers scholarship and fellowship programs, information about which is available at http://www.worldbank.org/wbi/ scholarships. Specific programs include the following: The Young Professionals Program, which is for highly qualified and moti- vated people younger than 32 who are skilled in areas relevant to the World Bank's operations. Candidates must hold the equivalent of a mas- ter's degree and have significant work experience or continued academic study at the doctoral level. Initial appointments are for two years and often lead to a career in the Bank. The Junior Professional Associates Program, which is for recent graduates younger than 29 who have superior academic records and an interest in international work. Candidates must hold the equivalent of a bachelor's or master's degree or must be a doctoral candidate. This is a two-year, entry-level program. Associates are not eligible for employment with the World Bank for two years following the end of their appointments. The Bank Internship Program, which is for nationals of a World Bank member country who are enrolled full time in a master's or doctoral pro- gram. Interns work either in the winter (November­January) or the sum- How the World Bank Group Operates 89 mer (May­September), although dates may vary according to university schedules. Interns in this program receive a salary. The Joint Japan­World Bank Graduate Scholarship Program, which covers up to two years of study toward a master's degree. Candidates must be nationals of a World Bank member country, must have been accepted at a university outside their country, must study in a field related to devel- opment, must be younger than 45, and must have at least two years of pro- fessional experience. The program is funded by the Japanese government but it does not require study in Japan. The Robert S. McNamara Fellowships Program, which is part of the Woodrow Wilson School of Public Affairs at Princeton University. This program provides a full tuition scholarship, a travel allowance, and a stipend for living expenses. The student must be a national of a World Bank member country and have at least seven years of professional ex- perience. Candidates apply directly to the Master's in Public Policy pro- gram at Princeton and indicate that they are applying for admission as a McNamara Fellow. Procurement Opportunities in Projects Financed by IBRD and IDA Every year, investment projects financed by the World Bank generate billions of dollars in opportunities for suppliers of goods and services. Government agencies from the Bank's borrowing countries are responsible for the pur- chase of goods and services to support these projects. Bank procedures have been established to ensure that procurement is conducted efficiently and in an open, competitive, and transparent manner. The procurement policies and procedures in Bank-financed projects are explained in "Guidelines: Procurement under IBRD Loans and IDA Cred- its" and "Guidelines: Selection and Employment of Consultants by World Bank Borrowers," which are available at http://www.worldbank.org/procure. On the same page, under the "Bidding / Consulting Opportunities" tab, the "Resource Guide to Consulting, Supply, and Contracting Opportunities in Projects Financed by the World Bank" provides detailed guidance on how to identify and track business opportunities. Supplying Directly to the World Bank Group The Bank Group regularly seeks qualified vendors for assistance in running its operations in Washington, DC, and its offices around the world. Oppor- 90 A Guide to the World Bank tunities range from supplying printer toner cartridges to managing complex communications systems. For information on how to sell goods and services to the Bank Group, including vendor registration, the key Web site is the vendor kiosk at http://info.worldbank.org/vendorkiosk/. Another Web site at http://www.worldbank.org/corporateprocurement lists current business opportunities with the Bank Group. Latin America and the Caribbean Middle East and North Africa Africa Europe and Central Asia South Asia East Asia and the Pacific 3 World Bank Group Countries and Regions This chapter provides information on the countries of the Bank Group: the mechanics of membership, the ways that countries are classified, and the initiatives focusing on groups of countries with shared characteristics or concerns. It then provides a review of each of the regions into which the Bank Group organizes its member countries as it provides development assistance. 93 94 A Guide to the World Bank Member Countries Membership The five institutions of the Bank Group are owned by their member countries (see box 3.1 for Web links). To become a member of IBRD, a country must first join the IMF. Similarly, membership in IDA, IFC, and MIGA is contin- gent upon membership in IBRD. In each of these cases, member countries buy shares in the institution, thereby helping build the institution's capital and bor- rowing power. This arrangement is known as "capital subscriptions." Member countries also sign the founding document of each institution: the Articles of Agreement for IBRD, IDA, and IFC and the MIGA Convention. Member- ship in ICSID entails signing and ratifying the ICSID Convention and also involves capital subscriptions. Links to the founding documents for each insti- tution can be found at http://www.worldbank.org/articles. As of April 2007, IBRD had 185 members, IDA had 166, IFC had 179, MIGA had 171, and ICSID had 143. The Bank Group's Corporate Secretariat keeps up-to-date lists of membership, handles official country names used by the Bank Group, and deals with communications regarding membership status and capital subscriptions. In its maps and publications, the Bank Group sometimes indicates contested boundaries or territorial claims between member countries, but it does not endorse any member country's position where such disputes exist. As covered in chapter 1, member countries govern the Bank Group through the Boards of Governors and the Boards of Directors. The voting power of each executive director is determined by the value of the capital subscriptions held by the countries that he or she represents. For each of the four shareholding insti- tutions--IBRD, IDA, IFC, and MIGA--the executive director for the United States has the greatest voting power, followed by the executive director for Japan. Member countries can withdraw from Bank Group institutions at any time by giving notice. A member may also be suspended and, after a year, expelled Box 3.1 Web Links for Country Membership Information IBRD and IDA member countries: see "Members" at http://www.worldbank.org/about IFC member countries: see "Member Countries" at http://www.ifc.org/about MIGA member countries: see "About MIGA" and click on "Member Countries" at http://www.miga. org ICSID contracting states: see "List of Contracting States" at http://www.worldbank.org/icsid World Bank Group Countries and Regions 95 if it fails to fulfill any of its obligations to a Bank Group institution. A coun- try that ceases to be a member of the IMF automatically ceases to be a mem- ber of the Bank Group unless, within three months, the Bank Group decides by a special majority to allow the country to remain a member. When a coun- try ceases to be a member, it continues to be liable for its contractual obliga- tions, such as servicing its loans. It also continues to be liable for calls on its unpaid subscription resulting from losses sustained by a Bank Group institu- tion on guarantees or loans outstanding on the date of withdrawal. Member countries are listed by geographic region later in this chapter. A master list--with dates of membership and each country's voting power is provided in appendix D. Ways of Classifying Countries Several designations for member countries are commonly used at the Bank Group. These designations reflect important distinctions among the mem- ber countries. Although the meanings of the terms overlap--and they are all based on wealth--they are not interchangeable. Low-income, middle-income, and high-income countries In its analytical and operational work, the Bank Group characterizes coun- try economies as low-income, middle-income (subdivided into lower- middle-income and upper-middle-income), and high-income. It makes these classifications for most nonsovereign territories as well as for independent countries. Low-income and middle-income economies are sometimes referred to as "developing economies." On the basis of gross national income in 2005, low-income countries are those with average annual per capita incomes of $875 or less. For lower-middle-income countries, the figures are $876 to $3,465; for upper-middle-income countries, $3,466 to $10,725; and for high-income countries, $10,726 or more. Classification by income does not necessarily reflect development status. Developing and industrial countries In general, the term "developing" refers to countries whose economies are clas- sified as low-income or middle-income. The terms "industrial" or "developed" refer to countries whose economies are high-income. The use of these terms is not intended to imply that all economies in the group are experiencing similar development or that other economies have reached a preferred or final stage of development. 96 A Guide to the World Bank Part I and Part II countries Countries choose whether they are Part I or Part II primarily on the basis of their economic standing. Part I countries are almost all industrial countries and donors to IDA, and they pay their contributions in freely convertible cur- rency. Part II countries are almost all developing countries, some of which are donors to IDA. Part II countries are entitled to pay most of their contri- butions to IDA in local currency. MIGA makes a similar distinction between Category I and Category II member countries. The breakdown of countries into these categories differs slightly from the breakdown within IDA. Donors and borrowers In general, the term "donor" refers to a country that makes contributions specifically to IDA. In contrast, the term "borrower" refers to a country that borrows from IDA or IBRD or both. Note, however, that all member coun- tries pay capital subscriptions, and this payment is distinct from a given country's lending and borrowing. IBRD, IDA, and blend countries and graduates The distinctions between IBRD and IDA borrowers--and the circumstances in which a country may be eligible to receive a blend of IBRD loans and IDA credits and grants--are based on per capita income and the country's credit- worthiness. These distinctions are discussed in detail in chapter 1 (see also "Country Eligibility for Borrowing" in The World Bank Annual Report). Note that, as a country's per capita income increases, it can graduate out of eligi- bility for IDA credits and grants and, in turn, out of eligibility for IBRD loans (box 3.2). However, wealthier countries remain members of Bank Group organizations even if they or the enterprises operating within their borders do not draw upon Bank Group services. Country Activities and Operations As indicated in chapter 2, the Bank Group's project databases enable users to search for information on individual institutions' activities in a given country. The Bank Group's key resource for comparative data on countries is World Development Indicators, published each year in April and available in both print and online formats. In addition, the World Bank maintains numer- ous country-specific Web sites, some maintained by the regional vice presi- World Bank Group Countries and Regions 97 Box 3.2 IBRD Graduates 1947: France 1974: Iceland 1994: Barbados and 1948: Luxembourg 1975: Finland, Israel, the Slovak 1957: Netherlands and Singapore Republic 1958: Belgium 1976: Ireland 2004: Slovenia 1962: Australia and Austria 1977: Spain 2005: Czech 1964: Denmark, Malta, 1979: Greece Republic and Norway 1987: Oman 2006: Estonia and 1965: Italy 1989: Portugal and Lithuania 1967: Japan The Bahamas 2007: Hungary and 1971: Taiwan, China 1992: Cyprus Latvia 1972: New Zealand Graduates That Have Returned to Borrower Status Last Year Borrowed Year of Reinitiated Country (before relapse) Borrowing Costa Rica 1994 2000 Malaysia 1994 1998 Korea, Rep. of 1995 1998 Chile 1996 1999 dencies and some by the country offices. The Web site showing World Bank information on countries and regions is at http://www.worldbank.org/ countries. Country information for IFC is accessible through the Web sites of the investment regions; links to these sites are at http://www.ifc.org/sitemap. The appendixes to this book provide a number of resources covering both borrower and donor countries: A comprehensive table of member countries, including their memberships in the various Bank Group institutions, the years they joined, and their individual voting power (appendix D). A list of country groupings that form the constituencies of the 24 execu- tive directors with the total voting power that each director represents (appendix E). A description of additional country resources and where information about them can be found (appendix F). These resources include country offices and Web sites, PICs, depository libraries, and distributors of World Bank publications. 98 A Guide to the World Bank Initiatives for Groups of Countries Some Bank Group initiatives target groups of countries with key features in common, for example, their income level, their degree of indebtedness, or the strength of their institutions. Multilateral Debt Relief Initiative (MDRI) September 2006 marked the tenth anniversary of the Heavily Indebted Poor Countries (HIPC) Initiative. Established by the World Bank, the IMF, and member countries in 1996 and significantly expanded in 1999, the HIPC Initiative is a comprehensive approach to reducing the external debt of the world's poorest, most heavily indebted countries. Its goals are to help coun- tries move from endless restructuring of debt to lasting debt relief, to reduce multilateral debt, and to free up resources for countries that pursue economic and social reforms targeted at measurable poverty reduction. The Multilateral Debt Relief Initiative (MDRI), introduced in 2006 fol- lowing the Group of Eight (G-8) Gleneagles Summit of 2005, has built on the HIPC Initiative to cut the debt burdens of many of the world's poorest countries to acceptable levels. At the 2005 summit, the leaders of the G-8 nations proposed 100 percent cancellation of debt owed to IDA, the IMF, and the African Development Fund by some of the world's poorest coun- tries, most of them in Africa and Latin America. The MDRI was endorsed by the Bank-Fund Development Committee in September 2005. Total debt relief under the MDRI is estimated at about $50 billion, including $37 billion from IDA alone, which is equivalent to more than a quarter of IDA's total resources. Debt relief will be provided up front and irrevocably once a HIPC country becomes MDRI-eligible. The Board of Executive Directors of IDA approved the MDRI on March 28, 2006; IDA's Board of Governors adopted the MDRI on April 21, 2006. IDA began imple- menting the MDRI at the start of fiscal 2007. For more information about the MDRI, including a list of eligible countries, visit www.worldbank. org/debt. Fragile states: The LICUS Initiative Recent thinking about development models and internal reflection on past development failures in difficult environments has brought the concept of the fragile state to the fore. In November 2001, the World Bank set up the Task Force on Low-Income Countries Under Stress (LICUS), which rec- ommended ways to help countries with particularly weak policies and insti- tutions get onto a path of sustained growth and poverty reduction by World Bank Group Countries and Regions 99 improving the effectiveness of development aid. Many low-income countries under stress are affected by ongoing armed conflicts. The Low-Income Countries Under Stress Unit was established at the end of 2002 to help coordinate this Bank-wide effort. The Bank is working with development partners to create an analytic framework and assemble the right tools to help countries in difficult circumstances. Working with low-income countries under stress is about catalyzing forces of change from within, even in the most difficult environments. Analytic work suggests that there is a need to increase fragile states' capacity and accountability; to forge peace, security, and development links; to harmonize donor assistance; and to develop strong and flexible institutional responses. In February 2007, the Bank's Board approved a reform package for fragile states that aims to reduce the average time to first disbursement of reconstruction funds from nine to three months, to place 30 more staff in the field, to strengthen incentives for staff, and to increase work across the Bank on tools and good practice for this client segment. Imple- mentation of the new framework for rapid response is supported by new orga- nizational and staffing measures designed to ensure that experienced people from all parts of the Bank are mobilized to work on rapid response operations in fragile states. For more information, see http://www.worldbank.org/licus. Education for All Fast-Track Initiative Launched in 2002 by the World Bank and all major education donors, the Education for All Fast-Track Initiative is a global partnership between donor and developing countries. The initiative's goal is to accelerate progress toward achievement of the MDGs for education. It is open to all low-income coun- tries that demonstrate a serious commitment to achieving universal primary education. As of April 2006, the Fast-Track Initiative compact included 20 developing countries: Burkina Faso, Djibouti, Ethiopia, The Gambia, Ghana, Guinea, Guyana, Honduras, Kenya, Lesotho, Madagascar, Maurita- nia, Moldova, Mozambique, Nicaragua, Niger, Tajikistan, Timor-Leste, Viet- nam, and the Republic of Yemen. Since 2000, the World Bank has more than doubled its annual new lending for education: total education lending increased from $728 million in 2000 to almost $2 billion in 2006. Middle-income countries Middle-income countries continue to face substantial development chal- lenges: achieving sustained growth that provides productive employment; reducing poverty and inequality; reducing volatility, particularly in their access to private financial markets; and strengthening the institutional and 100 A Guide to the World Bank governance structures that underpin viable, market-based economies. The Bank Group is uniquely placed to help these countries craft institutional reforms, attract infrastructure investment across the public-private spectrum, improve social service delivery, and cope with volatility. To support the development efforts of middle-income countries, in 2005 the Bank Group began implementing an action plan designed to strengthen the ability of its staff to respond to these countries' borrowing needs. Initia- tives include piloting the use of countries' own environmental and social safeguards and fiduciary systems, where applicable; streamlining policy con- ditionality; and making greater use of the flexibility of Country Assistance Strategies to customize support to countries' circumstances, respond quickly to emerging opportunities, and realign investment lending instruments and disbursement mechanisms with clients' evolving needs. The plan leverages Bank Group resources and skills to provide timely, relevant, and high- quality knowledge services that draw on Bank Group synergies and partner- ships with bilateral and multilateral agencies. Small states "Small states" is a term applied to a diverse group of sovereign developing countries--some quite wealthy, some very poor, some islands or groups of islands, some landlocked, and many with populations of 1.5 million or less. Forty-five developing countries have populations of 1.5 million or less and 41 of these are members of the World Bank. A 1999 report by the Commonwealth Secretariat/World Bank Joint Task Force on Small States identified a number of characteristics that developing small states share and that shape their development challenges. For instance, many are especially vulnerable to external events, including natural disasters, that cause high volatility in national incomes; many suffer from limited capacity in the public and private sectors; and many currently face an uncertain and diffi- cult economic transition under a changing world trade regime. For more infor- mation, see http://www.worldbank.org/smallstates. Regional groupings Most Bank Group institutions approach their work by grouping developing countries into geographic regions. As discussed in chapter 1, these regions are one dimension of an organizational matrix, the other dimension being the thematic network or sector aspects of development that cut across regions. The following sections provide a brief overview of Bank Group regions: which countries they include, a few essential facts, and some information on World Bank Group Countries and Regions 101 the Bank Group's activities and priorities. They also offer information on major regional initiatives, which in most cases are partnership initiatives between the Bank Group and other organizations or governments. Additional issue briefs for world regions can be found at http://www. worldbank.org/issuebriefs. More comprehensive information on regions can be found in the annual reports of the Bank Group institutions. The regional sections hereafter follow the organization of the World Bank's regional vice presidencies (see figure 3.1 for the share of total lending provided to each region). These vice presidencies largely correspond to IFC's regional departments, except that IFC has two separate but closely coor- dinated departments within Europe and Central Asia. Additionally, IFC assigns a few countries to different regions than the Bank (see figure 3.2 for the share of total investments provided to each region). A small number of IFC investment projects are classified as global because they involve private enterprises that are active in more than one developing region. In its annual report, MIGA reports on East Asia and the Pacific and South Asia as a single region (see figure 3.3 for MIGA's outstanding portfolio dis- tribution by region). ICSID does not organize its work by regions. Note that, strictly speaking, Bank Group regions refer only to the coun- tries that are eligible for borrowing or other services. Wealthier member countries that lie within these geographic areas--for example, Barbados, Oman, and Singapore--are not normally included in lists of countries within these regions. The Bank Group gathers economic information on all coun- tries, however, and operates offices in a number of donor countries. Figure 3.1 Total IBRD-IDA Lending by Region, Fiscal 2006 South Asia 16% 20% Africa Middle East & North Africa 7% 14% East Asia & Pacific Latin America & the Caribbean 25% 17% Europe & Central Asia Source: World Bank 2006. 102 A Guide to the World Bank Figure 3.2 IFC Investment Projects by Region, Fiscal 2006 Total of $8.3 billion committed for IFC's own account and mobilized through syndicated loans Global 0.2% Middle East & North Africa 8.1% Sub-Saharan Africa 8.5% Latin America & 31.8% the Caribbean South Asia 8.5% East Asia & the Pacific 14.8% 28.1% Europe & Central Asia Source: IFC 2006. Note: Some amounts include regional shares of investments that are officially classified as global projects. Figure 3.3 MIGA's Outstanding Portfolio Distribution by Host Region as of June 30, 2006 . 16.3 Asia & the Pacific 13.8 35.8 Europe & Central Asia 46.6 22.3 Latin America & the Caribbean 20.4 7.9 Middle East & North Africa 5.3 Net exposure 19.7 Gross exposure Sub-Saharan Africa 16.3 0 10 20 30 40 50 Source: MIGA 2006. Percent Note: Percentages add up to more than 100 percent due to multicountry agreements. World Bank Group Countries and Regions 103 Africa (Sub-Saharan) This World Bank region includes the following countries that are eligible for borrowing: Angola Ethiopia Niger Benin Gabon Nigeria Botswana The Gambia Rwanda Burkina Faso Ghana São Tomé and Principe Burundi Guinea Senegal Cameroon Guinea-Bissau Seychelles Cape Verde Kenya Sierra Leone Central African Republic Lesotho Somalia Chad Liberia South Africa Comoros Madagascar Sudan Democratic Republic of Malawi Swaziland Congo Mali Tanzania Republic of Congo Mauritania Togo Côte d'Ivoire Mauritius Uganda Equatorial Guinea Mozambique Zambia Eritrea Namibia Zimbabwe All these countries are members of IBRD. As for the other institutions, Namibia and the Seychelles are not members of IDA; Djibouti is included in IFC's Africa region; São Tomé and Principe is not a member of IFC; The Comoros, Niger, São Tomé and Principe, and Somalia are not members of MIGA; and 104 A Guide to the World Bank Angola, Cape Verde, Eritrea, Ethiopia, Guinea-Bissau, Namibia, São Tomé and Principe, and South Africa are not members of ICSID. The World Bank in Sub-Saharan Africa Sub-Saharan Africa is a priority for the development community and the World Bank Group. It is the Bank Group's largest region with the greatest number of client countries and the highest volume of IDA lending, and it presents some of the greatest challenges to the development community. (Box 3.3 presents key regional facts.) In 2006, the region's leaders reaffirmed their commitment to achieving the MDGs by improving governance, accelerating and sustain- ing economic growth and job creation, delivering human services, and fight- ing poverty. The UN Millennium Project and Millennium+5 Summit, the U.K. Commission for Africa, and the Gleneagles Summit all focused global attention on the continent, and the international community committed itself to doubling Africa's development assistance to $50 billion a year by 2010. To support Africa's development, the World Bank Group implemented the Africa Action Plan. The plan sets out the Bank Group's priorities for support- ing strategies to achieve broadly shared economic growth, accelerate progress toward the MDGs, and build capable states. It also defines priorities for the Bank Group's efforts to strengthen the Development Partnership for Africa through more, and more effective, aid. The action plan has eight focus areas: Strengthen the African private sector Increase the economic empowerment of women Build skills for competitiveness in the global economy Box 3.3 Africa Fast Facts Total population: 0.7 billion Population growth: 2.1 percent Life expectancy at birth: 46 years Infant mortality per 1,000 births: 100 Female youth literacy: 77 percent 2005 gross national income per capita: $750 Number of people living with HIV/AIDS: 24.8 million Source: World Bank 2006. World Bank Group Countries and Regions 105 Raise agricultural productivity Improve access to and reliability of clean energy Expand and upgrade road networks and transit corridors Increase access to safe water and sanitation Strengthen national health systems and combat malaria and HIV/AIDS The World Bank is the largest provider of development assistance to Africa, and it has increased its support dramatically since 2001 (figures 3.4 and 3.5 present thematic and sectoral breakdowns of lending for fiscal 2006). The portfolio of projects under implementation in Africa as of June 2006 amounted to $18.4 billion. IDA funding in fiscal 2006 of $1.1 billion in grants and $3.5 billion in credits represented a doubling of aid from fiscal 2000, and disbursements of $4 billion represented an increase of more than 100 percent. Through the recently approved Multilateral Debt Relief Initia- tive, Africa will also benefit from a total of $28.9 billion of relief. The Bank's strategic objectives for Africa are outlined in the report titled Strategic Framework for Assistance to Africa, which draws on the report Can Africa Claim the 21st Century? The framework focuses on reducing conflict, improving governance, investing in people, improving aid effectiveness, and increasing economic growth through enhanced competitiveness and trade. For more information, visit the Region's Web site at http://www. worldbank.org/africa. IFC in Sub-Saharan Africa IFC is the largest multilateral source of loan and equity financing for private sector projects in Africa. The corporation's investments in the region are grow- ing rapidly and cover a wide range of sectors, including microfinance and other financial sector projects, telecommunications, infrastructure, and edu- cation. The region is also a focus of many trade finance transactions through IFC's new Global Trade Finance Program. IFC's strategy for the region calls for an increase in advisory services, which are being delivered through the new Private Enterprise Partnership for Africa, a joint program with IDA, and other initiatives. The focus includes expanding the use of leasing, promoting exports, reforming busi- ness regulation, and helping companies respond to the challenges of HIV/AIDS. IFC is also advising on projects to bring private sector partic- ipation into infrastructure, with a key recent example being a successful pri- vate concession for a port in Madagascar. The Sub-Saharan Africa Department is managed from IFC's regional hub in Johannesburg. Its Web site is at http://www.ifc.org/africa. 106 A Guide to the World Bank Figure 3.4 Africa: IBRD and IDA Lending by Theme, Fiscal 2006 Share of total of $4.8 billion Rule of Law 4% Financial & Private Public Sector 21% Sector Development Governance 20% Economic Management 1% 9% Trade & Integration Environmental & Natural Social Protection & 5% Resource Management Risk Management 5% 6% Urban Development 11% Rural Development Social Development, Gender & Inclusion 4% 14% Human Development Source: World Bank 2006. Figure 3.5 Africa: IBRD and IDA Lending by Sector, Fiscal 2006 Share of total of $4.8 billion Industry & Trade 7% 7% Education 3% Finance Water, Sanitation Energy & Mining 11% 8% & Flood Protection Agriculture, Fishing 12% & Forestry Transportation 13% Health & Other Social Services 13% Information & Law & Justice Communication <1% 26% & Public Administration Source: World Bank 2006. World Bank Group Countries and Regions 107 MIGA in Sub-Saharan Africa Sub-Saharan Africa is a priority area for MIGA, which works to attract new investment and build greater institutional capacity in the region. MIGA has established a regional field office in Johannesburg and also works through some 30 field missions and mobile offices. The agency pursues new invest- ment project guarantees and undertakes numerous technical assistance activ- ities in the region. Its efforts are focused on the need for infrastructure investment in southern Africa and on how best to support privatization efforts involving public-private partnerships. Regional Initiatives Regional initiatives in Sub-Saharan Africa include the following: Africa Action Plan. The Africa Action Plan promotes the expansion of public-private partnerships and innovative financing approaches. The Bank, IFC, and MIGA are working to combine the complementary skills of the World Bank Group to support additional private participation in priority infrastructure projects. Africa Capacity Development Operational Task Force. Capacity development remains a binding constraint to development despite substantial donor sup- port and concerted efforts by developing countries. Implementing poverty reduction strategy programs successfully and achieving the MDGs under- scores the need for stronger institutions in Africa. See "Regional Initiatives" at http://www.worldbank.org/africa. Chad-Cameroon Pipeline Project. The objective of this project is to develop the oil fields in southern Chad and construct a pipeline to offshore oil- loading facilities on Cameroon's Atlantic coast. The unprecedented frame- work for this project will transform oil wealth into direct benefits for the poor, the vulnerable, and the environment. The World Bank and the gov- ernment of Chad signed a memorandum of understanding in July 2006 under which Chad has committed 70 percent of its 2007 budget spending to priority poverty reduction programs. See "Regional Initiatives" at http:// www.worldbank.org/africa. Global Partnership for Eliminating River Blindness. This global partnership's mission is to wipe out river blindness (onchocerciasis) in the whole of Africa by 2010. River blindness, caused by the Onchocerca volvulus parasite, poses a serious public health problem and creates an obstacle to socioeconomic development in Africa, where it is endemic in 30 countries. See "Regional Initiatives" at http://www.worldbank.org/africa. 108 A Guide to the World Bank Knowledge Partnerships for Africa. A major area of focus and activity for this partnership is sharing knowledge and learning from clients and part- ners to improve the quality and impact of the World Bank's assistance. See "Regional Initiatives" at http://www.worldbank.org/africa. Multi-Country HIV/AIDS Program. This initiative is helping a growing number of African countries, almost 30 as of January 2007, to provide increased access to HIV/AIDS prevention, care, and treatment programs, with an emphasis on vulnerable groups. See "Regional Initiatives" at http://www.worldbank.org/africa. Nile Basin Initiative. Launched in February 1999, the initiative is a regional partnership in which countries of the Nile Basin have united in common pursuit of the long-term development and management of Nile waters. See "Regional Initiatives" at http://www.worldbank.org/africa. Regional integration. Most African countries have already recognized the benefits of regional integration and participate in at least one regional arrangement. While past performance has been mixed, there is renewed momentum for a more pragmatic approach to regional integration. See "Regional Initiatives" at http://www.worldbank.org/africa. Regional Program on Enterprise Development. This is an ongoing research project aimed at generating business knowledge and policy advice useful to the development of private sector manufacturing in Sub-Saharan Africa. See "Regional Initiatives" at http://www.worldbank.org/africa. Roll Back Malaria. This global initiative, made up of more than 90 part- ners, is a coordinated international approach to fighting malaria. The dis- ease kills more than 1 million people each year, most of them children. The partnership's goal is to halve the burden of malaria by 2010. The Web site is http://www.rbm.who.int. Strategic Partnership with Africa. This is an informal association of donors and African partners whose goal is to support poverty reduction in Africa by working to improve the quality and increase the quantity of assistance to Africa. The partnership's Web site is http://www.spa.synisys.com/ main.html. Sub-Saharan Africa Transport Policy Program. This international part- nership facilitates policy development and related capacity building in the transport sector. The objective is to ensure that safe, reliable, and cost- effective transport plays its full part in achieving the development objec- tives of Sub-Saharan Africa (poverty reduction, pro-poor growth, and regional integration) and to help countries compete internationally. See "Regional Initiatives" at http://www.worldbank.org/africa. World Bank Group Countries and Regions 109 TerrAfrica. This is a partnership between Sub-Saharan African countries, donor countries and agencies, civil society, and the research community with the collective goal of scaling up harmonized support of effective and efficient land management approaches that are sustainable and country driven. The Web site is http://www.terrafrica.org. Key Publications The following publications address issues in Sub-Saharan Africa: Africa Development Indicators Africa's Silk Road: China and India's New Economic Frontier Attacking Africa's Poverty: Experience from the Ground Challenges of African Growth: Opportunities, Constraints, and Strategic Directions Down to Earth: Agriculture and Poverty Reduction in Africa Disease and Mortality in Sub-Saharan Africa, second edition Facing the Challenges of African Growth: Opportunities, Constraints, and Strategic Directions Improving Health, Nutrition, and Population Outcomes in Sub-Saharan Africa: The Role of the World Bank Making Finance Work for Africa A Model for Calculating Interconnection Costs in Telecommunications A Sourcebook of HIV/AIDS Prevention Programs A Strategic Framework for Assistance to Africa: IDA and the Emerging Partnership Model 110 A Guide to the World Bank East Asia and the Pacific This World Bank region includes the following countries that are eligible for borrowing: Cambodia Malaysia Philippines China Marshall Islands Samoa Fiji Federated States of Solomon Islands Indonesia Micronesia Thailand Kiribati Mongolia Timor-Leste Republic of Korea Myanmar Tonga Lao People's Democratic Palau Vanuatu Republic Papua New Guinea Vietnam All these countries are members of the IBRD, IDA, and IFC. As for the other institutions, Kiribati, the Marshall Islands, Myanmar, and Tonga are not members of MIGA; and Kiribati, the Lao People's Democratic Republic, the Marshall Islands, Myanmar, Palau, Thailand, Vanuatu, and Vietnam are not members of ICSID. The World Bank in East Asia and the Pacific From 1965 to 2000, East Asian economies grew faster than all others in the world. The top eight economies grew twice as fast as the rest of East Asia, three World Bank Group Countries and Regions 111 Box 3.4 East Asia and the Pacific Fast Facts Total population: 1.9 billion Population growth: 0.8 percent Life expectancy at birth: 70 years Infant mortality per 1,000 births: 29 Female youth literacy: 97 percent 2005 gross national income per capita: $1,630 Number of people living with HIV/AIDS: 2.4 million Source: World Bank 2006. times as fast as Latin America and South Asia, and 25 times as fast as Sub- Saharan Africa. As a result of this growth, human welfare improved dramat- ically. Life expectancy increased from almost 40 years in 1960 to 70 years in 2006. With just 8 percent of the population living below $1 a day in 2006, the region has the chance to reduce absolute poverty significantly by 2010. Much of the region's poverty reduction has resulted from rapid growth in China, which in turn has increased exports from China's neighbors. The region's exports have almost doubled since 2003. Box 3.4 presents key regional facts. Progress on structural and institutional reforms remains a key focus for the World Bank in the region. These reforms include accelerating finan- cial and corporate restructuring; improving competitiveness; tackling imped- iments that under- mine the investment climate; ensuring adequate social protection; pursuing public sector governance reforms in such areas as public expenditure management, public financial accountability and transparency, civil service reform, and decentralization; and preventing countries from retreating into environmental neglect. To reduce vulnerability and to ensure that poor people benefit from growth, the Bank's strategy has evolved from supporting safety nets and crisis assess- ment to focusing on the policies and institutions that help households manage social risks, that build an effective social policy framework, and that enable the poor to participate in the benefits of growth. Social programs have increasingly emphasized community empowerment and demand-driven approaches to pro- mote efficiency, transparency, and effectiveness. Figures 3.6 and 3.7 present thematic and sectoral breakdowns of lending for fiscal 2006. The region's Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/eap. 112 A Guide to the World Bank Figure 3.6 East Asia and the Pacific: IBRD and IDA Lending by Theme, Fiscal 2006 Share of total of $3.4 billion Financial & Private 22% Sector Development 3% Trade & Integration Environmental & Natural Rule of Law <1% 12% Resource Management Public Sector Governance 11% 13% Urban Development Economic Management 2% Social Protection & Risk Management 4% 14% Rural Development Social Development, Gender & Inclusion 2% 17% Human Development Source: World Bank 2006. Figure 3.7 East Asia and the Pacific: IBRD and IDA Lending by Sector, Fiscal 2006 Share of total of $3.4 billion Industry & Trade 1% 8% Education 6% Finance Energy & Mining 12% Water, Sanitation 17% & Flood Protection Transportation 19% Agriculture, Fishing 11% & Forestry Health & Other Social Services 5% Information & Law & Justice Communication <1% 20% & Public Administration Source: World Bank 2006. World Bank Group Countries and Regions 113 IFC in East Asia and the Pacific IFC is helping economies deepen and diversify their financial systems, strengthen corporate governance and other responsible business practices, and improve the environment for private investment in infrastructure. IFC's focus in the region includes strengthening the sustainability of private sector development by building financial sector institutions; developing model transactions that will further catalyze private investment in a variety of sec- tors; and setting standards for corporate governance, international account- ing, environmental technologies, best practices, and efficiency of operations. IFC also operates multidonor advisory services facilities in places throughout the region where support for private sector development, including small and medium enterprises, is especially crucial, namely, the Mekong region; the Pacific islands; and less developed areas of China, Indonesia, and the Philippines. The East Asia and the Pacific Department is managed from IFC's regional hub in Hong Kong, China. Its Web site is at http://www.ifc.org/eastasia. MIGA in East Asia and the Pacific MIGA supports projects in East Asia and the Pacific through its guarantee program as well as through technical assistance activities in the region. Tech- nical assistance goals for the region include developing and implementing targeting strategies to mobilize and promote investment opportunities, iden- tifying and fostering sectors with solid potential for investment promotion, and devising targeted work programs. Other key objectives involve assisting in the development and implementation of information technology tools and promotional materials. Regional Initiatives The following initiatives are in place in East Asia and the Pacific: Asia Alternative Energy Program. This is a partnership between the World Bank and key bilateral donors to incorporate alternative energy options into the design of energy sector strategies and lending operations for all the Bank's client countries in Asia. The Web site is at http://www. worldbank.org/astae. Asia Development Forum. This is a regional forum to strengthen links and policy dialogues within the development community of the Asia and Pacific region. It is sponsored by the Asian Development Bank, the Korea Development Institute, the Korea Institute for International Economic 114 A Guide to the World Bank Policy, and the World Bank. The Web site is at http://www.adb.org/ Documents/Events/2002/ADF. InfoCity: Connecting Cities to Global Knowledge and Resources. The Info- City initiative, funded by the Cities Alliance, seeks to facilitate the exchange of experience, ideas, and knowledge and to provide a repository for this type of information among participating cities in East Asia. The Web site is at http://infocity.org. Key Publications The following publications deal with East Asia and the Pacific: Connecting East Asia: A New Framework for Infrastructure Dancing with Giants: China, India, and the Global Economy East Asia Decentralizes: Making Local Government Work East Asia Integrates: A Trade Policy Agenda for Shared Growth East Asian Finance: The Road to Robust Markets An East Asian Renaissance: Ideas for Economic Growth East Asian Visions: Perspectives on Economic Development Global Change and East Asian Policy Initiatives Global Production Networking and Technological Change in East Asia Postindustrial East Asian Cities Sustainable Energy in China: The Closing Window of Opportunity Under New Ownership: China's State-Owned Enterprises World Bank Group Countries and Regions 115 South Asia This World Bank region includes the following countries that are eligible for borrowing: Afghanistan India Pakistan Bangladesh Maldives Sri Lanka Bhutan Nepal All these countries are members of IBRD and IDA. As for the other insti- tutions, Afghanistan and Pakistan are included in IFC's Middle East and North Africa region; Bhutan is not a member of MIGA; and Bhutan, India, and the Maldives are not members of ICSID. The World Bank in South Asia South Asia entered the 21st century having experienced a decade of rapid eco- nomic growth: growth rates for the region averaged 5.9 percent annually dur- ing the 1990s. In recent years, many nations in the region have reduced tariffs, removed trade barriers, dismantled restrictions on domestic and foreign private investment, and reformed their financial systems. However, South Asia still attracts the lowest rate of foreign direct investment in the world, just 0.5 percent 116 A Guide to the World Bank Box 3.5 South Asia Fast Facts Total population: 1.5 billion Population growth: 1.6 percent Life expectancy at birth: 63 years Infant mortality per 1,000 births: 66 Female youth literacy: 65 percent 2005 gross national income per capita: $680 Number of people living with HIV/AIDS: 6.2 million Source: World Bank 2006. of gross domestic product. Some economies are still highly protected, and intra- regional trade is still far below its potential. Box 3.5 presents key regional facts. Despite recent gains, the region remains one of the most disadvantaged in the world: more than one-third of its 1.5 billion people live on less than $1 a day, making South Asia home to nearly half the world's poor. This perva- sive poverty is both a cause and a consequence of its low level of human devel- opment. Despite improvements in education and health services, the region still has the world's highest youth illiteracy rate and one-third of the world's maternal deaths. Nearly half of children under five years of age are malnour- ished. Environmental degradation, inadequate infrastructure, and social exclusion are also among the many obstacles to growth and poverty reduc- tion. South Asia's long-term economic prospects will hinge on much needed reforms in the key sectors of banking, power, and infrastructure, as well as on commitments to improve public spending and reform state enterprises. Improved governance, including stronger regulatory reforms and increased transparency, is a critical challenge for the region. The World Bank's strategy for the South Asia region has two pillars: accel- erated growth and faster human development. Accelerating growth will require addressing the region's vast urban and rural infrastructure needs, which have been ignored because of a lack of resources and effective policy frameworks that could promote public-private partnerships. Despite having five megacities with populations of more than 10 million people, South Asia is the least urbanized region in the world and is the only region that has no city that can provide piped water 24 hours a day. In India, private investment in infrastructure has remained well under the projected 2 percent of gross World Bank Group Countries and Regions 117 domestic product. Deficiencies in the region's overall investment climate that need to be addressed include corruption and excessive red tape. More rapid human development has different meanings for different parts of South Asia. In Bangladesh, the Maldives, Sri Lanka, and parts of India, such as Kerala, which have achieved such basic goals as universal enrollment in primary education, the focus is on improving quality, whereas in other parts of the region, such as Pakistan, concerted efforts are needed to attain these basic goals, especially for women. In all cases, in supporting public expendi- tures for faster human development, the strategy emphasizes increasing the accountability of service providers and policy makers to poor people. Figures 3.8 and 3.9 provide thematic and sectoral breakdowns of lending for fiscal 2006. The region's Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/sar. IFC in South Asia South Asia has been one of the world's fastest-growing regions in recent years, with particularly strong growth in India. IFC's strategic priorities in the region include increasing private investment in infrastructure, developing local financial markets, supporting the restructuring and modernization of domestic manufacturing enterprises, and promoting the growth of small businesses. Through investments that have a high development impact, IFC is helping companies in the region improve their international competitive- ness and pursue new investment opportunities in South Asia and beyond. Through its South Asia Enterprise Development Facility, IFC provides advisory services to improve the business environment, strengthen providers of business services, and increase financial services for smaller businesses. This multidonor facility focuses on Bangladesh, Bhutan, Nepal, and northeast India and is currently expanding to serve the Maldives and Sri Lanka. The South Asia Department is managed from IFC's regional hub in New Delhi. Its Web site is at http://www.ifc.org/southasia. MIGA in South Asia MIGA supports projects in South Asia through guarantees and technical assis- tance. Recent guarantee activity has occurred in the power sector in Nepal and the software and telecommunications industries in Pakistan. Regional Initiatives Regional initiatives include the following: 118 A Guide to the World Bank Figure 3.8 South Asia: IBRD and IDA Lending by Theme, Fiscal 2006 Share of total of $3.8 billion Financial & Private Rule of Law <1% 14% Sector Development Public Sector Governance 16% 4% Trade & Integration Economic Management 1% Environmental & Natural 2% Resource Management Social Protection & Risk Management 12% 15% Urban Development 15% Rural Development Social Development, Gender & Inclusion 10% 10% Human Development Source: World Bank 2006. Figure 3.9 South Asia: IBRD and IDA Lending by Sector, Fiscal 2006 Share of total of $3.8 billion Industry & Trade 8% 10% Education 2% Finance Energy & Mining 13% Water, Sanitation 8% & Flood Protection Agriculture, Fishing 10% & Forestry Transportation 14% Health & Other Social Services 5% Information & Law & Justice Communication 1% 29% & Public Administration Source: World Bank 2006. World Bank Group Countries and Regions 119 Immunization Efforts in India and South Asia. The World Bank is the largest external financier of immunization programs in South Asia. It is actively working with countries to strengthen their routine immunization programs for major childhood diseases and, more recently, to accelerate polio eradication. In agreement with national governments, the goal is to reach all children with effective and high quality vaccinations. Over the next few years, the Bank will collaborate with governments in South Asia to help strengthen routine immunization services, eradicate polio, and introduce "new" vaccines. Strengthening the vaccine delivery system to ensure that all children are immunized with the basic six vaccines remains the top priority. HIV/AIDS and South Asia. Between 5.5 and 6 million people in South Asia are living with HIV and AIDS. The World Bank has focused on mobiliz- ing South Asian countries to improve and accelerate their responses to HIV and AIDS. It has supported national efforts to slow the spread of HIV since the first India project in 1992, and has committed $380 million to support national programs to date. The main components of these proj- ects are surveillance, monitoring and evaluation, targeted interventions for vulnerable populations, blood safety, efforts aimed at reducing stigma among the general population, and strengthening public and private insti- tutions for a multisector response. Tuberculosis in South Asia. Three of the 10 countries with the largest num- ber of tuberculosis (TB) patients are in South Asia. India carries the world's greatest burden of tuberculosis cases, so advances in India's TB pro- grams are critical to global TB control. In India, the World Bank supports a revised national TB control program, which treated 1.1 million patients in 1999, with that number increasing in 2000 under DOTS (Directly- Observed Treatment, Short-course--a cost-effective strategy that reduces illness, deaths, and transmission). Treatment success rates in India are at 84 percent. In Bangladesh, the World Bank has supported TB control efforts through two consecutive health projects that aim to implement pri- ority public health interventions and ensure sustainability through systems reform and integration. In these countries, the challenges ahead are expanding DOTS coverage, involving the private sector, and improving program management at all levels of government. Child Labor and South Asia. Despite the fact that legislation banning child labor has been enacted in all South Asian countries, South Asia remains home to the largest number of working children in the world. The long- term solution to child labor problems lies in reducing poverty, improving the quality of education, and expanding access to schooling to disadvan- 120 A Guide to the World Bank taged social groups. These are central objectives of the Bank's assistance programs in the South Asian countries. Urban Air Quality Management. The majority of South Asian cities suffer from extremely high levels of urban air pollution, particularly in the form of small particles. Regionwide, urban air pollution is estimated to cause over 250,000 deaths and billions of cases of respiratory illnesses every year. The World Bank, with support from the United Nations Development Pro- gramme, has initiated a regional program to address this issue. It draws lessons from international experience, identifies where more data are needed to arrive at viable policy recommendations, and assists governments, civil society, and the media as they work to improve urban air quality. Key Publications The following publications deal with South Asia: Dancing with Giants: China, India, and the Global Economy Ending Poverty in South Asia: Ideas that Work Explaining South Asia's Development Performance: The Role of Good Policies Improving Access to Finance for India's Rural Poor India and the WTO India's Undernourished Children: A Call for Reform and Action Local Organizations in Decentralized Development: Their Functions and Their Performance in India Overcoming Drought: Adaptation Strategies for Andhra Pradesh World Bank Group Countries and Regions 121 Europe and Central Asia This World Bank region includes the following countries that are eligible for borrowing: Albania Kyrgyz Republic Serbia Armenia Former Yugoslav Slovak Republic Azerbaijan Republic of Tajikistan Belarus Macedonia Turkey Bosnia and Herzegovina Moldova Turkmenistan Bulgaria Montenegro Ukraine Croatia Poland Uzbekistan Georgia Romania Kazakhstan Russian Federation All the countries listed are members of IBRD, IFC, and MIGA. As for the other institutions, Belarus, Bulgaria, Estonia, Lithuania, Romania, and Turkmenistan are not members of IDA; The Czech Republic, Estonia, Lithuania, and Slovenia are included in IFC's Central and Eastern Europe Region; and The Kyrgyz Republic, Moldova, Montenegro, Poland, Russia, Serbia, and Tajikistan are not members of ICSID. 122 A Guide to the World Bank Box 3.6 Europe and Central Asia Fast Facts Total population: 0.5 billion Population growth: 0.1 percent Life expectancy at birth: 69 years Infant mortality per 1,000 births: 28 Female youth literacy: 98 percent 2005 gross national income per capita: $4,110 Number of people living with HIV/AIDS: 1.5 million Source: World Bank 2006. The World Bank in Europe and Central Asia Most countries in the region have established the basic institutions and frame- work of open market economies. Poverty has declined significantly: overall, 40 million people moved out of poverty between 1999 and 2003, but poverty remains widespread in Central Asia and the South Caucasus. Box 3.6 presents key regional facts. At the other end of the spectrum, middle-income countries in the region face the same challenge as such countries everywhere--convergence with upper-income countries. Per capita income in the eight newest members of the European Union is 40 to 60 percent that of the countries they joined, and convergence is expected to take 20 to 30 years. Countries such as Azer- baijan, Kazakhstan, and Russia struggle with policy issues similar to those other resource-rich countries face, including the need to ensure good gover- nance of their revenues and reduce their dependence on extractive industries. The legacy of central planning remains throughout the region, with the stage of transition varying from country to country. On the positive side, human development indicators in education and health are relatively good. On the negative side, many towns are located in far-flung and unviable loca- tions, especially in Russia; state bureaucracies are bloated and overextended; and serious environmental issues remain. Less than full recovery from the recession that was in effect at the onset of transition and the emergence of new challenges mean that countries in the region face an uphill task in meet- ing the MDGs, especially those related to health and the environment. Another particularly worrisome issue is the rapid spread of tuberculosis and HIV/AIDS throughout the region. World Bank Group Countries and Regions 123 The Bank's Country Assistance Strategies are tailored to meet the needs of each subregion. They are organized around two broad themes: fostering growth and competitiveness by building a climate for investment, and pro- moting social inclusion. The Bank is also addressing global issues such as HIV/AIDS--which goes hand in hand with youth issues in Europe and Central Asia--and key environmental challenges pertaining to biodiversity, water, carbon emissions, and renewable energy, among others. Figures 3.10 and 3.11 present thematic and sectoral breakdowns of lending for fiscal 2006. The region's Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/eca. IFC in Europe and Central Asia IFC pursues its work in Europe and Central Asia through two depart- ments: the Central and Eastern Europe Department, managed from a regional hub in Moscow, and the Southern Europe and Central Asia Department, managed from a regional hub in Istanbul. Growth is strong in the region, with most countries at varying stages of transition to mar- ket economies and integration with Western private capital. IFC activity is led by the financial sector, where IFC's investments, expertise in struc- turing transactions, and advice to firms and governments are helping to build capital markets and expand access to finance. Other key sectors include infrastructure and manufacturing, and IFC continues to assist with privatization in many industries. IFC provides advisory services through multidonor operations, the Private Enterprise Partnership in Russia and the former Soviet republics, and a sim- ilar partnership in South East Europe. Efforts are tailored to the specific needs of economies, which range from new or prospective members of the Euro- pean Union to frontier markets where opportunities for investment remain severely constrained. Country and regional programs focus on leasing, hous- ing and mortgage finance, microfinance, corporate governance, and supply chain links between small and large companies. IFC's Europe and Central Asia Web site, covering countries served by both regional departments, is at http://www.ifc.org/eca. MIGA in Europe and Central Asia Guarantees in the energy, agribusiness, manufacturing, and finance sectors, as well as strong capacity-building assistance, highlight MIGA's current efforts in Europe and Central Asia. For more information, see "Regions" at http://www.miga.org. 124 A Guide to the World Bank Figure 3.10 Europe and Central Asia: IBRD and IDA Lending by Theme, Fiscal 2006 Share of total of $4 billion Financial & Private Rule of Law 10% 35% Sector Development Public Sector Governance 15% Economic 6% Trade & Integration Management <1% Environmental & Natural Social Protection & 4% Resource Management Risk Management 8% 5% Urban Development 6% Rural Development Social Development, Gender & Inclusion 2% 9% Human Development Source: World Bank 2006. Figure 3.11 Europe and Central Asia: IBRD and IDA Lending by Sector, Fiscal 2006 Share of total of $4 billion Industry & Trade 7% 3% Education 9% Finance Water, Sanitation Energy & Mining 28% <1% & Flood Protection Agriculture, Fishing 3% & Forestry Transportation 10% Law & Justice 32% & Public Administration Health & Other Social Services 8% Source: World Bank 2006. World Bank Group Countries and Regions 125 Regional Initiatives Regional initiatives include the following: Black Sea and Danube Basin Initiative. The Black Sea and Danube Basin have become polluted over the past four decades, causing significant losses through reduced revenues from tourism and fisheries, loss of biodiversity, and increased prevalence of water-borne diseases. This initiative aims to promote investment and capacity building to return the environment to its condition in the 1960s. See "Regional Initiatives" at http://www. worldbank.org/eca. European Union integration. In recent years, the World Bank has actively partnered with the accession candidate countries and the European Com- mission in relation to the European Union's enlargement process. See "Regional Initiatives" at http://www.worldbank.org/eca. Forest law enforcement and governance in Europe and North Asia. In November 2005, 48 countries committed to cracking down on illegal log- ging by improving forest law enforcement and governance. To this end, they signed the St. Petersburg Declaration. See "Regional Initiatives" at http://www.worldbank.org/eca. Program of Accounting Reform and Institutional Strengthening. This regional program seeks to create a transparent policy environment and effective institutional framework for corporate reporting within South Central and South East Europe. See "Regional Initiatives" at http://www. worldbank.org/eca. South Caucasus regional initiatives. The Caucasus region has been a major trade and transport corridor since ancient times, but during the last decade it has lost this role because transport costs are prohibitively high. See "Regional Initiatives" at http://www.worldbank.org/eca. South East Europe Social Development Initiative. This regional initiative aims to provide the governments of South East Europe and the donor community involved in the region (in particular, the World Bank) with the capacity to carry out social analyses, promote institution building, and launch pilot projects to address interethnic tensions and social cohesion issues. See "Regional Initiatives" at http://www.worldbank.org/eca. Trade and Transport Facilitation in South East Europe Program. This ini- tiative aims to foster trade in the subregion. It promotes more efficient and less costly trade flows across the countries of South East Europe and pro- vides customs standards compatible with those of the European Union. The Web site is http://www.seerecon.org/ttfse. 126 A Guide to the World Bank Key Publications The following publications deal with Europe and Central Asia: Anticorruption in Transition: Who Is Succeeding and Why? The Caucasian Tiger: Sustaining Economic Growth in Armenia Enhancing Job Opportunities: Eastern Europe and the Former Soviet Union Fiscal Policy and Economic Growth: Lessons for Transition Economies From Disintegration to Reintegration: Eastern Europe and the Former Soviet Union in International Trade From Red to Gray: The Third Transition of Aging Populations in Eastern Europe and the Former Soviet Union Growth, Poverty, and Inequality: Eastern Europe and the Former Soviet Union Judicial Systems in Transition Economies: Assessing the Past, Looking to the Future Migration and Remittances in Eastern Europe and the Former Soviet Union Pension Reform in Europe: Process and Progress Reducing Poverty through Growth and Social Policy Reform in Russia World Bank Group Countries and Regions 127 Latin America and the Caribbean This World Bank region includes the following countries that are eligible for borrowing: Antigua and Barbuda El Salvador Peru Argentina Grenada St. Kitts and Nevis Belize Guatemala St. Lucia Bolivia Guyana St. Vincent and the Brazil Haiti Grenadines Chile Honduras Suriname Colombia Jamaica Trinidad and Tobago Costa Rica Mexico Uruguay Dominica Nicaragua República Bolivariana de Dominican Republic Panama Venezuela Ecuador Paraguay All these countries are members of IBRD. As for the other institutions, Jamaica, Suriname, Trinidad and Tobago, and República Bolivariana de Venezuela are not members of IDA; The Bahamas and Barbados are included in IFC's Latin America and the Caribbean region; St. Vincent and the Grenadines and Suriname are not members of IFC; Mexico is not a member of MIGA; and Antigua and Barbuda, Belize, Brazil, Dominica, the Dominican Repub- lic, Haiti, Mexico, and Suriname are not members of ICSID. 128 A Guide to the World Bank The World Bank in Latin America and the Caribbean Latin America and the Caribbean is a region of broad diversity, with people who speak Spanish, Portuguese, English, French, and some 400 indigenous languages. Its topography and ecosystems range from tropical islands to high sierras and altiplanos, rainforests, deserts, and sprawling plains. It is the most urbanized region in the developing world, with three-quarters of its people living in and around cities, but natural resources and agriculture are also important to many of its economies, which include some of the developing world's largest, such as Brazil and Mexico, and some of the smallest. Despite immense resources and dynamic societies, deep inequalities of wealth persist in most countries. About a quarter of the region's population lives in poverty (defined as living on less than $2 a day), roughly the same as in the late 1980s. Approximately 50 million of these people (9.5 percent) are extremely poor (living on less than $1 a day). Box 3.7 presents key regional facts. Despite ongoing recovery and improved economic prospects in recent years, the region still faces the significant challenge of persistent poverty because of both entrenched high inequality, which is exacerbated by the exclusion of marginal groups, and modest and volatile growth in recent decades. World Bank support to the region aims to reduce poverty through sustained, equitable growth and a focus on the poorest and most vulnerable people. Priorities include improving the investment climate and competitiveness to foster job creation; strengthening education and creating innovative systems for enhancing human capital and increasing productivity; improving public sector governance and institutions; Box 3.7 Latin America and the Caribbean Fast Facts Total population: 0.6 billion Population growth: 1.4 percent Life expectancy at birth: 72 years Infant mortality per 1,000 births: 27 Female youth literacy: 97 percent 2005 gross national income per capita: $3,990 Number of people living with HIV/AIDS: 1.9 million Source: World Bank 2006. World Bank Group Countries and Regions 129 fostering social equity and inclusion and achieving an inclusive, but affordable, welfare system; strengthening environmental institutions and promoting effective use of natural resources; and consolidating macroeconomic and financial stability and using fiscal resources for infrastructure investments. The Bank is tailoring assistance to meet the needs of citizens in Latin America and the Caribbean, particularly in middle-income countries with high poverty. In Chile, for instance, the Bank has moved from financing a broad range of projects to supporting selected areas of focus (education, social protection, and innovation) that are part of the country's overall strategy to ensure high growth with equity. Figures 3.12 and 3.13 provide thematic and sectoral breakdowns of lending for fiscal 2006. The region's Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/lac. IFC in Latin America and the Caribbean IFC has had one of the largest regional programs in its 50-year history in Latin America and the Caribbean, which continues to present challenges in relation to its investment climate, financial sector development, and infrastructure. IFC is working to help develop a broadly based private sec- tor whose benefits can reach poorer segments of the population. IFC pro- vided countercyclical support during the region's recent crisis--supporting export-earning projects in Argentina, for example, and helping reactivate trade financing in Brazil--and is now focusing on providing longer-term funding for private enterprises and for select projects with a broad impact on social and economic inclusion. IFC's investments emphasize enhanc- ing competitiveness, providing support to high-growth industries, and helping the region's firms become global players. The region is also a focus for IFC's work in structured finance, risk management, and local currency transactions. Advisory services for the region are being delivered through a multi- donor facility set up by IFC to provide consulting and business services in support of private sector development. The facility is working with gov- ernments and key stakeholders to improve conditions for private sector development, with IFC clients to enhance the development impact of investments, and with financial institutions to help small businesses gain better access to finance. 130 A Guide to the World Bank Figure 3.12 Latin America and the Caribbean: IBRD and IDA Lending by Theme, Fiscal 2006 Share of total of $5.9 billion Financial & Private Rule of Law 2% 25% Sector Development Public Sector Governance 18% Economic Management 1% 12% Trade & Integration Social Protection & Risk Management 10% Environmental & Natural 8% Resource Management Social Development, Gender & Inclusion 5% 6% Urban Development Human Development 9% 4% Rural Development Source: World Bank 2006. Figure 3.13 Latin America and the Caribbean: IBRD and IDA Lending by Sector, Fiscal 2006 Share of total of $5.9 billion Industry & Trade 10% 12% Education Energy & Mining 3% 15% Finance Transportation 13% Water, Sanitation 6% & Flood Protection Health & Other Agriculture, Fishing Social Services 14% 5% & Forestry Information & Law & Justice Communication <1% 22% & Public Administration Source: World Bank 2006. World Bank Group Countries and Regions 131 The Latin America and the Caribbean Department is managed from IFC's regional hub in Rio de Janeiro. Its Web site is at http://www.ifc.org/lac. MIGA in Latin America and the Caribbean MIGA supports projects in Latin America and the Caribbean through its guarantee program. MIGA also undertakes technical assistance activities in the region, focusing on investment promotion in countries that have not been recipients of substantial foreign direct investment in the past. Regional Initiatives The following initiatives are among those in place in Latin America and the Caribbean: Clean Air Initiative in Latin American Cities. This initiative focuses on reversing the deterioration of urban air quality caused by rapid urbanization, increased vehicular transport, and industrial production. It is a partnership of city governments, private sector companies, international development agencies and foundations, NGOs, and academic institutions, with a tech- nical secretariat at the World Bank. See http://www.cleanairnet.org/lac. Global Telemedicine and Teaching Network. Through an expanded network and partnerships, the Global Telemedicine and Teaching Network--a satellite-based and Internet-based communications platform, the Global Development Learning Network, and Medical Missions for Children improve treatment of critically ill children in remote areas in real time. See "Regional Initiatives" at http://www.worldbank.org/lac. Landfill Gas-to-Energy Initiative for Latin American Cities. The objectives of this program are to develop outreach activities to promote this environ- mentally sound, nonconventional energy source; document experiences in the region and in selected cities elsewhere; and help implement a regional approach aimed at maximum reduction of methane emissions and the development of carbon trading opportunities. See "Regional Initiatives" at http://www.worldbank.org/lac. Mesoamerican Biological Corridor. Home to rare and endangered species, as well as human inhabitants, the goal of the Mesoamerican Biologi- cal Corridor is to integrate conservation, protection, and ecological bal- ance within the framework of sustainable economic development. See http://www.biomeso.net. 132 A Guide to the World Bank The Multi-Country HIV/AIDS Prevention and Control Lending Program for the Caribbean. This program provides loans or credits to help individ- ual countries finance their national HIV/AIDS prevention and control projects. See "Regional Initiatives" at http://www.worldbank.org/lac. Pilot Program to Protect the Brazilian Rain Forest. This multilateral initia- tive of the Brazilian government, civil society, and the international com- munity is aimed at developing innovative tools and methodologies for conserving Brazil's rain forests. See "Regional Initiatives" at http://www. worldbank.org/lac. Key Publications Publications about Latin America and the Caribbean include the following: Beyond the City: The Rural Contribution to Development Beyond Survival: Protecting Households from Health Shocks in Latin America Challenges of CAFTA: Maximizing the Benefits for Central America Close to Home: The Development Impact of Remittances Citizens, Politicians, and Providers: The Latin American Experience with Service Delivery Reform Emerging Capital Markets and Globalization: The Latin American Experience Inequality in Latin America and the Caribbean: Breaking with History? Infrastructure in Latin America and the Caribbean: Recent Developments and Key Challenges Keeping the Promise of Social Security In Latin America Lessons from NAFTA for Latin America and the Caribbean Natural Resources: Neither Curse Nor Destiny Poverty Reduction and Growth: Virtuous and Vicious Circles A Time to Choose: Caribbean Development in the 21st Century The Urban Poor in Latin America World Bank Group Countries and Regions 133 Middle East and North Africa This World Bank region includes the following countries that are eligible for borrowing: Algeria Iraq Syrian Arab Republic Djibouti Jordan Tunisia Arab Republic of Egypt Lebanon Republic of Yemen Islamic Republic of Iran Morocco All these countries are members of IBRD. There are also World Bank activities in the West Bank and Gaza. As for the other institutions, Afghanistan, Kuwait, Oman, Pakistan, Saudi Arabia, and the United Arab Emirates are also included in IFC's Middle East and North Africa region, which also covers the West Bank and Gaza; Djibouti is included in IFC's Africa region; Iraq is not a member of MIGA; and Djibouti, the Islamic Republic of Iran, and Iraq are not members of ICSID. The World Bank in the Middle East and North Africa The Middle East and North Africa is an economically diverse region that includes the oil-rich economies in the Gulf and countries that are resource- scarce in relation to population, such as Egypt, Morocco, and the Republic 134 A Guide to the World Bank Box 3.8 Middle East and North Africa Fast Facts Total population: 0.3 billion Population growth: 1.8 percent Life expectancy at birth: 69 years Infant mortality per 1,000 births: 44 Female youth literacy: 81 percent 2005 gross national income per capita: $2,240 Number of people living with HIV/AIDS: 0.4 million Source: World Bank 2006. of Yemen. The region's economic fortunes over much of the past quarter cen- tury have been heavily influenced by two factors: the price of oil and the legacy of economic policies and structures that emphasized a leading role for the state. Box 3.8 presents key regional facts. Beginning in the late 1980s, many of the region's economies were com- mitted to far-reaching economic reforms to restore macroeconomic bal- ances and promote private sector­led development. As a result, the late 1990s saw improvements: average gross national income per capita for the region increased from $1,800 in 1985 to $2,080 in 2000. Annual gross domestic product growth in the region has remained steady at 3.1 percent for the past decade. Despite its improved performance, the region continues to face important economic and social challenges. A key issue is unemployment, which is around 15 percent, although more than 20 percent of the workforce is unem- ployed in Algeria, Libya, Morocco, and the West Bank and Gaza. Unemploy- ment is only slightly less pressing in the Islamic Republic of Iran, Jordan, Lebanon, and Tunisia. Jobless rates among youth are twice the regional aver- age in some countries, requiring the region to create about 4 million jobs a year in the next few years to accommodate new entrants into the labor market. The Bank has identified five areas that represent a common challenge across the region--public sector efficiency and governance, private sector develop- ment and employment creation, education, sustainable water resource man- agement, and the gender gap--and takes their impact into account for each intervention it undertakes in a country. Figures 3.14 and 3.15 provide a thematic and sectoral breakdown of lending for fiscal 2006. The region's Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/mena. World Bank Group Countries and Regions 135 Figure 3.14 Middle East and North Africa: IBRD and IDA Lending by Theme, Fiscal 2006 Share of total of $1.7 billion Financial & Private Rule of Law 3% 53% Sector Development Environmental & Natural 3% Resource Management Public Sector Governance 13% 2% Urban Development Social Protection & 10% Rural Development Risk Management 4% Social Development, Gender & Inclusion 4% 8% Human Development Source: World Bank 2006. Figure 3.15 Middle East and North Africa: IBRD and IDA Lending by Sector, Fiscal 2006 Share of total of $1.7 billion 9% Education 36% Finance Industry & Trade 1% Water, Sanitation Energy & Mining 18% 6% & Flood Protection Agriculture, Fishing 1% & Forestry Law & Justice Transportation 14% 15% & Public Administration Source: World Bank 2006. 136 A Guide to the World Bank IFC in the Middle East and North Africa IFC aims to increase private investment and job creation to accelerate growth and promote economies that are more open. In support of this strategy, IFC's field presence has expanded rapidly. Recent investments cover many sectors, including the financial sector, manufacturing, oil and gas, education, agribusiness, and infrastructure. IFC is using advisory services, separately or in combination with long- term capital, to strengthen the region's private sector and promote best prac- tices. Through its Private Enterprise Partnership for the Middle East and North Africa, IFC provides a wide range of advisory services. Because small and medium enterprises are crucial to many economies in the region, the partnership is helping facilitate their development and their access to finance. It also provides advice on privatization and on business-enabling environ- ments, including for women entrepreneurs, and it provides support for public- private partnerships. The Middle East and North Africa Department is managed from IFC's regional hub in Cairo. Its Web site is at http://www.ifc.org/mena. MIGA in the Middle East and North Africa MIGA offers guarantee services in the region and provides support to regional investors making investments outside the region. It undertakes tech- nical assistance initiatives and participates in a broader World Bank Group outreach effort aimed at promoting the use of a wider array of World Bank Group tools for developing the private sector. Regional Initiatives Regional initiatives in the Middle East and North Africa include the following: Governance in the Middle East and North Africa Initiative. This initiative seeks to improve governance institutions and processes, the weaknesses of which may lead to disappointing economic performance. It is a partnership of individual researchers from the region, local think tanks, and donor agencies. The Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/mena/governance. The Middle East and North Africa Development Forum. This is a partner- ship, with participation by the World Bank Institute, the Bank's Middle East and North Africa Regional Vice Presidency, the UN Development Programme, and think tanks. Its goals include empowering civil society to participate in shaping public policy, contributing to the policy debate World Bank Group Countries and Regions 137 in key areas of regional interest, improving the extent and quality of research on economic and social policy issues, and improving networks to promote development in the region. The Web site is at http://www.worldbank. org/wbi/mdf. Trade and Investment Climate. The main objective of this program is to use global integration as a way to enhance growth, expand jobs, and increase productivity. To achieve greater global integration, the program calls for joint liberalization of trade in goods and services, involving, among other things, much freer flows of labor and capital than has thus far been the case. Key Publications The following publications deal with the Middle East and North Africa: Better Governance for Development in the Middle East and North Africa: Enhancing Inclusiveness and Accountability HIV/AIDS in the Middle East and North Africa: The Costs of Inaction Making the Most of Scarcity: Accountability for Better Water Management in the Middle East and North Africa Pensions in the Middle East and North Africa: Time for Change Sustaining Gains in Poverty Reduction and Human Development in the Middle East and North Africa Trade, Investment, and Development in the Middle East and North Africa: Engaging with the World Unlocking the Employment Potential in the Middle East and North Africa: Toward a New Social Contract Aircraft workers lay down flooring in Brazil as part of an IFC-financed project. IFC invests in private enterprises throughout most of the developing world. Its investments help to create jobs, build economies, and generate tax revenue. 4Topics in Development This chapter provides an overview of major aspects of develop- ment in which the World Bank Group is involved. These topics are listed alphabetically with a focus on key initiatives, Web sites, and publications. Because of space constraints, the listing of topics is not intended to be comprehensive. The broad themes in Bank Group work are covered under "Strategies" in chapter 2. As discussed in that section, the Bank Group is increasingly emphasizing the social aspects of develop- ment. A key organizing principle of its work is the Millennium Development Goals (MDGs) as defined by the United Nations. Another key aspect of Bank Group activities, as explained in chapter 1, is the matrix in which units focused on development sectors (called "networks") intersect with units focused on world regions. The networks correspond to many of the topics covered in this chapter. These topics are as follows: Agriculture and rural Health, nutrition, and development population Aid effectiveness Indigenous peoples Combating corruption Information and Conflict prevention and communication technologies reconstruction Infrastructure Debt relief Labor and social protection Economic research and Law, regulation, and the data judiciary Education Manufacturing and services Empowerment and Poverty participation Private sector development Energy and mining Social development Environment Sustainable development Financial sector Trade Gender Transport Globalization Urban development Governance Water 139 140 A Guide to the World Bank Agriculture and Rural Development Seventy percent of the world's poor live in rural areas, and this rural popula- tion relies on agriculture as its main source of income. The Bank Group pur- sues its work in agriculture and rural development through the units and programs discussed in this section. Agriculture and Rural Development Department (World Bank) The Agriculture and Rural Development Department, one of the depart- ments that make up the Sustainable Development Network, works to reduce poverty through sustainable rural development. To this end, the department provides analytic and advisory services to the Bank's regions on a wide range of agriculture and rural development topics. These services include preparing and implementing the World Bank's corporate strategy on rural development, monitoring the Bank's portfolio of agriculture and rural projects, and promoting knowledge sharing among agriculture and rural development practitioners inside and outside the Bank to continually improve the Bank's activities in rural areas. The department's focus includes gender and rural development, rural producer organizations, sustainable agri- culture, water resources management, and forests and forestry. The depart- ment's Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/rural. Additional information appears on the Sustainable Development Web site at http://www.worldbank. org/sustainabledevelopment. Agribusiness Department (IFC) The technical, financial, and market expertise necessary to evaluate agribusi- ness projects is centralized in IFC's Agribusiness Department. Its staff com- prises investment officers, engineers, and economists, all with specialized international experience. IFC supports projects involving primary agricul- tural production, aquaculture, and fishing, as well as marketing (for exam- ple, silos, cold and controlled-atmosphere storage facilities, and wholesale markets), food processing, and distribution. As a rule, preference is given to investment projects that have the largest demonstrated benefits for the effi- ciency and competitiveness of the supply chain and that have the highest overall contribution to economic development. For more on IFC and agribusiness, see http://www.ifc.org/agribusiness. Topics in Development 141 Other Resources Other resources include the following: The Consultative Group on International Agricultural Research, a Bank Group affiliate whose secretariat is at Bank headquarters, is a strategic alliance of members, partners, and international agricultural centers that mobilizes sci- ence to benefit the poor. Its Web site is at http://www.cgiar.org. World Bank research focused on agriculture and rural development can be found at http://go.worldbank.org/8PZ5ZCHZK0. Key Publications Following are some key publications that address agriculture and rural development: Agricultural Growth and the Poor Agricultural Investment Sourcebook Agricultural Trade Reform and the Doha Development Agenda Enhancing Agricultural Innovation: How to Go Beyond the Strengthening of Research Systems Reaching the Rural Poor Reengaging in Agricultural Water Management Shaping the Future of Water for Agriculture Sustainable Land Management: Challenges, Opportunities, and Trade-Offs Sustaining Forests World Development Report 2008: Agriculture for Development Aid Effectiveness The effectiveness of aid in reducing poverty, improving lives, and stimulat- ing economic growth has always been a central concern of the Bank Group. The international community's broad acceptance of the MDGs brought aid effectiveness into even sharper relief as the Bank Group (among others) began focusing on measuring progress toward achieving the MDGs. Independent Evaluation The World Bank's Independent Evaluation Group and equivalent units within IFC and MIGA assess the effectiveness of specific programs and proj- 142 A Guide to the World Bank ects for the people and countries participating in them. These units provide advice to the Boards of Directors based on evaluations at the project, country, and sector levels. Each year, evidence from those evaluations is marshaled to produce a summary report on the Bank's development effectiveness. As cov- ered in chapter 2, evaluation is an integral part of the life cycle of every project, as is monitoring for quality while a project is under way. The Web site for the Independent Evaluation Group is at http://www.worldbank.org/ieg. Quality Assurance Group As part of the Bank's goal of fighting poverty with passion and professionalism while decreasing defects in implementation, the Quality Assurance Group con- ducts real-time assessments of the Bank's performance in relation to its major product lines. The Quality Assurance Group systematically assesses quality in each of the Bank's three areas of operation: new lending, portfolio man- agement, and advisory services. These examinations cover economic, finan- cial, technical, environmental, social, and institutional aspects of operations and assess the degree to which operations align with Country Assistance Strategies and the extent of client participation. Other Resources The following Web sites are also useful: The Independent Evaluation Group Help Desk has a Web site at http://www. worldbank.org/ieg/contact.html. Its e-mail address is eline@worldbank.org. World Bank research focused on aid effectiveness can be found at http:// www.worldbank.org/research/aid. Key Publications Publications on aid effectiveness include the following: Aid That Works: Successful Development in Fragile States Annual Review of Development Effectiveness Assessing Aid: What Works, What Doesn't, and Why A Case for Aid: Building a Consensus for Development Assistance Global Monitoring Report 2006: Strengthening Mutual Accountability-- Aid, Trade, and Governance The Market for Aid Topics in Development 143 Combating Corruption The Bank Group has identified corruption as one of the single greatest obsta- cles to economic and social development. Through bribery, fraud, and the misappropriation of economic privileges, corruption diverts resources away from those who need them most. Since the mid-1990s, the Bank Group has supported more than 600 anticorruption programs and governance initiatives developed by its member countries. The goals include increasing political accountability, strengthening civil society participation, creating a competitive private sector, establishing institutional restraints on power, and improving public sector management. Initiatives include encouraging disclosure of assets by public officials, training judges, teaching investigative reporting to journalists, and support- ing strong corporate governance through IFC's outreach and advisory ser- vices. Nearly one-quarter of new projects now include public expenditure and financial reform components. The Bank Group is working to integrate governance and anticorruption measures into all of its planning and opera- tional work. In March 2007, the World Bank's Board of Executive Directors unani- mously approved a new Governance and Anticorruption Strategy for the World Bank Group. The strategy paper--originally presented to the Devel- opment Committee at the Bank's 2006 Annual Meetings in Singapore--was revised to take into account main messages resulting from multistakeholder consultations that the Bank held with over 3,200 representatives from govern- ment, civil society, donor agencies, business, parliaments, and other interested parties through 47 country consultations, 4 meetings with global audiences, and Web-based feedback. An implementation plan was scheduled to be final- ized by June 2007. The Bank Group is also committed to ensuring that the projects it finances are free from corruption. The Bank Group has stringent procurement and anticorruption guidelines and an anonymous hotline for cor- ruption complaints. It maintains a list of firms and individuals ineligible to be awarded Bank Group­financed contracts. The Web site for governance and anticorruption issues is at http://www.worldbank.org/governance. The World Bank Institute (WBI) supports countries in improving gover- nance and controlling corruption by linking empirical diagnostic surveys, their practical application, collective action, and prevention. WBI's thematic learn- ing programs include courses, seminars, and policy advice on topics that are important to the international development process. Aligned with the Mil- lennium Development Goals and the Bank Group's corporate operational goals, these programs are normally tailored to specific country needs, but may 144 A Guide to the World Bank also address global issues such as governance or knowledge for development. Programs also include parliamentary oversight, legal and judicial reform, and information and the media. For more information, visit http://www.worldbank. org/wbi/governance. Other Resources The Bank's Department of Institutional Integrity investigates allegations of fraud or corruption in World Bank Group­financed operations, as well as allegations of misconduct by Bank Group staff, by means of the fraud and corruption hotline. For more information, click on "Reporting Fraud and Corruption" at http://www.worldbank.org/investigations. Key Publications The following publications address corruption issues: Anticorruption in Transition: A Contribution to the Policy Debate Anticorruption in Transition 2: Corruption in Enterprise--State Interactions in Europe and Central Asia Anticorruption in Transition 3: Who Is Succeeding . . . and Why? Fighting Corruption in East Asia: Solutions from the Private Sector Governance Matters V: Governance Indicators for 1996­2005 Governance Reform: Bridging, Monitoring, and Action The Many Faces of Corruption: Tracking Vulnerabilities at the Sector Level Reference Guide to Anti-Money Laundering and Combating the Financing of Terrorism, second edition The Role of Parliaments in Curbing Corruption 1 World Manga: Investigating Corruption--Broken Trust (comic book) Conflict Prevention and Reconstruction The Bank Group works in countries afflicted by conflict, supporting inter- national efforts to assist war-torn populations in resuming peaceful devel- opment. It also seeks to understand the causes of conflict and to determine ways that conflict can be prevented. The Conflict Prevention and Recon- struction Unit of the World Bank takes the lead in this area: it conducts research and provides analysis on conflict and development to support country units working in conflict-affected countries. The Bank also sup- Topics in Development 145 ports the disarmament, demobilization, and reintegration of former com- batants, as well as mine survey and awareness initiatives. It has established the Post-Conflict Fund, which provides financing for physical and social reconstruction initiatives in postwar societies. The Web site is at http://www. worldbank.org/conflict. Other Resources World Bank research focused on the economics of civil war, crime, and violence, for which information can be found under "Conflict" at http://econ.worldbank. org/programs. Key Publications Publications dealing with conflict prevention and reconstruction include the following: Breaking the Conflict Trap: Civil War and Development Policy Gender, Conflict, and Development: Toward Gender Equality in Conflict- Affected Countries The Other Half of Gender: Men's Issues in Development Reshaping the Future: Education and Post-Conflict Reconstruction Risks and Reconstruction: Experiences of Resettlers and Refugees Understanding Civil War, volume 1: Africa Understanding Civil War, volume 2: Europe, Central Asia, and Other Regions The World Bank's Experience with Post-Conflict Reconstruction 1 World Manga: Child Soldiers--Of Boys and Men (comic book) Debt Relief Much of the debt burden in low-income countries dates back to the 1970s and 1980s. Many poor countries had borrowed to fund domestic projects on the back of the commodity price boom, believing that high prices and export earnings would be sustained. Oil price shocks during that time, which caused recessions throughout the world, combined with high inter- est rates and low commodity prices to hit borrowing countries especially hard. Although a number of countries recovered, many others did not. Despite several rounds of debt restructuring to alleviate the debt burdens these countries faced, the Bank Group soon realized that a multilateral debt 146 A Guide to the World Bank reduction effort would be needed to address the severe debt burdens of these countries effectively. The outcome was the Heavily Indebted Poor Country (HIPC) Initiative. The new Debt Department builds on the work of the HIPC Initiative. The department serves several purposes, including implementation of the proposed new debt sustainability framework for low-income countries and continued implementation of the HIPC Initiative. The department is also responsible for shaping the World Bank's position--when possible, in coor- dination with the debt policy community in general--on global debt issues facing developing countries. The e-mail address for comments on the HIPC Initiative is hipc@worldbank.org. In March 2006, the World Bank's Board of Executive Directors approved financing and implementation details for the Bank's contribution to the Multilateral Debt Relief Initiative, which provides for 100 percent relief of eligible debt from three multilateral institutions (the IMF, IDA, and the African Development Fund) to a group of low-income countries. This initiative is intended to help some of the world's poorest countries make progress toward achieving the MDGs by freeing up additional resources. For more information on the HIPC Initiative and the Multilateral Debt Relief Initiative, visit http://www.worldbank.org/debt. Other Resources Many Bank Group countries also participate in the Paris Club, an informal group of official creditors--industrial countries in most cases--that seek solutions for debtor nations facing payment difficulties. Paris Club creditors agree to reschedule debts due to them. Although the Paris Club has no legal basis, its members agree to a set of rules and principles designed to reach a coordinated agreement on debt rescheduling quickly and efficiently. This voluntary gathering dates back to 1956, when Argentina agreed to meet its public creditors in Paris. Since then, the Paris Club and related ad hoc groups have reached more than 300 agreements covering 76 debtor countries. Because the Paris Club normally requires countries to have an active IMF- supported program in order to qualify for a rescheduling agreement, it has extensive contact with the IMF and the Bank Group. The Web site is at http://www.clubdeparis.org. The Paris Club is paralleled by the London Club, an informal organiza- tion of commercial creditors. Officials of the Bank Group have been invited to meetings of the London Club in an effort to coordinate debt relief and repayment efforts with economic policy advice. Topics in Development 147 Key Publications Publications dealing with debt relief and the HIPC Initiative include the following: Debt Relief for the Poorest: An Evaluation Update of the HIPC Initiative Little Book on External Debt Economic Research and Data The Bank Group conducts extensive economic research and, with the help of country governments and other partners, assembles a wide range of eco- nomic data. Data and Statistics The Bank Group is a leading publisher of economic data and statistics on all aspects of development, both in print and online (see box 4.1 for Web links). Some information is free and some is available with a subscription. Major titles appear under "Key Publications" at the end of this section. The Development Data Group is the lead unit in this area; the Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/data. The Development Data Group can also be reached by phone at 1-202-473-7824 or 1-800-590-1906, by fax at 1-202- 522-1498, or by e-mail at data@worldbank.org. The Office of the Publisher handles commercial sales of print and electronic publications. This unit can be contacted through its Web site Box 4.1 Web Links for Data and Statistics World Bank Group data and statistics: http://www.worldbank.org/data Online databases: http://www.worldbank.org/data/onlinedatabases Financial sector databases: http://www.worldbank.org/finance Financial sector statistics: http://www.worldbank.org/finance Living standards measurement study: http://www.worldbank.org/lsms PovertyNet (data on poverty): http://www.worldbank.org/poverty/data Doing Business indicators: http://www.doingbusiness.org/ Statistical capacity building: http://www.worldbank.org/data World Bank--Global Environment Facility projects database: http://www. worldbank.org/gef World Bank research datasets: http://econ.worldbank.org/resource.php?type=18 148 A Guide to the World Bank at http://publications.worldbank.org/ecommerce, by phone at 1-703-661- 1580 or 1-800-645-7247, by fax at 1-703-661-1501, or by e-mail at books@ worldbank.org. Research The Bank Group's economic analysis identifies specific development indica- tors that provide a big picture of economic trends, the cumulative effectiveness of development programs, and other factors that affect economic progress. The Web site for World Bank research is at http://econ.worldbank.org; the e-mail for general queries is research@worldbank.org. The World Bank and IFC also conduct economic research through the joint Financial and Private Sector Development Vice Presidency. One major activity is the Doing Business Project, which studies the effects of regulation on the business climate. The Web site for this vice presidential unit is http://www.ifc.org/economics. Other Resources Various resources are available on the Internet: The Poverty Reduction and Economic Management (PREM) Advisory Ser- vice focuses on economic policy, gender, governance and public sector reform, and poverty, among other issues. It publishes PREM Notes, which summarizes good practice and key policy findings on those topics. Its Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/prem. The e-mail address is premadvisory@worldbank.org. The World Bank Research Observer and the World Bank Economic Review are journals published by the World Bank and Oxford University Press. Current issues are available by subscription. The archive database is search- able on the home page, but back issues must be ordered from Oxford Jour- nals. The Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/research/journals. Key Publications The following are some of the Bank's key research publications: Annual World Bank Conference on Development Economics Doing Business Frontiers of Development Economics Topics in Development 149 Global Development Finance (available in print and online) Global Economic Prospects Global Monitoring Report Little Data Book Little Green Data Book Policy Research Reports Policy Research Working Papers Atlas of Global Development: A Visual Guide to the World's Greatest Challenges World Development Indicators (available in print and online) World Development Report Education The Bank Group recognizes that universal, high-quality education reduces poverty and inequality and sustains economic growth. Such education is also fundamental for the construction of democratic societies and globally competitive economies. It improves people's skills, which, in turn, improve their incomes. Consequently, achieving universal primary education for all is one of the eight MDGs. The Web site for education issues is at http://www. worldbank.org/education. The Bank Group pursues its work in education and training through the following units and programs. Education Department (World Bank) The Education Department is part of the Human Development Network. Education activities, programs, and projects at the region or country level can be accessed through the Web sites of the Bank's regions. Major education initiatives include the following: Education for All is a commitment by the international community to achieving education for every citizen in every society. The Education for All partnership believes that education is key to sustainable development, to peace and stability within and among countries, and to people's full partic- ipation in the societies and economies of the 21st century. The partnership is committed to ensuring that, by 2015, all children are enrolled in and able to complete a primary education. Achieving this goal necessitates giving spe- cial attention to girls and disadvantaged children, who are at greatest risk of failing to complete their schooling. 150 A Guide to the World Bank Education for the Knowledge Economy is an analytical program for under- standing how education and training systems need to change to meet the challenges of the knowledge economy. The program offers practical and sustainable policy options for developing countries. Early Child Development is a knowledge source that assists policy makers, program managers, and practitioners in their efforts to promote the healthy growth and development of young children. Visit Early Child Development at http://www.worldbank.org/children. World Bank Institute Capacity for development is the ability of individuals, institutions, and entire societies to solve problems, make informed choices, order their priorities, and plan their futures, as well as implement programs and projects and sustain them over time. Building capacity is at the heart of development and devel- opment effectiveness and depends heavily on society's ability to acquire and use knowledge. WBI is the capacity development arm of the World Bank that helps countries share and apply global and local knowledge to meet development challenges. WBI's capacity development programs are designed not only to build skills among groups of individuals, but also to strengthen the organi- zations in which they work and the sociopolitical environment in which they operate. WBI conducts training sessions and policy consultations and creates and supports knowledge networks related to international economic and social development. The focus includes distance learning and other emerging tech- nologies for education and training. WBI serves member countries, Bank Group staff members and clients, and other people working in the areas of poverty reduction and sustainable development. WBI has programs focused on education, environment and natural resources management, the financial sector, health and HIV/AIDS, knowledge for development, poverty and growth, private sector development, public-private partnerships in infra- structure, public sector governance, social protection and risk management, trade, urban and local government, and water and rural development. Visit http://www.worldbank.org/wbi. IFC Investments in Private Education IFC supports the development of private educational activities in its client countries and believes that such support can help improve access to and the Topics in Development 151 quality of the education sector. To further this commitment, IFC's Health and Education Department invests in or advises on the start-up or expansion of initiatives in many subsectors of education. These subsectors include pri- mary, secondary, and postsecondary schooling, with a particular interest in school networks, e-learning initiatives, and student financing programs and other ancillary services. IFC has also been instrumental in establishing the Global Business School Network, which links institutions in developing and industrial countries, with an emphasis on Sub-Saharan Africa. Other Resources The following resources are also useful: Education Advisory Service. The Web site is at http://www.worldbank. org/education. The service may be contacted by e-mail at eservice@ worldbank.org. World Bank research. To visit the Web site, click "Topic" at http://econ. worldbank.org and select "Education." WBI has an education learning program. The Web site is at http://www. worldbank.org/wbi/education. Key Publications Publications addressing education issues include the following: Achieving Universal Primary Education by 2015: A Chance for Every Child A Chance to Learn: Knowledge and Finance for Education in Sub-Saharan Africa Closing the Gap in Education and Technology Higher Education in Latin America: The International Dimension How Universities Can Promote Economic Growth Meeting the Challenges of Secondary Education in Latin America and East Asia A New Social Contract for Peru: An Agenda for Improving Education, Health Care, and the Social Safety Net The following are some key WBI publications: Cities in a Globalizing World Development Outreach Magazine Diaspora Networks and the International Migration of Skills Japan: Moving Toward a More Advanced Knowledge Economy 152 A Guide to the World Bank Managing the Implementation of Development Projects: A Resource Kit on CD-ROM Promoting Social Cohesion through Education The Role of Parliaments in Curbing Corruption Empowerment and Participation Empowerment is the process of enhancing the capacity of individuals or groups to make choices and to transform those choices into desired actions and out- comes. Central to this process are actions that both build individual and col- lective assets and improve the efficiency and fairness of the organizational and institutional contexts that govern the use of these assets. The World Bank's Empowerment Sourcebook, published in 2002, set out to bring together the thinking and practice of empowerment as a first step toward developing a better understanding of this component of the Bank's work. Since then, staff members and teams around the World Bank have been engaged in a broad range of activities that seek to operationalize the con- cept of empowerment. Some practical illustrations from Bank operations and non-Bank activities include providing basic services, improving local governance, improving national governance, developing pro-poor markets, and providing access to justice and legal aid. In the past, the strategies of the World Bank and its clients for improved development and poverty reduction have focused on formal systems, with lit- tle connection to citizens and those working at the community level. An empowering approach creates a link between the supply and demand sides of development. A demand-side approach to improving governance focuses on educating, informing, and enabling citizens and poor people's organizations so that they can interact effectively with their governments. A supply-side approach focuses on macro-level institutions and the legal framework, which determine how poor people can access development opportunities. The empowerment process ensures that the two approaches act in synergy. IFC supports public participation and community empowerment through extensive civil society outreach efforts with local nongovernmental organiza- tions (NGOs), community leaders, media representatives, and all other stake- holders. IFC believes that early engagement with the community, along with Topics in Development 153 maximum public disclosure, is the best business model in the developing world and emerging markets. For more information, see http://www.worldbank.org/empowerment. Other Resources Further resources include the following: WBI has a socially sustainable development Web site at http://www. worldbank.org/wbi/empowerment. World Bank research focused on inequity around the world can be found at http://www.worldbank.org/research/inequality. Key Publications These publications also address empowerment and participation issues: Empowerment and Poverty Reduction: A Sourcebook Empowerment in Practice: From Analysis to Implementation Measuring Empowerment: Cross-Disciplinary Perspectives Voices of the Poor World Development Report 2000/2001: Attacking Poverty Energy and Mining The Bank Group views energy as a fundamental driver of economic devel- opment and believes that countries must develop their own energy programs in careful and sustainable ways. The Bank Group's objectives in the energy sector include helping the poor directly, improving macroeconomic and fis- cal balances, promoting good governance and private sector development, and protecting the environment. The Bank Group's energy program includes some joint units of the World Bank and IFC. The Web site for energy issues is at http://www.worldbank.org/energy. The Bank Group also works to help countries ensure environmentally and socially responsible development of their mineral resources. The Bank Group pursues its work in this area through the Oil, Gas, Mining, and Chemicals Department, a joint unit of the World Bank and IFC that aims to improve coordination between work on public sector policy and private sec- tor investment activities. The department is the lead unit in implementing the 154 A Guide to the World Bank Bank Group's response to the Extractive Industries Review, an independent stakeholder consultation process that concluded in 2004. The department focuses on such issues as gas flaring, carbon emissions trading, and revenue management and transparency, and it works with an advisory group to iden- tify best practices in the oil, gas, and mining industries. IFC is developing new business models for investments involving renew- able energy, energy efficiency, recovery and use of methane, and use of cleaner fuels. IFC helps companies in emerging markets increase their incomes while reducing environmental impacts by arranging for the pur- chase of carbon credits under the terms of the Kyoto Protocol. IFC also works with the Global Environment Facility and other donors to help com- mercialize climate-friendly investments. Other Resources These resources are also useful: The Energy Help Desk can be contacted at energyhelpdesk@worldbank.org. The Extractive Industries Review is an independent evaluation of Bank Group involvement in the sector. To access the report, visit http://www.ifc.org and search for "Extractive Industries Review." Information on IFC's power projects can be found at http://www.ifc.org/ ifcext/infrastructure.nsf/Content/Power. The Mining Help Desk can be contacted at omgc@worldbank.org. The Oil, Gas, Mining, and Chemicals Department Web site is at http://www. worldbank.org/mining. Key Publications These publications deal with energy and mining issues: Breathing Clean: Considering the Switch to Natural Gas Buses From Crisis to Stability in the Armenian Power Sector: Lessons Learned from Armenia's Energy Reform Experience The Little Green Data Book 2006 Mining Royalties: A Global Study of Their Impact on Investors, Government, and Civil Society People and Power: Electricity Sector Reforms and the Poor in Europe and Central Asia Topics in Development 155 Power for Development: A Review of the World Bank Group's Experience with Private Participation in the Electricity Sector Rural Energy and Development: Improving Energy Supplies for Two Billion People Environment Many view concern for the environment as a rich-country luxury. It is not. Natural and man-made environmental resources--fresh water, clean air, forests, grasslands, marine resources, and agro-ecosystems--provide sustenance and a foundation for social and economic development. The World Bank is one of the key promoters and financiers of environmental upgrading in the developing world, supporting environmental protection and improvement. It conducts research and advocacy on environmental issues and ensures envi- ronmental protection in its own work through careful adherence to safe- guards it has established. Environment Department (World Bank) Part of the Sustainable Development Network, the Environment Department is responsible for the World Bank's environment strategy for developing coun- tries. This strategy has the following priorities: improving aspects of the qual- ity of life (people's health, livelihoods, and vulnerability) that are affected by environmental conditions; improving the quality of growth by supporting pol- icy, regulatory, and institutional frameworks for sustainable environmental management and by promoting sustainable private development; and protect- ing the quality of the regional and global commons, such as the climate, forests, water resources, and biodiversity. The unit also maintains the Bank Group's Web site for environmental issues at http://www.worldbank.org/environment. Environment and Social Development Department (IFC) The Environment and Social Development Department works to meld the con- cerns of the environment with the needs of the private sector. The key Web site is at http://www.ifc.org/enviro. In early 2006, IFC announced its strengthened environmental and social standards, which set forth its requirements for its client companies. Also known as the performance standards, these are the basis of the Equator Principles--a benchmark for the financial industry to manage social and environmental issues in project financing--that some 40 of the world's lead- ing commercial banks have adopted for their project finance lending. 156 A Guide to the World Bank IFC's team of environmental specialists provides risk management and insurance services to reduce and manage environmental, social, and business risks, and it provides support for innovative products and business lines that contribute to the sustainability of private sector enterprises. Other Resources For information on the Bank Group's environmental safeguards, see chapter 2, as well as the following resources: IFC's environmental and social standards Web site provides information on the corporation's sustainability policy; environmental and social review procedure; performance standards; and environmental, health, and safety guidelines. It also lists those sectors in which IFC does not invest. Click "Environmental and Social Standards" at http://www.ifc.org/enviro. MIGA's environmental and disclosure policies are available at "NGOs and Civil Society" at http://www.miga.org. The Operational Manual includes safeguard policies. The Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/opmanual. The Global Environment Facility is a Bank Group affiliate whose secretariat is located at Bank headquarters. For more information, see "Program- matic Partnerships" under "Partnerships" in chapter 2 or http://www. worldbank.org/gef. The Prototype Carbon Fund seeks to mitigate climate change through reductions in greenhouse gases and encourages public-private partner- ships. An initiative of the Bank Group, donor governments, and private industry, the fund has a help desk at "About Us" on its Web site: http://www. prototypecarbonfund.org. World Bank research. For environmental resources, click "Topic" at http://econ.worldbank.org and select "Environment." For the Infrastruc- ture and the Environment Program, see http://econ.worldbank.org/ programs/2328. Key Publications Many publications address environmental issues, for example: At Loggerheads: Agricultural Expansion, Poverty Reduction, and the Envi- ronment in the Tropical Forests Environment Matters Topics in Development 157 Environmental Health: Bridging the Gaps Faith in Conservation: New Approaches to Religions and the Environment Green miniAtlas How Much Is an Ecosystem Worth? Assessing the Economic Value of Conservation Little Green Data Book Natural Disaster Hotspots: A Global Risk Analysis Natural Resources: Neither Curse nor Destiny Overcoming Drought: Adaptation Strategies for Andhra Pradesh Strategic Environmental Assessment for Policies: An Instrument for Good Where Is the Wealth of Nations? Measuring Capital for the 21st Century World Development Report 1992: Development and the Environment World Development Report 2002: Sustainable Development in a Dynamic World 1 World Manga Passage 3: Global Warming--The Lagoon of the Vanishing Fish (comic book) Financial Sector A healthy, trustworthy financial system is fundamental to economic develop- ment. The Bank Group helps countries strengthen their financial systems, grow their economies, restructure and modernize institutions, and respond to the savings and financing needs of all people. Major initiatives are as follows. Financial and Private Sector Development Vice Presidency (World Bank Group) The Financial and Private Sector Development Vice Presidency works to provide opportunities for the poor through market-friendly, enterprise-led growth and to provide better services through efficient delivery systems and well-targeted subsidies. This joint World Bank­IFC vice presidency focuses on the following three core areas: Creating the institutional foundations for effective markets, such as prop- erty rights, collateral systems, corporate governance, and financial market infrastructure Promoting open and competitive markets, for example, by opening up entry and providing access to finance for promising firms, by helping these firms to access deeper and more liquid financial markets, and exit for failing firms 158 A Guide to the World Bank Supporting social safety nets using market-based instruments, such as financial market-based instruments and risk management for pensions and insurance systems as well as low-income housing The Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/finance. IFC Investments and Advisory Services IFC considers support for financial markets a cornerstone of its investment policies and a critical tool for private sector development. IFC's Global Financial Markets Department is the lead unit for investments in and tech- nical support for banks and other financial institutions. More information is available at http://www.ifc.org/gfm. IFC also seeks innovative ways to finance microentrepreneurs, who play a key role in the private sectors of many economies in the developing world. See also the "Small and Medium Enterprise Department (World Bank Group)" in the section on "Private Sector Development" in this chapter. In addition to providing funding and asset management for the corpora- tion, IFC's Finance Vice Presidency offers products and services to clients, including many in the financial sector. These products and services include structured finance transactions, derivative-based products, loan participations with commercial banks, and local currency financing. In some instances, the vice presidency has funded IFC's own operations through local currency bond issues that have helped develop domestic capital markets in developing countries. See http://www.ifc.org/finance. Through its Private Equity and Investment Funds Department, IFC also invests in emerging market investment funds and fund management compa- nies. IFC has become a center of expertise for this sector and works through conferences and industry organizations to make emerging market private equity more visible to investors. See http://www.ifc.org/funds. Other Resources Additional resources include the following: The Consultative Group to Assist the Poor is a Bank Group affiliate that focuses on microfinance. Its secretariat is located at Bank headquarters. For more information, see "Programmatic Partnerships" under "Partnerships" in chapter 2 or http://www.cgap.org. The Financial Sector Advisory Service answers questions about the finan- cial sector. The e-mail address is askfinancialsector@worldbank.org. Topics in Development 159 The Interest Bearing Notes Newsletter is a periodical publication of the World Bank's Financial Sector. See http://www.worldbank.org/subscriptions. WBI has a financial sector learning program. The Web site is at http:// www.financelearning.org. World Bank research. For financial sector resources, click "Topic" at http:// econ.worldbank.org and select "Financial Sector." The Bank also has research programs focused on credit reporting systems, finance, and policies and insti- tutions that promote savings. Key Publications Publications about financial matters include the following: Access for All: Building Inclusive Financial Systems Access to Financial Services in Brazil Development of Non-Bank Financial Institutions and Capital Markets in European Union Accession Countries Electronic Finance: A New Approach to Financial Sector Development? Finance for Growth: Policy Choices in a Volatile World Financial Sector Assessment: A Handbook Financial Sector Development and the Millennium Development Goals International Financial Reporting Standards: A Practical Guide, fourth edition Microfinance Handbook: An Institutional and Financial Perspective The Microfinance Revolution A Reader in International Corporate Finance, volumes I and II Remittances: Development Impact and Future Prospects Transforming Microfinance Institutions: Providing Full Financial Services to the Poor Gender Through its programs and projects, the Bank Group seeks to reduce gender disparities and to enhance women's participation in economic development. It summarizes knowledge and experience, provides gender statistics, and pro- motes discussion on issues of gender and development. The Gender and Development Group within the Poverty Reduction and Economic Manage- ment Network is the lead unit in this area. The key gender-related goal is the MDG to eliminate gender-related disparities at all levels of education by 2015; see the Web site at http://www.worldbank.org/gender. IFC assists women entrepreneurs through the Gender Entrepreneurship Markets Pro- gram; visit http://www.ifc.org/GEM. 160 A Guide to the World Bank Other Resources Other resources include the PREM Advisory Service, which deals with many issues, including gender. The service publishes PREM Notes, which summa- rizes good practice and key policy findings. The Web site is at http://www. worldbank.org/prem. The e-mail address is premadvisory@worldbank.org. Key Publications Many publications address gender issues, including the following: Engendering Development Through Gender Equality in Rights, Resources, and Voice Gender, Conflict, and Development Gender and Development in the Middle East and North Africa: Women in the Public Sphere Gender and Economic Growth in Uganda: Unleashing the Power of Women Gender, Time Use, and Poverty in Sub-Saharan Africa The Other Half of Gender: Men's Issues in Development 1 World Manga: Girls' Education--Life Lessons (comic book) Globalization Globalization--the growing integration of economies and societies around the world--has been one of the most hotly debated topics in international economics over the past few years. Rapid growth and poverty reduction in China, India, and other countries that were poor 20 years ago has been a pos- itive aspect of globalization, but globalization has also generated significant international opposition over concerns that it has increased inequality and environmental degradation. The Bank Group's Web site on globalization issues is at http://www.worldbank.org/globalization. Key Publications Globalization is also the subject of these publications: Addressing the Challenges of Globalization: An Independent Evaluation of the World Bank's Approach to Global Programs Atlas of Global Development: A Visual Guide to the World's Greatest Challenges Cities in a Globalizing World: Governance, Performance, and Sustainability Topics in Development 161 Development Challenges in the 1990s: Leading Policymakers Speak from Experience Diaspora Networks and the International Migration of Skills: How Coun- tries Can Draw on Their Talent Abroad Global Issues for Global Citizens: An Introduction to Key Development Challenges Globalization and Development: A Latin American and Caribbean Perspective Globalization for Development, revised edition: Trade, Finance, Aid, Migra- tion, and Policy Globalization, Growth, and Poverty: Building an Inclusive World Economy miniAtlas of Global Development World Development Report 1999/2000: Entering the 21st Century Governance The Bank Group works to promote effective governance in the public sector and high standards of corporate governance in the private sector. Public Sector Governance A fundamental role of the Bank Group is to help the governments of client countries function better. Although this goal is simple to define, it is both com- plex and difficult to accomplish. The Bank Group has a number of initiatives dealing with governance issues, including Public Sector Group activities, pub- lic services research, and WBI governance and knowledge-sharing programs. The Public Sector Group is the lead unit in this area and is responsible for the World Bank's governance and public sector strategy. The unit focuses on building efficient and accountable public sector institutions rather than sim- ply providing policy advice, and it also maintains the Web site on governance and public sector reform at http://www.worldbank.org/publicsector. Several units of IFC work with governments to strengthen institutions, laws, and regulations related to the private sector. The Foreign Investment Advisory Service, a joint unit of IFC and the World Bank, focuses specifically on helping developing country governments attract and retain foreign direct investment; see http://www.fias.net. Corporate Governance The joint IFC­World Bank Corporate Governance Group helps compa- nies and countries improve standards of governance for corporations, 162 A Guide to the World Bank focusing on shareholders' and stakeholders' rights, board members' duties, disclosure, and effective enforcement. The Bank Group provides technical assistance on such governance issues to a wide range of government and financial institutions. IFC has developed a methodology for assessing cor- porate governance, which it uses in its own risk analysis and investment decisions as well as to help client companies improve their practices. For more information, click "Corporate Governance and Capital Markets" at http://www.ifc.org/economics. Other Resources Various resources are available on the Internet: The PREM Advisory Service deals with many issues, including gover- nance and public sector reform. The service publishes PREM Notes, which summarizes good practice and key policy findings. The Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/prem. The e-mail address is premadvisory@ worldbank.org. WBI has a public sector governance learning program. The Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/wbi/governancelp. Key Publications Publications in this area include the following: Public Sector Governance and Accountability series. This WBI book series provides conceptual guidance and practical lessons on how to establish a well-functioning public sector that focuses on poverty reduction; delivers quality public services; fosters private, market-led growth; and is account- able to its citizens for all actions. All the books in the series present ideas and practices that promote responsive, responsible, and accountable pub- lic governance in developing countries. Titles include Budgeting and Budgetary Institutions Intergovernmental Fiscal Transfers Local Budgeting Local Governance in Developing Countries Local Governance in Industrial Countries Local Public Financial Management Performance Accountability and Combating Corruption Topics in Development 163 Public Expenditure Analysis Public Services Delivery World Development Report 1997: The State in a Changing World World Development Report 2002: Building Institutions for Markets Health, Nutrition, and Population Ensuring adequate levels of basic health and nutrition lies at the heart of poverty reduction and economic development. In recent decades, improve- ments in income, education, hygiene, housing, water supply and sanitation, nutrition, and access to contraception have brought about notable health gains for much of the world, yet the health, nutrition, and population chal- lenges remain great for most developing countries. The World Bank and Health The World Bank commits an average of $1 billion in new lending each year for health, nutrition, and population projects in the developing world. It seeks to focus its assistance where the impact will be greatest--directly on people. The lead unit is Health, Nutrition, and Population, a sector unit of the Human Development Network. The unit organizes its work into the broad categories of health systems development; health, nutrition, and population MDGs; population and reproductive health; HIV/AIDS; nutrition; poverty and health; and public health. Public health is further broken down into categories that include avian flu, child heath, malaria, mental health, onchocerciasis, road safety, school health, tobacco, and tuberculosis. The unit's Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/hnp. IFC and Health IFC's Health and Education Department seeks to boost the private health care infrastructure in developing countries and emerging markets through investments in medical facilities, ancillary services, pharmaceutical devices, education and training, e-health (a relatively recent term for health care prac- tice supported by electronic processes and communication), and insurance. For more information, see http://www.ifc.org/ifcext/che.nsf. With respect to HIV/AIDS, IFC has prepared Good Practice Note: HIV/AIDS in the Workplace as part of the IFC Against AIDS Program. Its purpose is to help clients and others in the private sector understand and 164 A Guide to the World Bank manage the risks HIV/AIDS poses to their workforces and communities. The publication can be found at http://www.ifc.org/ifcext/aids.nsf/Content/ Publications. Other Resources Other health resources include the following: The Global Partnership for Eliminating River Blindness is discussed in the sub- section on "Regional Initiatives" under "Africa (Sub-Saharan)" in chapter 3 and at http://www.worldbank.org/gper. The Health and Population Advisory Service handles queries to the Health, Nutrition, and Population unit in all areas except nutrition, which has its own advisory service (see below). The service may be contacted by phone at 1-202-473-2256, by fax at 1-202-522-3234, or by e-mail at healthpop@worldbank.org. The health systems development Web site examines all aspects of health sys- tems, including market demand, financing, human resources, and service delivery. Go to "Topics" at http://www.worldbank.org/hnp. The HIV/AIDS Web site emphasizes that HIV/AIDS is not only a health problem, but is also a development problem that threatens human wel- fare, socioeconomic advances, productivity, social cohesion, and even national security. The World Bank is a key source of funding to combat HIV/AIDS. For information and resources, visit "Topics" at http://www. worldbank.org/hnp. The Joint UN Programme on HIV/AIDS has information on its Web site at http://www.unaids.org. The malaria Web site at http://www.worldbank.org/malaria addresses this devastating illness. Malaria is one of the world's most important public health concerns, causing more than a million deaths and up to 500 mil- lion clinical cases each year. Most of the 3,000 deaths each day--10 new cases every second--are in Africa, and more than a third of the world's population now lives in malaria-endemic areas. The Bank has intensified its support for malaria control through the new Global Strategy and Malaria Booster Program, begun in 2005. This program combines an emphasis on monitoring results and outcomes with flexibility in approaches and lend- ing instruments. The mental health Web site at http://www.worldbank.org/mentalhealth provides information about this issue. Topics in Development 165 The Multi-Country HIV-AIDS Program is described in the subsection on "Regional Initiatives" under "Africa (Sub-Saharan)" in chapter 3 and at http://www.worldbank.org/afr/aids/map.htm. The Nutrition Advisory Service provides information about nutrition. Nearly half of child mortality in low-income countries can be linked to malnutrition. The World Bank's approach to nutrition targets poor peo- ple, especially young children and their mothers, with an emphasis on community- and school-based nutrition programs, food fortification pro- grams, and food policy reforms. To date, the World Bank has committed nearly $2 billion to support nutrition programs. The Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/nutrition. Contact the Nutrition Advisory Service by phone at 1-202-473-2255, by fax at 1-202-522-3234, or by e-mail at nutrition@worldbank.org. The population and reproductive health Web site describes Bank activi- ties and resources in this area. Problems such as early and unwanted childbearing, sexually transmitted infections, and pregnancy-related ill- ness and death account for much of the burden of disease in develop- ing countries, especially among the poor, who often lack access to minimal health care. The Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/ population. The poverty and health Web site focuses on how developments in health affect efforts to reduce poverty in developing countries. Visit "Topics" at http://www.worldbank.org/hnp. The tobacco Web site provides information on tobacco policies and con- trol measures. The World Bank has a formal policy of not lending for tobacco production or processing, directly or indirectly, and of encourag- ing tobacco control in developing countries. Visit http://www.worldbank. org/tobacco. The tuberculosis Web site details the World Bank's efforts to fight tuberculosis. The World Bank combats tuberculosis by providing pol- icy dialogue and advice, by lending to countries to strengthen health systems and control the disease, by undertaking analysis, and by becom- ing involved in global partnerships. The Web site is at http://www. worldbank.org/tuberculosis. The vaccines and immunization Web site provides a summary of key facts, priority interventions, indicators, useful implementation lessons, and links to additional resources and information. The Bank Group supports immunization worldwide because it saves lives and is one of the most cost- effective, equitable health interventions available. Vaccine-preventable diseases disproportionately affect the poorest people in developing coun- 166 A Guide to the World Bank tries. Visit "Public Health at a Glance" at http://www.worldbank.org/hnp, then click on "Immunization." WBI has a program on health and AIDS. See http://www.worldbank. org/wbi/healthandaids. World Bank research. Click "Topic" at http://econ.worldbank.org, and select "Health, Nutrition, and Population." Key Publications Numerous publications address health and population issues, including the following: Battling HIV/AIDS: A Decision Maker's Guide to the Procurement of Medicines and Related Supplies Combating Malnutrition: Time to Act The Disease Control Priorities Project, available at http://www.dcp2.org Disease Control Priorities in Developing Countries, second edition Global Burden of Disease and Risk Factors Priorities in Health Health Economics in Development Health Financing Revisited: A Practitioner's Guide International Trade in Health Services and the GATS: Current Issues and Debates The Millennium Development Goals for Health: Rising to the Challenges Reproductive Health: The Missing Millennium Development Goal A Sourcebook of HIV/AIDS Prevention Programs World Development Report 1993: Investing in Health 1 World Manga: Passage 2: HIV/AIDS--First Love (comic book) Indigenous Peoples The Bank Group seeks to promote indigenous peoples' development while ensuring that the development process fosters respect for their dignity, human rights, and unique qualities. The lead unit in this area is the Bank's Indigenous Peoples Group, which is responsible for policies and guidelines to promote greater understanding within the Bank Group and its member countries of the value of cultural diversity in poverty reduction, sustainable development, and effective nation building. The Bank Group also works in this area through part- nerships with indigenous organizations, other donor agencies, and govern- ments. The Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/indigenous. Topics in Development 167 IFC and Indigenous Peoples IFC takes seriously the potentially disruptive nature of some private invest- ments that involve the resettling of indigenous peoples. At the same time, pri- vate sector projects may create opportunities for indigenous peoples to participate in and benefit from project-related activities that may help them fulfill their aspirations for economic and social development. IFC's perfor- mance standards recognize that indigenous peoples may play a role in sustain- able development by promoting and managing activities and enterprises as partners in development. To learn more about IFC's policy on indigenous peo- ples, see http://www.ifc.org/ifcext/enviro.nsf/Content/PerformanceStandards. Other Resources The Indigenous Knowledge Program documents local or traditional knowledge in developing countries and applies this knowledge to development issues. This program is a partnership of the World Bank's Africa Region with vari- ous UN agencies, bilateral development agencies, and NGOs. The Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/afr/ik. Key Publications The following publications deal with the involuntary resettlement of indige- nous peoples: The Economics of Involuntary Resettlement: Questions and Challenges Handbook for Preparing a Resettlement Action Plan Involuntary Resettlement Sourcebook: Planning and Implementation in Development Projects Information and Communication Technologies Information and communication technologies have the potential to speed devel- opment and improve a variety of social services. The Bank Group's Global Infor- mation and Communication Technologies Department--a joint department of the World Bank and IFC--focuses on the best ways to support technology implementation by helping to develop and promote access to information and communication technologies in developing countries. It provides governments, private companies, and community organizations with the capital and expertise needed to develop and exploit these technologies to reduce poverty and foster development. The Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/gict. 168 A Guide to the World Bank Other Resources Other resources include the following: The Development Gateway is an interactive portal for information and knowledge sharing on sustainable development and poverty reduction that offers, for example, a comprehensive database of development proj- ects, an international procurement marketplace, and knowledge sharing on key development topics. It is operated by the Development Gateway Foundation, a not-for-profit organization based in Washington, DC. The foundation is governed by a board of directors representing major donors and partners from international organizations, the public and private sectors, and civil society. The Development Gateway connects to Country Gateways, a network of 44 locally owned and managed public-pri- vate partnerships with the mission of facilitating country-level innovative and effective use of the Internet and other information and communication technologies. The Web site is at http://www.developmentgateway.org. The Global Development Learning Network is discussed in the subsection "Capacity Development" under "Knowledge Sharing" in chapter 2. The Web site is at http://www.gdln.org. Key Publications Publications addressing information and communication technologies include the following: China's Information Revolution: Managing the Economic and Social Transformation Connecting Sub-Saharan Africa: A World Bank Group Strategy for Infor- mation and Communication Technology Sector Development E-Development: From Excitement to Effectiveness Financing Information and Communication Infrastructure Needs in the Developing World: Public and Private Roles Global Integration and Technology Transfer Information and Communications for Development 2006: Global Trends and Policies Infrastructure Infrastructure development remains a fundamental focus of the Bank Group, and poor people are acutely aware that infrastructure could significantly Topics in Development 169 improve the quality of their lives. The Bank Group's infrastructure work is organized by departments that focus on energy; information and communi- cation technologies; mining; oil, gas, and chemicals; transport; urban devel- opment; and water supply and sanitation. Some of these departments are joint World Bank­IFC units. The Web site for infrastructure issues is at http://www.worldbank.org/infrastructure. IFC and Infrastructure Infrastructure is a significant part of IFC's work of assisting the development of private sector business opportunities in emerging economies. IFC's Infra- structure Department offers expertise in helping private sector sponsors finance infrastructure projects in client countries. It focuses on investments in power, transport, and utilities; its Web site is http://www.ifc.org/infrastructure. Other departments handle some related sectors, including telecommunications and oil and gas. In close partnership with the World Bank, IFC has also established the Subnational Finance Department to make direct investments in subsover- eign governments and entities they control that bear much of the responsi- bility for infrastructure; see http://www.ifc.org/municipalfund. In addition, IFC's Advisory Services Department assists client countries with privatiza- tions and public-private partnerships in infrastructure and other essential services; see http://www.ifc.org/advisory. Other Resources The following resources are also useful: The energy Web site can be found at http://www.worldbank.org/energy. The Global Information and Communication Technologies Department can be contacted by e-mail at gict@worldbank.org, and its Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/gict. The Oil, Gas, Mining and Chemicals Group can be contacted by e-mail at ogmc@worldbank.org. Visit its Web site by selecting "Oil, Gas, Mining & Chemicals" at http://www.worldbank.org/infrastructure. The Public-Private Infrastructure Advisory Facility is a multidonor technical assistance facility aimed at helping developing countries improve the qual- ity of their infrastructure through private sector involvement. Launched in July 1999, the facility was developed as a joint initiative of the govern- ments of Japan and the United Kingdom working closely with the World Bank. The Web site is at http://www.ppiaf.org. 170 A Guide to the World Bank The Transport Group can be contacted by e-mail at transport@worldbank. org. Visit its Web site by selecting "Transport" at http://www.worldbank. org/infrastructure. The Urban Development Group can be contacted by e-mail at urbanhelp@ worldbank.org. Visit its Web site by selecting "Urban Development" at http://www.worldbank.org/infrastructure. The Water Supply and Sanitation Group Web site can be found at http:// www.worldbank.org/watsan. WBI has a learning program on public-private partnerships in infra- structure. The Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/wbi/infrastruc- ture. WBI's urban and local government learning program Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/wbi/urban, and its water-related Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/wbi/water. Key Publications Much has been published about infrastructure, including the following: Building Safer Cities: The Future of Disaster Risk Handbook for Evaluating Infrastructure Regulatory Systems Infrastructure at the Crossroads: Lessons from Twenty Years of World Bank Experience Infrastructure for Poor People: Public Policy for Private Provision Labor Issues in Infrastructure Reform: A Toolkit Port Reform Toolkit, second edition: Effective Support for Policymakers and Practitioners Reforming Infrastructure: Privatization, Regulation, and Competition Street Addressing and the Management of Cities World Development Report 1994: Infrastructure for Development World Development Report 2004: Making Services Work for Poor People Labor and Social Protection The Bank Group studies and generally supports measures that seek to improve or protect human capital, such as labor market interventions, publicly man- dated unemployment or old-age insurance, and targeted income support. Such measures help individuals, households, and communities better manage the income risks that leave people vulnerable, and they contribute to a coun- try's solidarity, social cohesion, and social stability. Topics on which the Bank Group provides information and resources through its Human Development Network include child labor, disability, labor markets, pensions, safety nets and Topics in Development 171 transfers, social funds, and social risk management. The Web site for social pro- tection issues is at http://www.worldbank.org/sp. The World Bank also main- tains the Social Protection Advisory Service: fax queries to 1-202-614-0471 or e-mail socialprotection@worldbank.org. IFC and Social Protection IFC will not support projects that use forced or harmful child labor. Projects should comply with the national laws of host countries, including laws that pro- tect core labor standards, and with related treaties ratified by host countries. Forced labor consists of all work or service not voluntarily performed that is exacted from an individual under threat of force or penalty. Harmful child labor consists of the employment of children that is economically exploitative; likely to be hazardous to the child or to interfere with the child's education; or likely to be harmful to the child's health or physical, mental, spiritual, moral, or social development. IFC's performance standards address labor and work- ing conditions. Learn more from http://www.ifc.org/ifcext/enviro.nsf/ Content/PerformanceStandards. Other Resources Other resources include the following: The Social Protection Help Desk can provide useful information. Contact the help desk by e-mail at socialprotection@worldbank.org. WBI has a social protection and risk management learning program. The Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/wbi/socialprotection. World Bank research. Click "Topic" at http://econ.worldbank.org and select "Social Protections and Labor." Key Publications Some publications about social protection follow: Chains of Production, Ladders of Protection: Social Protection for Workers in the Informal Economy Household Risk Management and Social Protection in Chile Income Support for the Unemployed: Issues and Options Labor Issues in Infrastructure Reform: A Toolkit Labor Markets and Social Policy in Central and Eastern Europe: The Acces- sion and Beyond 172 A Guide to the World Bank Old-Age Income Support in the 21st Century: An International Perspective on Pension Systems and Reform Pensions in the Middle East and North Africa: Time for Change Pensions Panorama: Retirement-Income Systems in 53 Countries Reducing Vulnerability and Increasing Opportunity: Social Protection in the Middle East and North Africa Trade and Migration: Building Bridges for Global Labor Mobility World Development Report 1995: Workers in an Integrating World Law, Regulation, and the Judiciary The Bank Group is an active supporter of legal and judicial reforms that address the needs of the poor and the most vulnerable in developing coun- tries. The lead unit in this area, the Legal and Judicial Reform Practice Group of the World Bank, works with governments, judges, lawyers, scholars, civil society representatives, and other organizations to build better legal institu- tions and judicial systems. Other areas of activity for the Bank include envi- ronmental and international law and the role of legal systems in private sector development, finance, and infrastructure. The Bank's law and justice Web site at http://www4.worldbank.org/legal provides information on all these activities and links to several legal databases. The Bank Group is working with governments to make laws and regula- tions more conducive to private sector development. Efforts include the Doing Business Project, a joint World Bank­IFC effort that compares administrative barriers facing private sector enterprises in more than 150 countries. The pro- ject is now being extended to the subnational level in selected countries and regions. Many of IFC's regional advisory services facilities and the joint World Bank­IFC Foreign Investment Advisory Service work with governments to assess administrative barriers and help develop legislative or judicial solutions. IFC has helped establish alternative dispute resolution in several countries in an effort to ensure that conflicts among private enterprises are addressed more quickly and at lower cost than through court proceedings. Other Resources Other legal resources are as follows: The Bank documents Web resource has links to key Bank Group docu- ments, including articles of agreement, manuals and guidelines, and other materials. See http://www.worldbank.org/lawlibrary. Topics in Development 173 The Legal Help Desk has a Web site at "Legal Help Desk" at http://www.worldbank.org/legal. The e-mail address is legalhelpdesk@ worldbank.org. Key Publications These publications deal with law and justice: Competition Law and Regional Economic Integration: An Analysis of the Southern Mediterranean Countries A Framework for the Design and Implementation of Competition Law and Policy Intellectual Property and Development: Lessons from Recent Economic Research Judicial Systems in Transition Economies: Assessing the Past, Looking to the Future Land Law Reform: Achieving Development Policy Objectives Reforming Collateral Laws to Expand Access to Finance The Transit Regime for Landlocked States: International Law and Develop- ment Perspectives The World Bank Legal Review: Law and Justice for Development, volume 1 Manufacturing and Services Manufacturing accounts for some 40 percent of the gross domestic product of developing countries. By engaging in the manufacturing and services indus- tries, primarily through IFC investments and advisory services and MIGA guarantees, the Bank Group is helping countries improve their economic competitiveness and the environmental and social sustainability of their indus- trial operations. Global Manufacturing and Services Department (IFC) This department coordinates IFC's investments and advisory services in a wide range of enterprises, including heavy industries, such as building materials, metals, forest products, automotives, glass, and other industrial and con- sumer products; light industries, such as electronics, appliances, pharmaceu- ticals, and textiles; and services, such as retail and tourism. The goal is to help clients achieve international competitiveness through financing, industry- specific expertise, and assistance in meeting international standards, includ- 174 A Guide to the World Bank ing on corporate governance and environmental and social performance. In some instances, IFC also helps link small local suppliers of goods and ser- vices to larger clients in which it has invested. For more information, see http://www.ifc.org/ifcext/gms.nsf/Content/home. Key Publications Some publications that address manufacturing and services follow: Forest Management in Nepal: Economics and Ecology Nature Tourism, Conservation, and Development in KwaZulu Natal, South Africa Radical Reform in the Automotive Industry: Policies in Emerging Markets Structural Aspects of Manufacturing in Sub-Saharan Africa: Findings from a Seven Country Enterprise Technology Institutions and Policies: Their Role in Developing Technologi- cal Capability in Industry Toward the Rural-Based Development of Commerce and Industry: Selected Experiences from East Asia Trade and Transport Facilitation: An Audit Methodology The World Bank Forest Strategy: Striking the Right Balance Poverty Fighting poverty is central to the Bank Group's mission. The Bank Group considers a comprehensive understanding of poverty and its possible solu- tions to be fundamental for everyone involved in development. This under- standing involves defining poverty, studying trends over time, setting goals to reduce poverty, and measuring results. The Bank Group's Web site on this topic is PovertyNet at http://www.worldbank.org/poverty, which intro- duces key issues and provides in-depth information on poverty measure- ment, monitoring, and analysis and on poverty reduction strategies for researchers and practitioners. IFC and Poverty IFC assists in the fight against poverty by focusing many of its investments on sectors that have the most direct effect on living standards. Such sectors include the financial sector, infrastructure, information and communica- Topics in Development 175 tion technologies, small and medium enterprises, microfinance, health, and education. Other Resources Other resources include the following: The PREM Advisory Service, whose focus includes poverty, publishes PREM Notes, which summarizes good practice and key policy findings. The Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/prem. The e-mail address is premadvisory@worldbank.org. WBI has a program on poverty and growth. The Web site is at http://www. worldbank.org/wbi/povertyandgrowth. World Bank research. Click "Topic" at http://econ.worldbank.org and select "Poverty Reduction." Key Publications These publications address poverty: Attacking Africa's Poverty: Experience from the Ground Can the Poor Influence Policy? Participatory Poverty Assessments in the Devel- oping World Delivering on the Promise of Pro-Poor Growth: Insights and Lessons from Country Experiences The Impact of Microeconomic Policies on Poverty and Income Distribution Improving the Lives of the Poor through Investment in Cities Participatory Approaches to Attacking Extreme Poverty Poverty and Social Impact Analysis Power, Rights, and Poverty: Concepts and Connections Reaching the Rural Poor: A Renewed Strategy for Rural Development Reducing Poverty on a Global Scale: Learning and Innovating for Development A Sourcebook for Poverty Reduction Strategies, two volumes Targeting of Transfers in Developing Countries: Review of Lessons and Experience Voices of the Poor (series) World Development Report 2000/2001: Attacking Poverty 1 World Manga: Passage 1: Poverty--A Ray of Light (comic book) 2004 Annual Review of Development Effectiveness: The World Bank's Con- tributions to Poverty Reduction 176 A Guide to the World Bank Private Sector Development The Bank Group places major emphasis on the role of the private sector in spurring economic growth and reducing poverty, with two of its institutions, IFC and MIGA, focusing specifically on private enterprises. In addition to IFC investments and MIGA guarantees, the Bank Group institutions provide research and advisory services in many areas of private sector development. The focus of Bank Group efforts includes private sector advisory services on corporate governance, corporate social responsibility, investment climate diag- nostics and reform, private participation in infrastructure, privatization trans- actions, and micro and small business development. Financial and Private Sector Development Vice Presidency (World Bank Group) This joint World Bank­IFC vice presidency takes the lead on many aspects of private sector development. These include small and medium enterprises; corporate governance and capital markets; investment climate, including the Doing Business Project and the Foreign Investment Advisory Service; and the development effectiveness of IFC's investments and advisory services. See http://www.ifc.org/economics. The activities of the Corporate Governance Department are aimed at helping companies and countries improve standards of governance for cor- porations, focusing on shareholders' and stakeholders' rights, board mem- bers' duties, disclosure, and effective enforcement. The department promotes the spirit of enterprise and accountability, encouraging fairness, transparency, and responsibility. IFC Investments and Advisory Services IFC's Industries Vice Presidency includes departments responsible for its investment portfolio across a wide range of industry sectors, including agribusi- ness, global financial markets, global manufacturing and services, health and education, infrastructure, and private equity and investment funds. Depart- ments in this group also focus on grassroots business organizations, advisory services for privatization, and subnational finance. Departments dealing with global information and communication technologies and with oil, gas, min- ing, and chemicals report both to this group and to the World Bank's Infra- structure Vice Presidency. Increasingly, IFC is working to integrate its investments with related advisory services to improve the sustainability, com- petitiveness, governance, and development impact of private enterprises. Topics in Development 177 Private sector development is the focus of many Bank Group partnerships with other organizations. This includes IFC's donor-funded operations, which encompass trust funds and a network of facilities that serve develop- ing regions or promote specific aspects of development. For information, including links to facilities, see "Advisory Services" at http://www.ifc.org/ ifcext/about.nsf/Content/TAAS. Small and Medium Enterprise Department (World Bank Group) The Small and Medium Enterprise Department is a joint department of IFC and the World Bank that assists units across the World Bank Group in their efforts to develop small and medium enterprises (SMEs). This includes devel- oping monitoring and evaluation tools for advisory services, supporting data collection and analysis on IFC's SME activities, promoting business links between companies in which IFC invests and local SMEs, and identifying best practices. The department also manages IFC's donor-supported trust funds. The Doing Business Report and Database In 2003, the World Bank and IFC launched the Doing Business Project, which measures the ease of doing business around the world. Now in its fifth edition, the project's reports are widely read and foster dialogue on business environ- ment reforms at the local, regional, and global levels. Doing Business allows pol- icy makers to compare their countries' regulatory performance with that of other countries, learn from best practices globally, and prioritize reforms. A public database on the Doing Business Web site shares the data collected for the reports. These data provide objective measures of business regulations and their enforcement, with indicators comparable across 175 economies. They indicate the regulatory costs of business and can be used to analyze spe- cific regulations that enhance or constrain investment, productivity, and growth. See http://www.doingbusiness.org. Other Resources Other resources include the following: The Donor Committee for Enterprise Development works to share informa- tion and coordinate the efforts of agencies in this field. The secretariat is housed in the joint World Bank­IFC Small and Medium Enterprise Department. Visit http://www.sedonors.org. 178 A Guide to the World Bank The Foreign Investment Advisory Service advises governments of develop- ing and transition countries on how to improve their investment climate for domestic and foreign investors. Visit http://www.fias.net/. The Private Sector Development Blog gathers news, resources, and ideas about the role of private enterprise in fighting poverty. The blog is informal and represents the quirks and opinions of the bloggers, not the World Bank Group. Visit http://psdblog.worldbank.org. Public Policy for the Private Sector is an online World Bank Group journal that covers public policy innovations for private sector­led and market- based solutions for development. Articles can be viewed and downloaded at http://rru.worldbank.org/PublicPolicyJournal/. The Public-Private Infrastructure Advisory Facility is a multidonor tech- nical assistance facility aimed at helping developing countries improve the quality of their infrastructure through private sector involvement. The facility is a joint initiative of the governments of Japan and the United Kingdom working closely with the World Bank. The Web site is at http://www.ppiaf.org. The Rapid Response Web Site is an online knowledge resource specializ- ing in policy for the private sector in developing countries. Areas of exper- tise are economywide interventions that shape the investment climate, including foreign investment and corporate governance; private partici- pation in sectors with complex market design and regulatory issues (for example, energy, transport, telecommunications, health, and education); privatization transactions; and policy. The Web site provides links to expert analysis, powerful databases, quick solutions, and comprehensive how-to guides at http://rru.worldbank.org. WBI has a private sector development program that includes subprograms on business, competitiveness, and development and on the investment climate. The Web sites are at www.worldbank.org/wbi/bcd and www. worldbank.org/wbi/investmentclimate or www.investmentclimate.org. For microfinance and small and medium enterprises, see http://www. worldbank.org/wbi/banking/microfinance. World Bank research. Click on "Topic" at http://econ.worldbank.org and select "Private Sector Development." Key Publications Publications about private sector development include the following: Doing Business in 2004: Understanding Regulation Doing Business in 2005: Removing Obstacles to Growth Topics in Development 179 Doing Business in 2006: Creating Jobs Doing Business 2007: How to Reform The Private Sector in Development: Entrepreneurship, Regulation, and Competitive Disciplines World Development Report 2005: A Better Investment Climate for Everyone Social Development The World Bank has consolidated its approach to social development in a single Bank-wide strategy and implementation plan titled "Empowering People by Transforming Institutions: Social Development in World Bank Operations," which was produced following a three-year effort that involved extensive stocktaking, research, and consultation. The plan focuses on efforts to empower the poor through enhanced Bank support for social inclusion, cohesive societies, and accountable institutions. Social development is defined as the transformation of institutions, and as such, promotes enhanced growth, improved projects, and better quality of life. The plan sets a vision, objectives, and a course of action for the long term and suggests specific actions, targets, and institutional measures for the next five years. The Sustainable Development Network of the World Bank coordinates several thematic work programs. These include programs on community- driven development, conflict prevention and reconstruction, indigenous peoples, involuntary resettlement, participation and civic engagement, social analysis and policy, and social capital. The Web site is at http:// www.worldbank.org/socialdevelopment. Additional information appears on the Sustainable Development Network Web site at http://www.worldbank. org/sustainabledevelopment. See also "Environment and Social Develop- ment Department (IFC)" under the "Environment" section in this chapter. Its Web site is at http://www.ifc.org/enviro. Other Resources More information about social development can be obtained from World Bank research. Click "Topic" at http://econ.worldbank.org and select "Social Development." Key Publications These publications deal with social development: Evaluating Social Funds: A Cross-Country Analysis of Community Investments Measuring Social Capital: An Integrated Questionnaire 180 A Guide to the World Bank Natural Resources and Violent Conflict: Options and Actions Putting Social Development to Work for the Poor: An OED Review of World Bank Activities Reshaping the Future: Education and Post-Conflict Reconstruction Social Cohesion and Conflict Prevention in Asia: Managing Diversity through Development Sustainable Development The Sustainable Development Network was formed to advance sustainable development within the Bank Group by ensuring that actions taken today to promote development and reduce poverty do not result in environmen- tal degradation or social exclusion tomorrow. That means dealing with the comprehensive nature of development in the implementation of projects and programs by the Bank Group and its partners. Specifically, participa- tion, empowerment, strengthened institutions, environmental protection, conservation, and a focus on the rural poor are all foundations for sustained and inclusive economic growth. In 2006, the Bank merged the networks that deal with infrastructure and environment projects into a single unit to promote sustainable development. The purpose of consolidating the net- works was to mainstream environmental issues, improve synergies, better integrate core operations, and ensure that the focus on sustainability is strengthened as the Bank increases its investment in infrastructure. The Web site for sustainable development issues is at http://www.worldbank. org/sustainabledevelopment. IFC and Sustainability Sustainability is at the heart of IFC's business model. The projects that it chooses to finance and the products and services it offers must fulfill devel- opment goals that go beyond financing. Therefore, when investing, IFC considers multiple dimensions of sustainability: Economic and financial growth through projects and client services to achieve development effectiveness Environmental protection by means of pollution prevention and abatement, biodiversity conservation, and sustainable natural resource management Social development through improved living standards, fair land acquisi- tion, support of small businesses, health and safety of workers and com- munities, and respect for key human rights Topics in Development 181 Corporate governance through transparent and professional systems of direction and control that lead to sustainable businesses Private sector development. The Web site for IFC sustainability resources is at http://www.ifc.org/ sustainability. Other Resources WBI has a sustainable development learning program. The Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/wbi/sustainabledevelopment. Key Publications These publications address sustainable development: At Loggerheads: Agricultural Expansion, Poverty Reduction, and Environ- ment in the Tropical Forests Beyond the City: The Rural Contribution to Development Beyond Economic Growth, second edition: An Introduction to Sustainable Development Generating Public Sector Resources to Finance Sustainable Development: Revenue and Incentive Effects Green miniAtlas How Much Is an Ecosystem Worth? Assessing the Economic Value of Conservation The Little Green Data Book Strategic Environmental Assessment for Policies: An Instrument for Good Sustainable Amazon: Limitations and Opportunities for Rural Development Sustainable Land Management: Challenges, Opportunities, and Trade-Offs Water, Wealth, and Poverty World Development Report 2003: Sustainable Development in a Dynamic World Trade The Bank Group's work on trade has two central objectives. At the global level, the Bank Group aims to promote changes in the world trading system to make it more supportive of development, especially of the poorest coun- tries and of poor people across the developing world. That work entails continued collaboration with the World Trade Organization, other multi- 182 A Guide to the World Bank lateral agencies, and donor countries, including work to maximize the devel- opment impact of regional trading agreements. At the country level, the Bank Group aims to promote integration through trade as a core aspect of devel- opment strategies. That effort involves providing strategic assistance to client countries to support trade-related reforms, with special efforts to target the low-income countries that are most in need of Bank support. The Bank Group's Web site on trade issues, maintained by WBI, is at http:// www.worldbank.org/trade. IFC and Trade Through investments and advisory services, IFC supports banking institu- tions that provide trade enhancement facilities to local companies. In 2005, IFC launched the Global Trade Finance Program to help establish a world- wide network of bank partnerships to finance trade under risk coverage pro- vided by IFC. The program aims to increase the developing countries' share of global trade and promote flows of goods and services between developing countries. Its Web site is at http://www.ifc.org/gtfp. Other Resources The following can provide more information on trade: International Trade has a Web site at http://www.worldbank.org/research/ trade/index.htm. World Bank research. Click "Topic" at http://econ.worldbank.org, and select "International Economics and Trade." Key Publications Trade-related publications include the following: Agricultural Trade Reform and the Doha Development Agenda Challenges of CAFTA: Maximizing the Benefits for Central America China and the WTO: Accession, Policy Reform, and Poverty Reduction Strategies Customs Modernization Handbook Development, Trade, and the WTO: A Handbook East Asia Integrates: A Trade Policy Agenda for Shared Growth Economic Development and Multilateral Trade Cooperation Topics in Development 183 Global Economic Prospects 2005: Trade, Regionalism, and Development International Trade in Health Services and the GATS: Current Issues and Debates Poverty and the WTO: Impacts of the Doha Development Agenda Regional Integration and Development Transport Transport is the key infrastructure asset for the movement of goods, people, and resources; it encompasses roads, rail, seaports, airports, and all manner of vehicles and management systems. This sector focuses on access, the role of the public and private sectors, and institutional and financial development. Areas of activity include economics and policy, ports and logistics, railways, roads and highways, and rural and urban transport. Special concerns include globaliza- tion of trade, congestion and pollution, operating deficits in public transport systems, and expenditure to maintain and modernize transport infrastructure. The Web site for transport issues is at http://www.worldbank.org/transport. IFC and Transport Sound transport infrastructure and services are crucial to private sector devel- opment. The private sector is playing a larger role in financing projects, as well as in providing managerial and technical expertise. Through its Infra- structure Department, IFC invests in ports, airlines and airports, roads, rail- roads, shipping, and trucking. Visit http://www.ifc.org/infrastructure. IFC's Advisory Services Department advises governments on private sector partic- ipation in transportation infrastructure and services; its Web site is at http://www.ifc.org/advisory. Other Resources The Transport Help Desk can be found at "Contact Us" at http://www. worldbank.org/transport.htm. The e-mail address is transport@worldbank.org. Key Publications The following publications concern transport issues: Cities on the Move: A World Bank Urban Transport Strategy Review Customs Modernization Handbook 184 A Guide to the World Bank Customs Modernization Initiatives: Case Studies Design and Appraisal of Rural Transport Infrastructure: Ensuring Basic Access for Rural Communities Improving Rural Mobility: Options for Developing Motorized and Non- motorized Transport in Rural Areas Port Reform Toolkit: Effective Decision Support for Policymakers A Primer on Efficiency Measurement for Utilities and Transport Regulators Trade and Transport Facilitation: A Toolkit for Audit, Analysis, and Remedial Action Urban Development The Bank Group's work in the field of urban development focuses on improv- ing the lives of poor people and promoting equity. That effort includes the creation of city development strategies; that is, an agenda for development modeled roughly on country strategies and created by local people with broad participation. Other areas of activity include disaster management, land and real estate, local economic development, municipal finance, urban commu- nity upgrades, urban poverty, and waste management. The main Web site for urban issues is at http://www.worldbank.org/urban. A combined initiative of the World Bank and IFC, the Municipal Fund provides needed capital investment to municipalities and other local public entities in the developing world without central government guarantees. The Municipal Fund's offerings provide states, municipalities, and municipally controlled institutions with new financial products and access to capital mar- kets. The objective is to strengthen their ability to deliver key infrastructure services such as water, wastewater management, transportation, electricity, and power and to improve efficiency and accountability. More information is available at http://www.ifc.org/municipalfund. Other Resources Other urban development resources include the following: Cities Alliance is a global alliance of cities and their development partners committed to improving the living conditions of the urban poor. The sec- retariat is housed at the World Bank. Visit http://www.citiesalliance.org. The Urban Help Desk offers e-mail advice at urbanhelp@worldbank.org. WBI has a program on urban and local government. Its Web site is at http://www.worldbank.org/wbi/urban. Topics in Development 185 World Bank research. Click "Topic" at http://econ.worldbank.org and select "Urban Development." Key Publications The following publications deal with urban development: Building Safer Cities: The Future of Disaster Risk Cities in a Globalizing World: Governance, Performance, and Sustainability Coping with the Cold: Heating Strategies for Eastern Europe and Central Asia's Urban Poor Historic Cities and Sacred Sites: Cultural Roots for Urban Futures Improving the Lives of the Poor through Investment in Cities: An Update on the Performance of the World Bank's Urban Portfolio Street Addressing and the Management of Cities Urban Environment and Infrastructure: Toward Livable Cities Urban Planning in Africa: Addressing, Mapping, and Their Applications The Urban Poor in Latin America Water Water is the focus of Bank Group efforts in two broad areas: (1) water resources management, and (2) water supply and sanitation. Specific issues include coastal and marine management, dams and reservoirs, groundwater, irrigation and drainage, river basin and watershed management, water man- agement across national boundaries, water and the environment, and water economics. Water is also the focus of one of the MDGs: the objective for 2015 is to reduce by half the proportion of people without sustainable access to safe drinking water. Web sites include water resources management at http://www.worldbank.org/water and water and water supply and sanitation at http://www.worldbank.org/watsan. IFC and Water Resources IFC is represented on the World Bank Group's Water and Urban Sector Board and contributes to the development of ideas and policies in this sec- tor. IFC draws on its experience to provide inputs from an investor perspec- tive. It often works in collaboration with the World Bank; however, IFC's main role is to support investors who undertake private sector water pro- jects. IFC has invested in water projects in a wide range of countries; see 186 A Guide to the World Bank http://www.ifc.org/infrastructure. IFC has also advised on the privatization of several water companies; learn more at http://www.ifc.org/advisory. Other Resources The Water Help Desk offers e-mail advice at whelpdesk@worldbank.org. Key Publications Publications on the water sector include the following: The Human Right to Water: Legal and Policy Dimensions The Institutional Economics of Water: A Cross-Country Analysis of Institu- tions and Performance Making the Most of Scarcity: Accountability for Better Water Management in the Middle East and North Africa Shaping the Future of Water for Agriculture: A Sourcebook for Investment in Agricultural Water Management Water, Electricity, and the Poor Students take year-end exams in the Republic of Yemen. Since 1990, the World Bank's emphasis on girls' education has increased and gender equality has been integrated as an important component of the Bank's poverty reduction mission. Appendixes A Contacting the World Bank Group B Timeline of World Bank Group History C Presidents of the World Bank Group D Country Membership in World Bank Group Institutions E Constituencies of the Executive Directors F Additional Country Resources 189 The location of World Bank Group headquarters. The buildings of World Bank Group headquarters. A P P E N D I X A Contacting the World Bank Group Headquarters and General Inquiries The offices and Web sites listed here are good sources of general information about the five World Bank Group institutions: the International Bank for Reconstruction and Development (IBRD), the International Development Association (IDA), the International Finance Corporation (IFC), the Multilateral Investment Guarantee Agency (MIGA), and the International Centre for Settlement of Investment Disputes (ICSID). General Contact Information General Inquiries, IFC Corporate Relations: Tel: 1-202-473-3800 World Bank Group Fax: 1-202-974-4384 1818 H Street NW Contact page: http://www.ifc.org/contacts Washington DC 20433 USA Tel: 1-202-473-1000 Fax: 1-202-477-6391 MIGA Contact Information Web: http://www.worldbankgroup.org or Mail: Same as for the World Bank Group http://www.worldbank.org Location: Multilateral Investment Guarantee Agency Staff Directory Orders 1800 G Street NW, Suite 1200 Washington DC 20433 USA World Bank Publications Tel: 1-202-473-1000 Tel: 1-800-645-7247 or 1-703-661-1580 Web: http://www.miga.org Fax: 1-703-661-1501 Web: http://www.worldbank.org/publications Business Inquiries: Tel: 1-202-473-1000 IBRD and IDA Contact Information Fax: 1-202-522-0316 E-mail: migainquiry@worldbank.org Same as for the World Bank Group Contact page: see "Contacts" at Contact page: http://www.worldbank.org/ http://www.miga.org contacts ICSID Contact Information IFC Contact Information Same address as for the World Bank Group International Finance Corporation Tel: 1-202-458-1534 2121 Pennsylvania Avenue NW Fax: 1-202-522-2615 Washington DC 20433 USA Web: http://www.worldbank.org/icsid Tel: 1-202-473-1000 Contact page: http://www.worldbank.org/icsid/ Web: http://www.ifc.org contact.htm 191 192 A Guide to the World Bank Media Relations, News, and Public Affairs The External Affairs Department of the World Bank and the Corporate Relations units of IFC and MIGA are the key resources for media relations, news, press con- tacts, public affairs, and access to World Bank Group experts and the Speakers' Bureau. Generally, the Bank Group organizations also feature news stories and major events on their home pages. IBRD and IDA The following are links to various World Bank media resources: The DevNews Media Center provides press releases, feature stories, reviews of press coverage, speeches and transcripts, issue briefs, and an events calendar. It also provides access to the Speakers' Bureau, to World Bank experts, and to media contacts. Web: http://www.worldbank.org/mediacontacts. Electronic newsletters offer a wide range of material by free e-mail subscription, including the daily press review; the World Bank weekly update; and many newsletters from specific sectors, regions, and partnerships of the Bank. Web: http://www.worldbank.org/subscriptions. The Online Media Briefing Center is a password-protected site available only to accredited journalists. Web: http://media.worldbank.org. IFC The IFC Pressroom provides press releases and links to media contacts, country fact sheets, general information about IFC, publications, speeches, briefs, and project documents. See "News" at http://www.ifc.org. MIGA MIGA News and Events provides newsletters, press releases, feature stories, an events calendar, and correspondence with nongovernmental organizations. See "Media" at http://www.miga.org. ICSID News from ICSID is a biennial newsletter, with the current issue and archives avail- able online. See http://www.worldbank.org/icsid/news/news.htm. Contacting the World Bank Group 193 Public Information Various offices within the World Bank provide public information. Public Information Centers InfoShop/Public Information Center 1818 H Street NW, Room J1-060 Washington DC 20433 USA Tel: 1-202-458-5454 Fax: 1-202-522-1500 E-mail: pic@worldbank.org (For public information centers in other countries, go to http://www.worldbank. org/reference/ and select "Public Information Centers" in the "Finding Publications" box.) World Bank Publications To order publications: Tel: 1-800-645-7247 or 1-703-661-1580 Fax: 1-703-661-1501 Web: http://www.worldbank.org/publications World Bank Group Feedback Service This service helps Web users locate online information resources, project information, and publications. Although the site does not provide in-depth research, it can guide users to those Web sites most likely to have the replies to their questions. The feed- back service also welcomes suggestions on how to make the Web site more useful. To provide feedback: Web: http://www.worldbank.org/feedback E-mail: feedback@worldbank.org Projects, Policies, Strategies, and Research These database portals provide access to information on World Bank Group pro- jects, policies, and strategies. They are searchable by sector, region, country, or development theme. Documents and reports: http://www-wds.worldbank.org Projects, policies, and strategies: http://www.worldbank.org/projects 194 A Guide to the World Bank IFC projects: http://www.ifc.org/projects World Bank Operational Manual: http://www.worldbank.org/OpManual World Bank research: http://econ.worldbank.org World Bank Group articles of agreement and other basic documents: http://www. worldbank.org/articles Annual Reports Annual reports of World Bank Group organizations and programs are available online as PDF files or in HTML format. The reports are published in multiple languages and the Web sites include past editions. World Bank annual report: http://www.worldbank.org/annualreport IFC annual report: http://www.ifc.org/ar2006 MIGA annual report: click on "Media" and see "News and Publications" at http://www.miga.org ICSID annual report: see "ICSID Documents and Publications" at http://www. worldbank.org/icsid Libraries The Library Network consists of 12 libraries and resource centers that serve the World Bank Group and the International Monetary Fund. The libraries offer the following services, which span the full spectrum of Bank Group and International Monetary Fund business: research, consultation, procurement of information products, content organization, and document delivery. All the libraries are located in Washington, DC, with the exception of the World Bank country office libraries and the public infor- mation centers. Some libraries admit visitors by appointment only. Distinct from the Library Network, the PovertyNet Library is an online library of reports and documents devoted to poverty in the developing world. The library contains a variety of poverty-related documents, including technical reports and papers, abstracts, speeches, interviews, and press releases. Following are links to various Bank Group library resources: World Bank Group and International Monetary Fund Joint Bank­Fund Library: http://external.worldbankimflib.org. For outside visitor access, see "Visitor Access" on this page. Sectoral and Information Technology Resource Library: see "List of Libraries" at http://external.worldbankimflib.org IFC Library: see "List of Libraries" at http://external.worldbankimflib.org PovertyNet Library: see "Poverty Net Library" at http://www.worldbank. org/povertynet A P P E N D I X B Timeline of World Bank Group History 1944 The United Nations (UN) Monetary and Financial Conference draws up the World Bank (International Bank for Reconstruction and Development [IBRD]) Articles of Agreement at Bretton Woods, New Hampshire, with 44 countries represented. 1945 Twenty-eight governments sign the Articles of Agreement in Washington, DC. 1946 The World Bank formally begins operations on June 25. The first loan applications are received (from Chile, Czechoslovakia, Denmark, France, Luxembourg, and Poland). 1947 The Bank makes its first bond offering--$250 million--in New York City. The Bank makes its first loan--$250 million--to France. 1948 The Bank makes its first development loan--$13.5 million--to Chile. 1950 The Bank makes its first loan to a national development bank--$2 million--to Ethiopia. 1951 Finland and Yugoslavia are the first countries to repay their Bank loans in full. 1952 Japan and the Federal Republic of Germany become members. 1953 The first three loans to Japan, totaling $40.2 million, are approved. 1955 The Economic Development Institute (now the World Bank Institute) is established to serve as the Bank's staff college. 1956 The International Finance Corporation (IFC) is established as a private sector affiliate of the Bank, with 31 members and authorized capital of $100 million. 1957 IFC makes its first investment--$2 million--in Siemens in Brazil to expand manufacturing. 1958 In the wake of deterioration in India's balance of payments, the first meeting of the India Aid Consortium takes place in Washington, DC. 1960 India, Pakistan, and the World Bank sign the Indus Water Treaty. The International Development Association (IDA) is established as part of the World Bank with initial subscriptions of $912.7 million. 195 196 A Guide to the World Bank 1961 The Bank loans $80 million to Japan to finance the bullet train. IDA extends its first development credit--$9 million--to Honduras for highway development. 1962 IFC establishes an advisory panel of investment bankers. The Bank makes its first education loan, a $5 million IDA credit to Tunisia for school construction. IFC makes its first equity investment in Fabrica Española Magentos S.A. of Spain. 1963 The Bank launches the Junior Professional Recruitment and Training Program (now the Young Professionals Program). Eighteen newly independent African countries join the Bank. 1966 The International Centre for Settlement of Investment Disputes (ICSID) is established. 1967 Developing countries form the Group of 77 as a convention and a negotiation arm. France, the Federal Republic of Germany, Japan, the United Kingdom, and the United States form the Group of Five to convene meetings of finance ministers and governors of central banks. (The group became the Group of Seven in 1976 with the addition of Canada and Italy. This group, with the addition of the Russian Federation, is now known as the Group of Eight.) 1970 The Bank makes its first loan for population planning--$2 million--to Jamaica. The Bank's new commitments exceed $2 billion for the first time. 1971 Japan becomes one of the Bank's five largest shareholders. The Bank makes its first loan for pollution control--$15 million--to Brazil. 1972 The Bank redeploys project and program staff members into regional departments to enable the institution to function more effectively. The World Bank Group Staff Association comes into existence. 1974 The Interim Committee of the International Monetary Fund (IMF) and the Development Committee are established to advise the Boards of Governors. The position of director general of operations evaluation is established to ensure independent evaluation of projects and programs. President Robert S. McNamara delivers a speech at the Annual Meetings at which, for the first time, poverty is placed at the top of the Bank's agenda. 1975 IBRD and IDA commit nearly $1 billion in one fiscal year for rural development projects. Shirley Boskey is appointed as the Bank's first female manager at the director level (International Relations Department). (The diversity strategy is extended in 1998 to include gender, nationality, race, sexual orientation, culture, and disability.) Timeline of World Bank Group History 197 The Project Preparation Facility, which provides borrowing governments an advance for financial and technical help with project preparation, is created. IFC's first major commercial loans are syndicated for projects in Brazil and the Republic of Korea. 1978 The executive directors endorse a Bank policy to assess the environmental impact of Bank- assisted projects. The first World Development Report team, led by Ernest Stern, publishes a report on the theme of accelerating growth and alleviating poverty. 1979 The Bank's new commitments exceed $10 billion for the first time. The Bank begins lending for health projects. The Bank Group suspends operations in Afghanistan after the invasion by the former Soviet Union. (Normal operations resume in 2002.) 1980 IBRD's authorized capital stock increases by $44 billion to $85 billion. The first structural adjustment loan is approved--$200 million--for Turkey. The People's Republic of China assumes representation for China and quickly becomes one of the largest borrowers. 1981 The position of World Bank ombudsman is established. IFC coins the term "emerging markets." The Emerging Markets Database is developed. 1982 Anne Krueger is appointed as the first female vice president (Economics and Research). A Bank loan for the Polonoroeste Program in Brazil finances a 90-mile highway across the Amazon rain forest, unintentionally attracting a large influx of settlers and spurring deforestation and international outcry. 1983 The Bank establishes a small grants program to fund activities to promote cooperation among nongovernmental organizations (NGOs), governments, academics, and the media. 1984 IFC establishes a $20 billion special fund to stimulate private sector development. IFC undertakes its first direct borrowings in international capital markets. 1986 The Foreign Investment Advisory Service (FIAS)--a multidonor service of the International Finance Corporation that advises governments of developing and transition countries on how to improve their investment climate for domestic and foreign investors--is formed. 1987 In a major reorganization, all staff members are reselected into positions. New country departments combine functions formerly divided between programs and projects staff. Regional and central environment departments are created. The Emerging Markets Database is launched commercially. 198 A Guide to the World Bank 1988 The Multilateral Investment Guarantee Agency is established. 1989 The Bank's Board of Executive Directors endorses a directive on disclosure of information. 1990 The Global Environment Facility is launched. 1991 China replaces India as the largest IDA borrower. 1992 An independent review of the Sardar Sarovar Project in India (Narmada Dam) is conducted. (Bank participation in the project is canceled in 1995.) A task force proposes steps to improve the Bank's portfolio management. Excellence through Equality recommends an increase in the proportion of women at higher grade levels. Russia and 12 other republics of the former Soviet Union become members of IBRD and IDA. 1993 The Institutional Development Fund is established to support innovative capacity- building initiatives. The independent Inspection Panel is established to investigate external complaints from individual groups negatively affected by Bank-funded projects. IFC initiates the first environmental training for financial intermediaries. 1994 The first Public Information Center is opened. The Bank unveils a three-year, $1.2 billion program to assist Palestinians in the West Bank and Gaza in transition to autonomous rule. "Dollar budgeting" is introduced. The World Bank celebrates its 50th anniversary while being widely criticized by NGOs and member governments. 1995 The Bank Group emphasizes the importance of girls' education. 1996 A trust fund for Bosnia and Herzegovina is created. The Quality Assurance Group is established to provide real-time information on the quality of the Bank's work. Knowledge management is launched to connect those who need to know with those who do know, to collect know-how, and to make knowledge accessible. The IMF, the World Bank, and donors launch the Heavily Indebted Poor Countries Initiative to alleviate debt. (The framework is significantly enhanced in 1999.) 1997 The Governance Action Plan is introduced. After just two years, more than 600 specific governance and clean government initiatives are started in almost 100 borrower countries. Adaptable lending instruments are introduced. Bank operations are reorganized into a matrix structure (country departments and networks of related sector families) and begin to decentralize. Timeline of World Bank Group History 199 The Bank approves a loan of $3 billion to the Republic of Korea and approves other loans to economies affected by the Korean financial crisis to restore investor confidence and minimize the social costs of the crisis. The Board of Executive Directors approves the Strategic Compact, a fundamental organizational renewal program. The Extending IFC's Reach Initiative is launched, thereby targeting countries where difficult environments hamper investments. 1998 The Knowledge Bank Initiative is launched. The Bank approves the Kosovo Special Fund. The Bank holds the first Development Marketplace to reward innovation in development. IFC strengthens its environmental and social policies. 1999 The Bank's vision for the new millennium is articulated: "Our dream is a world free of poverty." The Bank Group adopts the Comprehensive Development Framework, and at their Annual Meetings, the Bank Group and the IMF agree to implement country-owned poverty reduction strategies. IFC and MIGA appoint a compliance adviser/ombudsman to improve accountability to locally affected communities. 2000 The Bank and IMF Spring Meetings in Washington, DC, and the Annual Meetings in Prague draw large protests. The Bank commits an additional $500 million to fight HIV/AIDS. The Inspection Panel reviews the China Western Poverty Project. Chinese authorities decide to use their own resources to implement the controversial component. The Bank and its partners create the Global Development Gateway, a portal on development where users can find and contribute information, resources, and tools. The Heavily Indebted Poor Countries Initiative delivers on its promise made in 2000: 22 countries receive more than $34 billion in debt service relief. Completed Bank projects with satisfactory outcome ratings reach 75 percent for the first time in nearly 20 years (up from 60 percent in 1996). IFC reaches a record for new investment approvals in Sub-Saharan Africa--$1.2 billion. The United Nations Millennium Summit establishes the Millennium Development Goals for achievement by 2015. 2001 The IMF and the Bank Group cancel their Annual Meetings following the attacks of September 11. The Bank and its partners establish the Global Development Learning Network, a distance-learning initiative in developing countries. Partners in the Global Partnership to Eliminate River Blindness pledge $39 million to eliminate the disease in Africa by 2010. 200 A Guide to the World Bank The Bank Group participates in calls for decreasing agricultural subsidies in developed countries. The Bank revises its disclosure policy to promote better transparency and accountability in its development work. 2002 The Bank Group participates in the first UN International Conference on Financing for Development, held in Monterrey, Mexico. With its partners, the World Bank establishes the Education for All Fast-Track Initiative to help ensure that developing countries provide every child with a complete primary school education by 2015. 2003 The Bank lends $505 million to support Brazil's accelerated program of human development reforms. The Bank Group participates in the World Water Forum in Kyoto, Japan, asserting that water is a key driver of growth and poverty reduction. IFC and its partners launch a program to help local businesses in Azerbaijan benefit from investments in the oil industry. Ten leading commercial banks adopt the Equator Principles, choosing to follow World Bank and IFC environmental and social guidelines for all their investment work in developing countries. The Bank Group participates in UN efforts to rebuild Iraq. A major conference with youth organizations is held in Paris to discuss the role of young people in peace and development. The Council of the Global Environment Facility approves $224 million in grants for 19 new projects in developing countries and countries with economies in transition. The first annual Doing Business report is published. 2004 The Bank establishes the Low-Income Countries Under Stress Trust Fund. The Bank's Board of Executive Directors authorizes the Bank to act as an administrator for the Iraq Trust Fund to finance a program of emergency projects and technical assistance. The Bank and the IMF adopt a more comprehensive and integrated approach to fighting money laundering and terrorist financing in member countries. The Bank and the IMF launch the Quarterly External Debt Database, an online database that offers access to external debt statistics for 41 countries. The first issue of the Global Monitoring Report is published, warning that, based on current trends, most developing countries would fail to meet most of the Millennium Development Goals. The World Bank issues a wide-ranging reform proposal for the World Bank Group's activities in the extractive industries--oil, gas, and mining. 2005 The Bank publishes Focus on Sustainability 2004, its first report on sustainability. Donor countries agree to the IDA-14 replenishment of $34 billion, which represents a 25 percent increase over the previous replenishment and the largest expansion of IDA resources in two decades. Timeline of World Bank Group History 201 The Bank publishes its first annual report investigating fraud and corruption both internally and in Bank-financed projects. The Bank approves a $20 million grant to step up the fight against HIV/AIDS in the six countries of the Great Lakes region--Burundi, the Democratic Republic of Congo, Kenya, Rwanda, Tanzania, and Uganda. The Bank launches a new global approach to help developing countries make faster progress in their fight against malaria. The Bank issues a revised policy on indigenous peoples that reflects a strategic shift toward a broader and direct engagement with indigenous peoples' communities. The World Bank makes its first loan to Iraq in three decades. 2006 An avian flu pledging conference--cosponsored by the European Commission, the government of China, and the Bank--is held in Beijing, with pledges amounting to almost $1.9 billion. Wolfowitz outlines a comprehensive strategy for tackling corruption, a serious impediment to development and effective governance. The Bank announces the creation of the independent, high-level Commission on Growth and Development comprising leading practitioners from government, business, and the policy-making arena. To mobilize more resources for the very poorest countries, IBRD and IFC make a record transfer of $950 million to IDA, substantially more than the $500 million to be transferred under the IDA-14 replenishment agreement. The Board of Executive Directors approves the Multilateral Debt Relief Initiative, an extension of debt relief available under the enhanced Highly Indebted Poor Countries Initiative. The Bank announces the Bank Gender Action Plan, a four-year, $24.5 million plan to enhance women's economic power in key economic sectors in the developing world. 2007 IFC donates $150 million to IDA, the first such contribution by the private sector arm of the World Bank Group. The Board of Executive Directors approves a new health, nutrition, and population strategy. A P P E N D I X C Presidents of the World Bank Group Eugene Meyer (1875­1959). Term: June 1946 to December 1946. Head of a banking house, Eugene Meyer & Company, and owner of the Washington Post. John J. McCloy (1896­1989). Term: March 1947 to April 1949. A lawyer whose firm was counsel to Chase National Bank. Held positions in the U.S. government, including assistant secretary of war. Resigned from the World Bank to become the U.S. high commissioner to Germany. Eugene Black (1898­1992). Term: July 1949 to December 1962. Investment banker and senior vice president of Chase Manhattan Bank. Had previously been the U.S. executive director to the World Bank and assistant secretary at the U.S. Treasury. Served the longest of any World Bank president. George Woods(1901­1982). Term: January 1963 to March 1968. Investment banker and chair of the First Boston Corporation. Robert S. MCNamara (b. 1916). Term: April 1968 to June 1981. Was previously director and president of the Ford Motor Company and served as secretary of defense in the Kennedy and Johnson administrations. A. W. Clausen (b. 1923). Term: July 1981 to June 1986. Held positions at the Bank of America and Bank America Corporation before and after his World Bank tenure. These positions included president, chief executive officer, and chair. Barber B. Conable (1922­2003). Term: July 1986 to August 1991. Member of the U.S. House of Representatives from 1965 to 1985, where his committee mem- berships included the House Ways and Means Committee, the Joint Economic Committee, and the House Budget and Ethics committees. Lewis T. Preston (1926­1995). Term: September 1991 to May 1995. Held positions at J. P. Morgan & Company, including president, board chair, chief executive officer, and chair of the Executive Committee. James D. Wolfensohn (b. 1933). Term: June 1995 to May 2005. Established his career as an international investment banker with a parallel involvement in devel- opment issues and the global environment. Served as special envoy for Gaza dis- engagement for the Quartet on the Middle East from May 2005 through April 2006. Currently holds the position of senior adviser to Citigroup. Paul D. Wolfowitz (b. 1943). Term: June 2005 to June 2007. Held a number of significant posts within the U.S. government. 203 A P P E N D I X D Country Membership in World Bank Group Institutions Once a country has joined the IMF, it may apply for membership in IBRD. Upon admission, each country makes a capital contribution to IBRD. Only countries belonging to IBRD may apply for membership in the other Bank Group institu- tions. More information on regions and countries is available in chapter 3, includ- ing specific ways that IFC regions differ from those used by IBRD and IDA. 205 Table D.1 Country Memberships and Voting Shares in Each Institution as of April 2007 ICSID IBRD (founded 1945) IDA (founded 1960) IFC (founded 1956) MIGA (founded 1988) (founded Share Share Share Share 1966) IBRD/IDA Year of Year of Year of Year of Year Country region joined Votes total joined Votes total joined Votes total joined Votes total joined Afghanistan SA 1955 550 0.03 1961 16,857 0.10 1957 361 0.02 2003 376 0.17 1968 Albania ECA 1991 1,080 0.07 1991 36,599 0.22 1991 1,552 0.06 1991 360 0.16 1991 Algeria MENA 1963 9,502 0.59 1963 27,720 0.17 1990 5,871 0.24 1996 1,402 0.64 1996 Angola AFR 1989 2,926 0.18 1989 57,909 0.35 1989 1,731 0.07 1989 445 0.20 nm Antigua and Barbuda LAC 1983 770 0.05 nm nm nm 1987 263 0.01 2005 308 0.14 nm Argentina LAC 1956 18,161 1.12 1962 134,439 0.81 1959 38,379 1.59 1992 2,468 1.13 1994 Armenia ECA 1992 1,389 0.09 1993 15,132 0.09 1995 1,242 0.05 1995 338 0.15 1992 Australia n.a. 1947 24,714 1.53 1960 211,357 1.27 1956 47,579 1.97 1999 3,277 1.50 1991 Austria n.a. 1948 11,313 0.70 1961 120,425 0.72 1956 19,991 0.83 1997 1,624 0.74 1971 Azerbaijan ECA 1992 1,896 0.12 1995 7,860 0.05 1995 2,617 0.11 1992 373 0.17 1992 Bahamas, The LAC 1973 1,321 0.08 nm nm nm 1986 585 0.02 1994 434 0.20 1995 Bahrain n.a. 1972 1,353 0.08 nm nm nm 1995 1,996 0.08 1988 394 0.18 1996 Bangladesh SA 1972 5,104 0.32 1972 100,314 0.60 1976 9,287 0.39 1988 857 0.39 1980 Barbados LAC 1974 1,198 0.07 1999 39,219 0.24 1980 611 0.03 1988 378 0.17 1983 Belarus ECA 1992 3,573 0.22 nm nm nm 1992 5,412 0.22 1992 491 0.22 1992 Belgium n.a. 1945 29,233 1.81 1964 191,827 1.15 1956 50,860 2.11 1992 3,835 1.76 1970 Belize LAC 1982 836 0.05 1982 13,784 0.08 1982 351 0.01 1992 346 0.16 nm Benin AFR 1963 1,118 0.07 1963 23,105 0.14 1987 369 0.02 1994 366 0.17 1966 Bhutan SA 1981 729 0.05 1981 34,663 0.21 2003 970 0.04 nm nm nm nm Bolivia LAC 1945 2,035 0.13 1961 51,788 0.31 1956 2,152 0.09 1991 478 0.22 1995 Bosnia and Herzegovina ECA 1993 799 0.05 1993 38,077 0.23 1993 870 0.04 1993 338 0.15 1997 Botswana AFR 1968 865 0.05 1968 32,495 0.19 1979 363 0.02 1990 346 0.16 1970 Brazil LAC 1946 33,537 2.07 1963 282,228 1.69 1956 39,729 1.65 1993 2,864 1.31 nm Brunei Darussalam n.a. 1995 2,623 0.16 nm nm nm nm nm nm nm nm nm 2002 Bulgaria ECA 1990 5,465 0.34 nm nm nm 1991 5,117 0.21 1992 901 0.41 2001 Burkina Faso AFR 1963 1,118 0.07 1963 41,732 0.25 1975 1,086 0.05 1988 319 0.15 1966 Burundi AFR 1963 966 0.06 1963 36,060 0.22 1979 350 0.01 1998 332 0.15 1969 Cambodia EAP 1970 464 0.03 1970 22,642 0.14 1997 589 0.02 1999 422 0.19 2005 Cameroon AFR 1963 1,777 0.11 1964 34,991 0.21 1974 1,135 0.05 1988 365 0.17 1967 Canada n.a. 1945 45,045 2.78 1960 462,791 2.78 1956 81,592 3.39 1988 5,483 2.51 nm Cape Verde AFR 1978 758 0.05 1978 8,320 0.05 1990 265 0.01 1993 308 0.14 nm Central African Republic AFR 1963 1,112 0.07 1963 23,029 0.14 1991 369 0.02 2000 318 0.15 1966 Chad AFR 1963 1,112 0.07 1963 16,890 0.10 1998 1,614 0.07 2002 318 0.15 1966 Chile LAC 1945 7,181 0.44 1960 31,782 0.19 1957 11,960 0.50 1988 1,113 0.51 1991 China EAP 1945 45,049 2.78 1960 332,400 1.99 1969 24,750 1.03 1988 5,788 2.65 1993 Colombia LAC 1946 6,602 0.41 1961 77,701 0.47 1956 12,856 0.53 1995 1,028 0.47 1997 Comoros AFR 1976 532 0.03 1977 13,141 0.08 1992 264 0.01 nm nm nm 1978 Congo, Dem. Rep. of AFR 1963 2,893 0.18 1963 56,767 0.34 1970 2,409 0.10 1989 854 0.39 1970 Congo, Rep. of AFR 1963 1,177 0.07 1963 38,923 0.23 1980 381 0.02 1991 373 0.17 1966 Costa Rica LAC 1946 483 0.03 1961 12,480 0.07 1956 1,202 0.05 1994 464 0.21 1993 Côte d'Ivoire AFR 1963 2,766 0.17 1963 46,863 0.28 1963 3,794 0.16 1988 568 0.26 1966 (continued) Table D.1 continued ICSID IBRD (founded 1945) IDA (founded 1960) IFC (founded 1956) MIGA (founded 1988) (founded Share Share Share Share 1966) IBRD/IDA Year of Year of Year of Year of Year Country region joined Votes total joined Votes total joined Votes total joined Votes total joined Croatia ECA 1993 2,543 0.16 1993 59,878 0.36 1993 3,132 0.13 1993 588 0.27 1998 Cyprus n.a. 1961 1,711 0.11 1962 48,466 0.29 1962 2,389 0.10 1988 441 0.20 1966 Czech Republic ECA 1993 6,558 0.40 1993 79,859 0.48 1993 9,163 0.38 1993 1,042 0.48 1993 Denmark n.a. 1946 13,701 0.85 1960 169,299 1.02 1956 18,804 0.78 1988 1,523 0.70 1968 Djibouti MENA 1980 809 0.05 1980 6,441 0.04 1980 271 0.01 2007 308 0.14 nm Dominica LAC 1980 754 0.05 1980 26,014 0.16 1980 292 0.01 1991 308 0.14 nm Dominican Republic LAC 1961 2,342 0.14 1962 27,780 0.17 1961 1,437 0.06 1997 405 0.19 nm Ecuador LAC 1945 3,021 0.19 1961 47,252 0.28 1956 2,411 0.10 1988 579 0.27 1986 Egypt, Arab Rep. of MENA 1945 7,358 0.45 1960 79,574 0.48 1956 12,610 0.52 1988 1,067 0.49 1972 El Salvador LAC 1946 391 0.02 1962 6,244 0.04 1956 279 0.01 1991 380 0.17 1984 Equatorial Guinea AFR 1970 965 0.06 1972 6,167 0.04 1992 293 0.01 1994 308 0.14 nm Eritrea AFR 1994 843 0.05 1994 31,162 0.19 1995 1,185 0.05 1996 308 0.14 nm Estonia ECA 1992 1,173 0.07 nm nm nm 1993 1,684 0.07 1992 373 0.17 1992 Ethiopia AFR 1945 1,228 0.08 1961 39,529 0.24 1956 377 0.02 1991 381 0.17 nm Fiji EAP 1971 1,237 0.08 1972 19,462 0.12 1979 537 0.02 1990 329 0.15 1977 Finland n.a. 1948 8,810 0.54 1960 102,458 0.61 1956 15,947 0.66 1988 1,315 0.60 1969 France n.a. 1945 69,647 4.30 1960 687,398 4.12 1956 121,265 5.03 1989 8,823 4.04 1967 Gabon AFR 1963 1,237 0.08 1963 2,093 0.01 1970 1,518 0.06 2003 427 0.20 1966 Gambia, The AFR 1967 793 0.05 1967 19,444 0.12 1983 344 0.01 1992 308 0.14 1975 Georgia ECA 1992 1,834 0.11 1993 41,519 0.25 1995 1,211 0.05 1992 369 0.17 1992 Germany n.a. 1952 72,649 4.49 1960 1,076,549 6.46 1956 129,158 5.36 1988 9,194 4.21 1969 Ghana AFR 1957 1,775 0.11 1960 66,391 0.40 1958 5,321 0.22 1988 690 0.32 1966 Greece n.a. 1945 1,934 0.12 1962 45,962 0.28 1957 7,148 0.30 1993 751 0.34 1969 Grenada LAC 1975 781 0.05 1975 20,627 0.12 1975 324 0.01 1988 308 0.14 1991 Guatemala LAC 1945 2,251 0.14 1961 37,397 0.22 1956 1,334 0.06 1996 398 0.18 2003 Guinea AFR 1963 1,542 0.10 1969 33,987 0.20 1982 589 0.02 1995 349 0.16 1968 Guinea-Bissau AFR 1977 790 0.05 1977 6,790 0.04 1977 268 0.01 2006 308 0.14 nm Guyana LAC 1966 1,308 0.08 1967 23,460 0.14 1967 1,642 0.07 1989 342 0.16 1969 Haiti LAC 1953 1,317 0.08 1961 24,871 0.15 1956 1,072 0.04 1996 333 0.15 nm Honduras LAC 1945 891 0.06 1960 43,282 0.26 1956 745 0.03 1992 436 0.20 1989 Hungary ECA 1982 8,300 0.51 1985 124,659 0.75 1985 11,182 0.46 1988 1,252 0.57 1987 Iceland n.a. 1945 1,508 0.09 1961 42,791 0.26 1956 292 0.01 1998 348 0.16 1966 India SA 1945 45,045 2.78 1960 488,525 2.93 1956 81,592 3.39 1994 5,629 2.58 nm Indonesia EAP 1967 15,231 0.94 1968 130,075 0.78 1968 28,789 1.19 1988 2,107 0.96 1968 Iran, Islamic Rep. of MENA 1945 23,936 1.48 1960 15,455 0.09 1956 1,694 0.07 2003 1,917 0.88 nm Iraq MENA 1945 3,058 0.19 1960 15,669 0.09 1956 397 0.02 nm nm nm nm Ireland n.a. 1957 5,521 0.34 1960 60,966 0.37 1958 1,540 0.06 1989 908 0.42 1981 Israel n.a. 1954 5,000 0.31 1960 60,421 0.36 1956 2,385 0.10 1992 1,093 0.50 1983 Italy n.a. 1947 45,045 2.78 1960 432,716 2.60 1956 81,592 3.39 1988 5,228 2.39 1971 Jamaica LAC 1963 2,828 0.17 nm nm nm 1964 4,532 0.19 1988 577 0.26 1966 Japan n.a. 1952 127,250 7.86 1960 1,676,530 10.06 1956 141,424 5.87 1988 9,237 4.23 1967 Jordan MENA 1952 1,638 0.10 1960 24,865 0.15 1956 1,191 0.05 1988 429 0.20 1972 Kazakhstan ECA 1992 3,235 0.20 1992 4,106 0.02 1993 4,887 0.20 1993 626 0.29 2000 Kenya AFR 1964 2,711 0.17 1964 58,781 0.35 1964 4,291 0.18 1988 561 0.26 1967 Kiribati EAP 1986 715 0.04 1986 11,777 0.07 1986 262 0.01 nm nm nm nm (continued) Table D.1 continued ICSID IBRD (founded 1945) IDA (founded 1960) IFC (founded 1956) MIGA (founded 1988) (founded Share Share Share Share 1966) IBRD/IDA Year of Year of Year of Year of Year Country region joined Votes total joined Votes total joined Votes total joined Votes total joined Korea, Rep. of EAP 1955 16,067 0.99 1961 107,096 0.64 1964 16,196 0.67 1988 1,049 0.48 1967 Kuwait MENA 1962 13,530 0.84 1962 90,524 0.54 1962 10,197 0.42 1988 1,897 0.87 1979 Kyrgyz Republic ECA 1992 1,357 0.08 1992 8,751 0.05 1993 1,970 0.08 1993 335 0.15 nm Lao PDR EAP 1961 428 0.03 1963 22,867 0.14 1992 528 0.02 2000 318 0.15 nm Latvia ECA 1992 1,634 0.10 1992 40,225 0.24 1993 2,400 0.10 1998 429 0.20 1997 Lebanon MENA 1947 590 0.04 1962 8,562 0.05 1956 385 0.02 1994 508 0.23 2003 Lesotho AFR 1968 913 0.06 1968 38,272 0.23 1972 321 0.01 1988 346 0.16 1969 Liberia AFR 1962 713 0.04 1962 22,467 0.13 1962 333 0.01 2007 342 0.16 1970 Libya AFR 1958 8,090 0.50 1961 17,478 0.10 1958 305 0.01 1993 807 0.37 nm Lithuania ECA 1992 1,757 0.11 nm nm nm 1993 2,591 0.11 1993 445 0.20 1992 Luxembourg n.a. 1945 1,902 0.12 1964 47,099 0.28 1956 2,389 0.10 1991 462 0.21 1970 Macedonia, FYR ECA 1993 677 0.04 1993 34,011 0.20 1993 786 0.03 1993 346 0.16 1998 Madagascar AFR 1963 1,672 0.10 1963 44,794 0.27 1963 682 0.03 1988 434 0.20 1966 Malawi AFR 1965 1,344 0.08 1965 44,374 0.27 1965 2,072 0.09 1988 335 0.15 1966 Malaysia EAP 1958 8,494 0.52 1960 68,189 0.41 1958 15,472 0.64 1991 1,278 0.59 1966 Maldives SA 1978 719 0.04 1978 40,284 0.24 1983 266 0.01 2005 308 0.14 nm Mali AFR 1963 1,412 0.09 1963 35,336 0.21 1978 701 0.03 1992 401 0.18 1978 Malta MENA 1983 1,324 0.08 nm nm nm 2005 1,865 0.08 1990 390 0.18 2003 Marshall Islands EAP 1992 719 0.04 1993 4,902 0.03 1992 913 0.04 nm nm nm nm Mauritania AFR 1963 1,150 0.07 1963 35,623 0.21 1967 464 0.02 1992 369 0.17 1966 Mauritius AFR 1968 1,492 0.09 1968 49,657 0.30 1968 1,915 0.08 1990 411 0.19 1969 Mexico LAC 1945 19,054 1.18 1961 102,666 0.62 1956 27,839 1.16 nm nm nm nm Micronesia, Federated States of EAP 1993 729 0.05 1993 18,424 0.11 1993 994 0.04 1993 308 0.14 1993 Moldova ECA 1992 1,618 0.10 1994 612 0.00 1995 1,110 0.05 1993 354 0.16 nm Mongolia ECA 1991 716 0.04 1991 24,389 0.15 1991 394 0.02 1999 316 0.14 1991 Montenegro ECA 2007 938 0.06 2007 44,271 0.27 2007 1,285 0.05 2007 319 0.15 nm Morocco MENA 1958 5,223 0.32 1960 79,602 0.48 1962 9,287 0.39 1992 871 0.40 1967 Mozambique AFR 1984 1,180 0.07 1984 19,523 0.12 1984 572 0.02 1994 429 0.20 1995 Myanmar EAP 1952 2,734 0.17 1962 55,655 0.33 1956 916 0.04 nm nm nm nm Namibia AFR 1990 1,773 0.11 nm nm nm 1990 654 0.03 1990 365 0.17 nm Nepal SA 1961 1,218 0.08 1963 41,409 0.25 1966 1,072 0.04 1994 380 0.17 1969 Netherlands n.a. 1945 35,753 2.21 1961 346,481 2.08 1956 56,381 2.34 1988 4,080 1.87 1966 New Zealand n.a. 1961 7,486 0.46 1974 51,753 0.31 1961 3,833 0.16 nm nm nm 1980 Nicaragua LAC 1946 858 0.05 1960 43,282 0.26 1956 965 0.04 1992 438 0.20 1995 Niger AFR 1963 1,102 0.07 1963 19,302 0.12 1980 397 0.02 nm nm nm 1966 Nigeria AFR 1961 12,905 0.80 1961 74,183 0.45 1961 21,893 0.91 1988 1,745 0.80 1966 Norway n.a. 1945 10,232 0.63 1960 172,928 1.04 1956 17,849 0.74 1989 1,490 0.68 1967 Oman MENA 1971 1,811 0.11 1973 37,068 0.22 1973 1,437 0.06 1989 424 0.19 1995 Pakistan SA 1950 9,589 0.59 1960 156,805 0.94 1956 19,630 0.81 1988 1,421 0.65 1966 Palau EAP 1997 266 0.02 1997 3,804 0.02 1997 275 0.01 1997 308 0.14 nm Panama LAC 1946 635 0.04 1961 10,185 0.06 1956 1,257 0.05 1997 489 0.22 1996 Papua New Guinea EAP 1975 1,544 0.10 1975 45,445 0.27 1975 1,397 0.06 1991 354 0.16 1978 Paraguay LAC 1945 1,479 0.09 1961 20,258 0.12 1956 686 0.03 1992 399 0.18 1983 Peru LAC 1945 5,581 0.34 1961 29,494 0.18 1956 7,148 0.30 1991 915 0.42 1983 (continued) Table D.1 continued ICSID IBRD (founded 1945) IDA (founded 1960) IFC (founded 1956) MIGA (founded 1988) (founded Share Share Share Share 1966) IBRD/IDA Year of Year of Year of Year of Year Country region joined Votes total joined Votes total joined Votes total joined Votes total joined Philippines EAP 1945 7,094 0.44 1960 16,583 0.10 1957 12,856 0.53 1994 742 0.34 1989 Poland ECA 1986 11,158 0.69 1988 361,284 2.17 1987 7,486 0.31 1990 1,022 0.47 nm Portugal n.a. 1961 5,710 0.35 1992 48,714 0.29 1966 8,574 0.36 1988 931 0.43 1984 Qatar MENA 1972 1,346 0.08 nm nm nm nm nm nm 1996 499 0.23 nm Romania ECA 1972 4,261 0.26 nm nm nm 1990 2,911 0.12 1992 1,236 0.57 1975 Russian Federation ECA 1992 45,045 2.78 1992 51,361 0.31 1993 81,592 3.39 1992 5,786 2.65 nm Rwanda AFR 1963 1,296 0.08 1963 23,612 0.14 1975 556 0.02 2002 390 0.18 1979 Samoa EAP 1974 781 0.05 1974 21,741 0.13 1974 285 0.01 1988 308 0.14 1978 San Marino n.a. 2000 845 0.05 nm nm nm nm nm nm nm nm nm nm São Tomé and Principe AFR 1977 745 0.05 1977 9,714 0.06 nm nm nm nm nm nm nm Saudi Arabia MENA 1957 45,045 2.78 1960 556,643 3.34 1962 30,312 1.26 1988 5,786 2.65 1980 Senegal AFR 1962 2,322 0.14 1962 50,925 0.31 1962 2,549 0.11 1988 514 0.24 1967 Serbia ECA 1993 3,096 0.19 1993 52,017 0.31 1993 2,053 0.09 1993 665 0.30 nm Seychelles AFR 1980 513 0.03 nm nm nm 1981 277 0.01 1992 308 0.14 1978 Sierra Leone AFR 1962 968 0.06 1962 38,112 0.23 1962 473 0.02 1996 390 0.18 1966 Singapore n.a. 1966 570 0.04 2002 11,000 0.07 1968 427 0.02 1998 530 0.24 1968 Slovak Republic ECA 1993 3,466 0.21 1993 53,523 0.32 1993 4,707 0.20 1993 649 0.30 1994 Slovenia ECA 1993 1,511 0.09 1993 40,878 0.25 1993 1,835 0.08 1993 438 0.20 1994 Solomon Islands EAP 1978 763 0.05 1980 518 0.00 1980 287 0.01 2005 308 0.14 1981 Somalia AFR 1962 802 0.05 1962 10,506 0.06 1962 333 0.01 nm nm nm 1968 South Africa AFR 1945 13,712 0.85 1960 50,798 0.30 1957 16,198 0.67 1994 1,920 0.88 nm Spain n.a. 1958 28,247 1.74 1960 122,219 0.73 1960 37,276 1.55 1988 2,523 1.16 1994 Sri Lanka SA 1950 4,067 0.25 1961 72,188 0.43 1956 7,385 0.31 1988 736 0.34 1967 St. Kitts and Nevis LAC 1984 525 0.03 1987 13,778 0.08 1996 888 0.04 1999 308 0.14 1995 St. Lucia LAC 1980 802 0.05 1982 30,531 0.18 1982 324 0.01 1988 346 0.16 1984 St. Vincent and the Grenadines LAC 1982 528 0.03 1982 34,787 0.21 nm nm nm 1990 346 0.16 2003 Sudan AFR 1957 1,100 0.07 1960 25,784 0.15 1960 361 0.02 1991 464 0.21 1973 Suriname LAC 1978 662 0.04 nm nm nm nm nm nm 2003 340 0.16 nm Swaziland AFR 1969 690 0.04 1969 19,022 0.11 1969 934 0.04 1990 316 0.14 1971 Sweden n.a. 1951 15,224 0.94 1960 328,687 1.97 1956 27,126 1.13 1988 2,107 0.96 1967 Switzerland n.a. 1992 26,856 1.66 1992 182,197 1.09 1992 41,830 1.74 1988 2,901 1.33 1968 Syrian Arab Rep. MENA 1947 2,452 0.15 1962 10,351 0.06 1962 444 0.02 2002 554 0.25 2006 Tajikistan ECA 1993 1,310 0.08 1993 20,568 0.12 1994 1,462 0.06 2002 388 0.18 nm Tanzania AFR 1962 1,545 0.10 1962 53,758 0.32 1962 1,253 0.05 1992 506 0.23 1992 Thailand EAP 1949 6,599 0.41 1960 75,798 0.45 1956 11,191 0.46 2000 1,000 0.46 nm Timor-Leste EAP 2002 767 0.05 2002 558 0.00 2004 1,027 0.04 2002 308 0.14 2002 Togo AFR 1962 1,355 0.08 1962 23,243 0.14 1962 1,058 0.04 1988 335 0.15 1967 Tonga EAP 1985 744 0.05 1985 26,061 0.16 1985 284 0.01 nm nm nm 1990 Trinidad and Tobago LAC 1963 2,914 0.18 1972 14,309 0.09 1971 4,362 0.18 1992 616 0.28 1967 Tunisia MENA 1958 969 0.06 1960 2,793 0.02 1962 3,816 0.16 1988 533 0.24 1966 Turkey ECA 1947 8,578 0.53 1960 107,538 0.65 1956 14,795 0.61 1988 1,072 0.49 1989 Turkmenistan ECA 1992 776 0.05 nm nm nm 1997 1,060 0.04 1993 324 0.15 1992 (continued) Table D.1 continued ICSID IBRD (founded 1945) IDA (founded 1960) IFC (founded 1956) MIGA (founded 1988) (founded Share Share Share Share 1966) IBRD/IDA Year of Year of Year of Year of Year Country region joined Votes total joined Votes total joined Votes total joined Votes total joined Uganda AFR 1963 867 0.05 1963 48,099 0.29 1963 985 0.04 1992 491 0.22 1966 Ukraine ECA 1992 11,158 0.69 2004 1,762 0.01 1993 9,755 0.40 1994 1,604 0.73 2000 United Arab Emirates MENA 1972 2,635 0.16 1981 1,367 0.01 1977 4,283 0.18 1993 914 0.42 1982 United Kingdom n.a. 1945 69,647 4.30 1960 858,061 5.15 1956 121,265 5.03 1988 8,823 4.04 1967 United States n.a. 1945 265,219 16.38 1960 2,158,302 12.95 1956 569,629 23.64 1988 32,822 15.03 1966 Uruguay LAC 1946 3,062 0.19 nm nm nm 1968 3,819 0.16 1993 460 0.21 2000 Uzbekistan ECA 1992 2,743 0.17 1992 746 0.00 1993 4,123 0.17 1993 433 0.20 1995 Vanuatu EAP 1981 836 0.05 1981 13,821 0.08 1981 305 0.01 1988 308 0.14 nm Venezuela, R.B. de LAC 1946 20,611 1.27 nm nm nm 1956 27,838 1.16 1994 1,685 0.77 1995 Vietnam EAP 1956 1,218 0.08 1960 19,203 0.12 1967 696 0.03 1994 646 0.30 nm Yemen, Republic of MENA 1969 2,462 0.15 1970 49,574 0.30 1970 965 0.04 1996 413 0.19 2004 Zambia AFR 1965 3,060 0.19 1965 60,030 0.36 1965 1,536 0.06 1988 576 0.26 1970 Zimbabwe AFR 1980 3,575 0.22 1980 20,957 0.13 1980 2,370 0.10 1992 494 0.23 1994 TOTALS 185 1,619,599 100 166 16,671,072 100 179 2,409,852 100 171 218,384 100 143 Source: World Bank Group Corporate Secretariat. Note: Totals may not add to 100 because of rounding. Also, 0.00 signifies less than 0.005 percent. AFR = Africa, EAP = East Asia and Pacific, ECA = Europe and Central Asia, LAC = Latin America and the Caribbean, MENA = Middle East and North Africa, SA = South Asia, n.a. = high-income country that does not currently borrow or receive financing from the World Bank or IFC (these countries are not necessarily classified as Part I relative to IDA), nm = nonmember. A P P E N D I X E Constituencies of the Executive Directors IBRD's general operations are delegated to the Board of Executive Directors. Under IBRD's Articles of Agreement, the five member countries holding the largest number of shares each appoint one executive director, and the remaining member countries elect the other executive directors. At present, IBRD's Board consists of 24 executive directors. Of these, five were appointed by the largest shareholders-- the United States, Japan, Germany, France, and the United Kingdom (figure E.1) and 19 were elected by other country constituencies. (See chapter 1 for more information.) Under the Articles of Agreement for IDA and IFC, respectively, the executive directors of IBRD serve ex officio on IDA's Board of Executive Directors and on IFC's Board of Directors. Members of MIGA's Board of Directors are elected separately, but it is customary for the directors of MIGA to be the same individ- uals as the executive directors of IBRD. (See chapter 1 for more information.) Regular elections of executive directors are held every two years, normally at the time of the Annual Meetings. Elections are coordinated by the Bank Group's Cor- porate Secretariat, which anticipates changes in constituency groupings resulting from new memberships or political events, as well as increases in members' capital subscriptions and the corresponding changes in voting power. The Corporate Sec- retariat also verifies the credentials of governors who are entitled to vote. In the event that an executive director elected during the regular election terminates his or her service before the next regular election, the constituency affected by the vacancy holds an interim election for a successor. The interim election is conducted either by mail vote or during an Annual Meetings session that does not fall on a regular election year. 215 216 A Guide to the World Bank Figure E.1 Voting Power of the Largest Shareholders of IBRD as of April 2007 16.41% United States 7.87% Japan 4.49% Germany Others 62.62% 4.31% France 4.31% United Kingdom Table E.1 Voting Shares of Executive Directors of IBRD as of April 2007 Nationality of Number Percentage of executive director Constituency of votes total votes Appointed directors 1 United States United States 265,219 16.41 2 Japan Japan 127,250 7.87 3 Germany Germany 72,649 4.49 4 France France 69,647 4.31 5 United Kingdom United Kingdom 69,647 4.31 Elected directors 6 Belgium, casting Austria, Belarus, Belgium, Czech 77,669 4.81 the votes of Republic, Hungary, Kazakhstan, Luxembourg, Slovak Republic, Slovenia, and Turkey 7 Mexico, casting Costa Rica, El Salvador, Guatemala, 72,786 4.50 the votes of Honduras, Mexico, Nicaragua, Spain, and República Bolivariana de Venezuela 8 Netherlands, Armenia, Bosnia and Herzegovina, 72,208 4.47 casting the Bulgaria, Croatia, Cyprus, Georgia, votes of Israel, former Yugoslav Republic of Macedonia, Moldova, Netherlands, Romania, and Ukraine Constituencies of the Executive Directors 217 Table E.1 continued Nationality of Number Percentage of executive director Constituency of votes total votes Elected directors continued 9 Canada, casting Antigua and Barbuda, The Bahamas, 62,217 3.85 the votes of Barbados, Belize, Canada, Dominica, Grenada, Guyana, Ireland, Jamaica, St. Kitts and Nevis, St. Lucia, and St. Vincent and the Grenadines 10 Brazil, casting Brazil, Colombia, Dominican Repub- 57,462 3.56 the votes of lic, Ecuador, Haiti, Panama, Philip- pines, and Trinidad and Tobago 11 Italy, casting the Albania, Greece, Italy, Malta, Portu- 56,705 3.51 votes of gal, San Marino, and Timor-Leste 12 Republic of Australia, Cambodia, Kiribati, 55,800 3.45 Korea, casting Republic of Korea, Marshall Islands, the votes of Federated States of Micronesia, Mongolia, New Zealand, Palau, Papua New Guinea, Samoa, Solomon Islands, and Vanuatu 13 India, casting Bangladesh, Bhutan, India, and 54,945 3.40 the votes of Sri Lanka 14 Ethiopia, casting Angola, Botswana, Burundi, Ethiopia, 54,347 3.36 the votes of The Gambia, Kenya, Lesotho, Liberia, Malawi, Mozambique, Namibia, Nige- ria, Seychelles, Sierra Leone, South Africa, Sudan, Swaziland, Tanzania, Uganda, Zambia, and Zimbabwe 15 Norway, casting Denmark, Estonia, Finland, Iceland, 54,039 3.34 the votes of Latvia, Lithuania, Norway, and Sweden 16 Pakistan, casting Afghanistan, Algeria, Ghana, Islamic 51,544 3.19 the votes of Republic of Iran, Morocco, Pakistan, and Tunisia 17 Switzerland, Azerbaijan, Kyrgyz Republic, Poland, 49,192 3.04 casting the Serbia, Switzerland, Tajikistan, Turk- votes of menistan, and Uzbekistan 18 Kuwait, casting Bahrain, Arab Republic of Egypt, 47,042 2.91 the votes of Iraq, Jordan, Kuwait, Lebanon, Libya, Maldives, Oman, Qatar, Syrian Arab Republic, United Arab Emirates, and Republic of Yemen (continued) 218 A Guide to the World Bank Table E.1 continued Nationality of Number Percentage of executive director Constituency of votes total votes Elected directors continued 19 China, casting China 45,049 2.79 the votes of 20 Saudi Arabia, Saudi Arabia 45,045 2.79 casting the votes of 21 Russian Federa- Russian Federation 45,045 2.79 tion, casting the votes of 22 Malaysia, cast- Brunei Darussalam, Fiji, Indonesia, 41,096 2.54 ing the votes of Lao People's Democratic Republic, Malaysia, Myanmar, Nepal, Singa- pore, Thailand, Tonga, and Vietnam 23 Argentina, Argentina, Bolivia, Chile, Paraguay, 37,499 2.32 casting the Peru, and Uruguay votes of 24 Mauritius, cast- Benin, Burkina Faso, Cameroon, Cape 32,252 2.00 ing the votes of Verde, Central African Republic, Chad, Comoros, Democratic Republic of Congo, Republic of Congo, Côte d'Ivoire, Djibouti, Equatorial Guinea, Gabon, Guinea, Guinea-Bissau, Mada- gascar, Mali, Mauritania, Mauritius, Niger, Rwanda, São Tomé and Principe, Senegal, and Togo 1,616,354 100.00 Source: World Bank Group Corporate Secretariat. Note: Individual percentages may not total 100 because of rounding. Eritrea, Montenegro, Somalia, and Suriname did not participate in the 2006 regular election of executive directors. Constituencies of the Executive Directors 219 Figure E.2 Voting Power of the Largest Shareholders of IDA as of April 2007 13.01% United States 10.11% Japan 6.49% Germany Others 61.05% 5.17% France 4.14% United Kingdom Table E.2 Voting Shares of Executive Directors of IDA as of April 2007 Nationality of Number Percentage of executive director Constituency of votes total votes Appointed directors 1 United States United States 2,158,302 13.01 2 Japan Japan 1,676,530 10.11 3 Germany Germany 1,076,549 6.49 4 United Kingdom United Kingdom 858,061 5.17 5 France France 687,398 4.14 Elected directors 6 Norway, casting Denmark, Finland, Iceland, Latvia, 856,388 5.16 the votes of Norway, and Sweden 7 Belgium, casting Austria, Belgium, Czech Republic, 769,914 4.64 the votes of Hungary, Kazakhstan, Luxembourg, Slovak Republic, Slovenia, and Turkey 8 Ethiopia, casting Angola, Botswana, Burundi, Ethiopia, 759,597 4.58 the votes of The Gambia, Kenya, Lesotho, Liberia, Malawi, Mozambique, Nigeria, Sierra Leone, South Africa, Sudan, Swazi- land, Tanzania, Uganda, Zambia, and Zimbabwe (continued) 220 A Guide to the World Bank Table E.2 continued Nationality of Number Percentage of executive director Constituency of votes total votes Elected directors continued 9 Canada, casting Barbados, Belize, Canada, Dominica, 725,957 4.38 the votes of Grenada, Guyana, Ireland, St. Kitts and Nevis, St. Lucia, and St. Vincent and the Grenadines 10 India, casting Bangladesh, Bhutan, India, and Sri 695,690 4.19 the votes of Lanka 11 Mauritius, cast- Benin, Burkina Faso, Cameroon, Cape 651,445 3.93 ing the votes of Verde, Central African Republic, Chad, Comoros, Democratic Republic of Congo, Republic of Congo, Côte d'Ivoire, Djibouti, Equatorial Guinea, Gabon, Guinea, Guinea-Bissau, Mada- gascar, Mali, Mauritania, Mauritius, Niger, Rwanda, São Tomé and Principe, Senegal, and Togo 12 Netherlands, Armenia, Bosnia and Herzegovina, 11,646,359 3.90 casting the Croatia, Cyprus, Georgia, Israel, for- votes of mer Yugoslav Republic of Macedonia, Moldova, Netherlands, and Ukraine 13 Switzerland, Azerbaijan, Kyrgyz Republic, Poland, 633,423 3.82 casting the Serbia, Switzerland, Tajikistan, and votes of Uzbekistan 14 Italy, casting the Albania, Greece, Italy, Portugal, and 564,549 3.40 votes of Timor-Leste 15 Saudi Arabia, Saudi Arabia 556,643 3.36 casting the votes of 16 Republic of Australia, Cambodia, Kiribati, Repub- 537,669 3.24 Korea, casting lic of Korea, Marshall Islands, Feder- the votes of ated States of Micronesia, Mongolia, New Zealand, Palau, Papua New Guinea, Samoa, Solomon Islands, and Vanuatu 17 Brazil, casting Brazil, Colombia, Dominican Repub- 500,909 3.02 the votes of lic, Ecuador, Haiti, Panama, Philip- pines, and Trinidad and Tobago Constituencies of the Executive Directors 221 Table E.2 continued Nationality of Number Percentage of executive director Constituency of votes total votes Elected directors continued 18 Malaysia, cast- Fiji, Indonesia, Lao People's Demo- 469,719 2.83 ing the votes of cratic Republic, Malaysia, Myanmar, Nepal, Singapore, Thailand, Tonga, and Vietnam 19 Kuwait, casting Arab Republic of Egypt, Iraq, Jordan, 375,316 2.26 the votes of Kuwait, Lebanon, Libya, Maldives, Oman, Syrian Arab Republic, United Arab Emirates, and Republic of Yemen 20 Mexico, casting Costa Rica, El Salvador, Guatemala, 367,570 2.22 the votes of Honduras, Mexico, Nicaragua, and Spain 21 Pakistan, casting Afghanistan, Algeria, Ghana, Islamic 365,623 2.20 the votes of Republic of Iran, Morocco, Pakistan, and Tunisia 22 China, casting China 332,400 2.00 the votes of 23 Argentina, cast- Argentina, Bolivia, Chile, Paraguay, 267,761 1.61 ing the votes of and Peru 24 Russian Federa- Russian Federation 51,361 0.31 tion, casting the votes of 16,585,133 100.00 Source: World Bank Group Corporate Secretariat. Note: Individual percentages may not total 100 because of rounding. Eritrea, Montenegro, and Somalia did not participate in the 2006 regular election of executive directors. 222 A Guide to the World Bank Figure E.3 Voting Power of the Largest Shareholders of IFC as of April 2007 23.67% United States Others 55.02% 5.88% Japan 5.37% Germany 5.04% France 5.04% United Kingdom Table E.3 Voting Shares of Directors of IFC as of April 2007 Nationality of Number Percentage of executive director Constituency of votes total votes Appointed directors 1 United States United States 569,629 23.67 2 Japan Japan 141,424 5.88 3 Germany Germany 129,158 5.37 4 France France 121,265 5.04 5 United Kingdom United Kingdom 121,265 5.04 Elected directors 6 Belgium, casting Austria, Belarus, Belgium, Czech 125,221 5.20 the votes of Republic, Hungary, Kazakhstan, Luxembourg, Slovak Republic, Slovenia, and Turkey 7 Italy, casting the Albania, Greece, Italy, Malta, 101,758 4.23 votes of Portugal, and Timor-Leste 8 India, casting Bangladesh, Bhutan, India, and 99,234 4.12 the votes of Sri Lanka 9 Mexico, casting Costa Rica, El Salvador, Guatemala, 97,478 4.05 the votes of Honduras, Mexico, Nicaragua, Spain, and República Bolivariana de Venezuela Constituencies of the Executive Directors 223 Table E.3 continued Nationality of Number Percentage of executive director Constituency of votes total votes Elected directors continued 10 Canada, casting Antigua and Barbuda, The Bahamas, 92,944 3.86 the votes of Barbados, Belize, Canada, Dominica, Grenada, Guyana, Ireland, Jamaica, St. Kitts and Nevis, and St. Lucia 11 Netherlands, Armenia, Bosnia and Herzegovina, 87,289 3.63 casting the votes Bulgaria, Croatia, Cyprus, Georgia, of Israel, former Yugoslav Republic of Macedonia, Moldova, Netherlands, Romania, and Ukraine 12 Norway, casting Denmark, Estonia, Finland, Iceland, 86,693 3.60 the votes of Latvia, Lithuania, Norway, and Sweden 13 Russian Federa- Russian Federation 81,592 3.39 tion, casting the votes of 14 Brazil, casting Brazil, Colombia, Dominican Repub- 75,980 3.16 the votes of lic, Ecuador, Haiti, Panama, Philip- pines, and Trinidad and Tobago 15 Republic of Australia, Cambodia, Kiribati, Repub- 73,309 3.05 Korea, casting lic of Korea, Marshall Islands, Feder- the votes of ated States of Micronesia, Mongolia, New Zealand, Palau, Papua New Guinea, Samoa, Solomon Islands, and Vanuatu 16 Argentina, cast- Argentina, Bolivia, Chile, Paraguay, 64,144 2.66 ing the votes of Peru, and Uruguay 17 Switzerland, Azerbaijan, Kyrgyz Republic, Poland, 62,601 2.60 casting the Serbia, Switzerland, Tajikistan, Turk- votes of menistan, and Uzbekistan 18 Malaysia, cast- Fiji, Indonesia, Lao People's Demo- 59,912 2.49 ing the votes of cratic Republic, Malaysia, Myanmar, Nepal, Singapore, Thailand, Tonga, and Vietnam (continued) 224 A Guide to the World Bank Table E.3 continued Nationality of Number Percentage of executive director Constituency of votes total votes Elected directors continued 19 Ethiopia, casting Angola, Botswana, Burundi, Ethiopia, 57,688 2.40 the votes of The Gambia, Kenya, Lesotho, Liberia, Malawi, Mozambique, Namibia, Nige- ria, Seychelles, Sierra Leone, South Africa, Sudan, Swaziland, Tanzania, Uganda, Zambia, and Zimbabwe 20 Pakistan, casting Afghanistan, Algeria, Ghana, Islamic 45,980 1.91 the votes of Republic of Iran, Morocco, Pakistan, and Tunisia 21 Kuwait, casting Bahrain, Arab Republic of Egypt, Iraq, 34,476 1.43 the votes of Jordan, Kuwait, Lebanon, Libya, Mal- dives, Oman, Syrian Arab Republic, United Arab Emirates, and Republic of Yemen 22 Saudi Arabia, Saudi Arabia 30,312 1.26 casting the votes of 23 China, casting China 24,750 1.03 the votes of 24 Mauritius, cast- Benin, Burkina Faso, Cameroon, Cape 22,947 0.95 ing the votes of Verde, Central African Republic, Chad, Comoros, Democratic Republic of Congo, Republic of Congo, Côte d'Ivoire, Djibouti, Equatorial Guinea, Gabon, Guinea, Guinea-Bissau, Mada- gascar, Mali, Mauritania, Mauritius, Niger, Rwanda, Senegal, and Togo 2,407,049 100.00 Source: World Bank Group Corporate Secretariat. Note: Individual percentages may not total 100 because of rounding. Eritrea, Montenegro, and Somalia did not participate in the 2006 regular election of executive directors. Constituencies of the Executive Directors 225 Figure E.4 Voting Power of the Largest Shareholders of MIGA as of April 2007 15.14% United States 4.26% Japan 4.24% Germany 4.07% France Others 65.55% 4.07% United Kingdom 2.67% China Table E.4 Voting Shares of Directors of MIGA as of April 2007 Nationality of Number Percentage of executive director Constituency of votes total votes Directors elected by 6 largest shareholders 1 United States United States 32,822 15.14 2 Japan Japan 9,237 4.26 3 Germany Germany 9,194 4.24 4 France France 8,823 4.07 5 United Kingdom United Kingdom 8,823 4.07 6 China China 5,788 2.67 Directors elected by other shareholders 7 Netherlands, Armenia, Bosnia and Herzegovina, 11,688 5.39 casting the votes Bulgaria, Croatia, Cyprus, Georgia, of Israel, former Yugoslav Republic of Macedonia, Moldova, Netherlands, Romania, and Ukraine 8 Belgium, casting Austria, Belarus, Belgium, Czech 11,491 5.30 the votes of Republic, Hungary, Kazakhstan, Luxembourg, Slovak Republic, Slovenia, and Turkey (continued) 226 A Guide to the World Bank Table E.4 continued Nationality of Number Percentage of executive director Constituency of votes total votes Directors elected by other shareholders continued 9 Ethiopia, casting Angola, Botswana, Burundi, Ethiopia, 11,058 5.10 the votes of The Gambia, Kenya, Lesotho, Malawi, Mozambique, Namibia, Nigeria, Sey- chelles, Sierra Leone, South Africa, Sudan, Swaziland, Tanzania, Uganda, Zambia, and Zimbabwe 10 Canada, casting Antigua and Barbuda, The Bahamas, 10,392 4.79 the votes of Barbados, Belize, Canada, Dominica, Grenada, Guyana, Ireland, Jamaica, St. Kitts and Nevis, St. Lucia, and St. Vincent and the Grenadines 11 Kuwait, casting Bahrain, Arab Republic of Egypt, 8,214 3.79 the votes of Jordan, Kuwait, Lebanon, Libya, Maldives, Oman, Qatar, Syrian Arab Republic, United Arab Emirates, and Republic of Yemen 12 Mauritius, cast- Benin, Burkina Faso, Cameroon, Cape 8,035 3.71 ing the votes of Verde, Central African Republic, Chad, Democratic Republic of Congo, Republic of Congo, Côte d'Ivoire, Equatorial Guinea, Gabon, Guinea, Guinea-Bissau, Madagascar, Mali, Mauritania, Mauritius, Rwanda, Senegal, and Togo 13 Norway, casting Denmark, Estonia, Finland, Iceland, 8,030 3.70 the votes of Latvia, Lithuania, Norway, and Sweden 14 Italy, casting the Albania, Greece, Italy, Malta, Portu- 7,968 3.68 votes of gal, and Timor-Leste 15 India, casting Bangladesh, India, and Sri Lanka 7,222 3.33 the votes of 16 Pakistan, casting Afghanistan, Algeria, Ghana, Islamic 7,210 3.33 the votes of Republic of Iran, Morocco, Pakistan, and Tunisia Constituencies of the Executive Directors 227 Table E.4 continued Nationality of Number Percentage of executive director Constituency of votes total votes Directors elected by other shareholders continued 17 Brazil, casting Brazil, Colombia, Dominican Repub- 7,056 3.26 the votes of lic, Ecuador, Haiti, Panama, Philip- pines, and Trinidad and Tobago 18 Republic of Australia, Cambodia, Republic of 6,958 3.21 Korea, casting Korea, Federated States of Micronesia, the votes of Mongolia, Palau, Papua New Guinea, Samoa, Solomon Islands, and Vanuatu 19 Malaysia, cast- Fiji, Indonesia, Lao People's Demo- 6,588 3.04 ing the votes of cratic Republic, Malaysia, Nepal, Singapore, Thailand, and Vietnam 20 Switzerland, Azerbaijan, Kyrgyz Republic, Poland, 6,441 2.97 casting the Serbia, Switzerland, Tajikistan, Turk- votes of menistan, and Uzbekistan 21 Mexico, casting Costa Rica, El Salvador, Guatemala, 6,324 2.92 the votes of Honduras, Nicaragua, Spain, and República Bolivariana de Venezuela 22 Argentina, cast- Argentina, Bolivia, Chile, Paraguay, 5,833 2.69 ing the votes of Peru, and Uruguay 23 Saudi Arabia, Saudi Arabia 5,786 2.67 casting the votes of 24 Russian Federa- Russian Federation 5,786 2.67 tion, casting the votes of 216,767 100.00 Source: World Bank Group Corporate Secretariat. Note: Individual percentages may not total 100 because of rounding. Djibouti, Eritrea, Liberia, Montene- gro, and Suriname did not participate in the 2006 regular election of directors. A P P E N D I X F Additional Country Resources World Bank and IFC regional Web sites serve as portals to country-specific Web sites or pages (box F.1). Those country-specific Web pages typically provide a brief summary of activities and issues in the country, with links to specific projects, eco- nomic data and statistics, publications, Web sites of the country's government, and related news. Additionally, the following resources are available: Bank Group Offices. For links to country office Web sites, go to http://www. worldbank.org/ and select the "Countries" tab. Public Information Centers (PICs). These centers disseminate information on the Bank Group's work. They are hosted in either the World Bank offices or in exter- nal organizations who work closely with the Bank. Most PICs have project doc- uments and publications specific to the country in which the office is located and will generally have access to World Bank online databases. PIC Europe in Paris and PIC Tokyo offer the complete range of Bank operational documents for all member countries and maintain libraries of recent World Bank publications. For more information go to http://www.worldbank.org/reference/ and select "Pub- lic Information Centers" in the "Finding Publications" box. World Bank Depository and Regional Libraries. Each depository library is enti- tled to a free copy of each formal publication of the Bank Group. A deposi- tory library must make its collection of Bank Group publications available to the public. Each regional library has a similar arrangement but receives only major publications and formal publications that are related to its World Bank region. Go to http://www.worldbank.org/reference/ and select "Worldwide Depository Libraries" in the "Finding Publications" box. Distributors of World Bank Group Publications. The Bank Group encourages cus- tomers outside the United States to order through local distributors. For a list of distributors go to http://www.worldbank.org/reference/ and select "Book Distibutors" in the "Finding Publications" box. The Bank Group also sells direct to all member countries. 229 230 A Guide to the World Bank Publication Discount. Bank Group publications are sold at discounts of 35 percent or 75 percent off the list price to customers in many developing countries, depending on the country's income level. These discounts are assessed biennially on the basis of new economic data. See http://publica- tions.worldbank.org/discounts. Box F.1 Regional Web Sites Sub-Saharan Africa World Bank vice presidency: http://www.worldbank.org/afr IFC regional department: http://www.ifc.org/africa East Asia and the Pacific World Bank vice presidency: http://www.worldbank.org/eap IFC regional department: http://www.ifc.org/eastasia South Asia World Bank vice presidency: http://www.worldbank.org/sar IFC regional department: http://www.ifc.org/southasia Europe and Central Asia World Bank vice presidency: http://www.worldbank.org/eca IFC regional department: http://www.ifc.org/europe Latin America and the Caribbean World Bank vice presidency: http://www.worldbank.org/lac IFC regional department: http://www.ifc.org/lac Middle East and North Africa World Bank vice presidency: http://www.worldbank.org/mena IFC regional department: http://www.ifc.org/mena Western Europe World Bank EuropeExternal Affairs: http://www.worldbank.org/europe References IFC (International Finance Corporation). 2006. IFC Annual Report 2006. Washington, DC: IFC. MIGA (Multilateral Investment Guarantee Agency). 2006. 2006 Annual Report. Washing- ton, DC. MIGA. United Nations. 2000. Millennium Declaration, A/RES/55/2, New York: United Nations. ------. 2001. Road Map towards the Implementation of the United Nations Millennium Declaration, Report of the Secretary General, New York: United Nations. World Bank. 2006. World Bank Annual Report 2006. Washington, DC: World Bank. 231 Index Boxes, figures, and tables are indicated by "b," "f," and "t." A IFC trust funds, 72 integrity reports, 40 accounting reform and institutional strength- portfolio performance, 80 ening, 125 Web site availability, 81b, 82 Administrative and Client Support Network, arbitration, 26, 75 36 archives, 58 advisory services articles of agreement, 7, 215 education, 151 Asia. See East Asia and the Pacific; Europe and financial sector, 158 Central Asia; South Asia foreign investment, 161, 172, 176, 178 Asia Alternative Energy Program, 113 health and population, 164 Asia Development Forum, 113­14 IFC, 23, 73, 169, 183 Asian Development Bank, 85, 113 nutrition, 165 audit. See evaluation PREM, 148, 160, 162, 175 social protection, 171 World Bank, 72­73 B Africa. See Middle East and North Africa; Sub-Saharan Africa Bangladesh, 117, 119 Africa Action Plan, 104, 107 Bank-Fund Staff Federal Credit Union, 41 Africa Capacity Development Operational Bank Group Task Force, 107 governance of, 3, 7­10 African Development Bank Group, 85 institutions comprising, 1, 2b, 11­26. See African Development Fund, 98 also specific institutions (e.g., IBRD, Agribusiness Department (IFC), 140 IDA) agriculture and rural development, 35, legal documents on Web site, 172 140­41 relationship with IMF, 41­42 aid effectiveness, 141­42 Annual Meetings, 42­43 AIDS. See HIV/AIDS Development Committee, 41­42, 98 air quality, 120, 131 differences, 41 analytic services, 72­73 relationship with UN, 43 Annual Bank Conference on Development role of, 1­4 Economics, 74­75 Bank Internship Program, 88­89 Annual Meetings, 8, 26, 41, 42­43 Bank Procedures, 55 annual reports bilateral development agencies, 85 availability of, 194 Black Sea and Danube Basin Initiative, 125 financial, 61 "blend" borrowers, 13, 15t, 19, 96 233 234 Index "B-loan" program, 71 concessional finance and global partnerships, boards of directors, 8­9 37 boards of governors, 7­8 conciliation and arbitration, 26, 75 Annual Meetings, 42­43 conferences, forums, and summits, 41, 74­75 Development Committee and, 42 conflict-affected countries, investment in, 23 borrower countries, 96 conflict prevention and reconstruction, See also developing countries 144­45 Brazilian rain forest, 132 arbitration, 26, 75 Bretton Woods Institutions, 41 Conflict Resolution System, 38 consultants, 89­90 Consultive Group on International Agricul- C ture Research, 85, 141 Canada, 19 Consultive Group to Assist the Poor, 85­86, Can Africa Claim the 21st Century?, 105 158 capacity development, 73­74 contact information, 191­94 carbon trading, 131 controllers, strategy, and resource manage- Caribbean. See Latin America and the ment, 37 Caribbean Convention on the Settlement of Investment Disputes, 26 Caribbean Development Bank, 85 Cooperative Underwriting Program, 24b CASs. See Country Assistance Strategies Corporate Finance, 38 Central American Bank for Economic Integra- Corporate Governance Group (joint tion, 85 IFC­World Bank), 161­62 Central Asia. See Europe and Central Asia corporate reporting standards, 125 Chad-Cameroon Pipeline Project, 107 Corporate Secretariat, 36­37, 94, 215 chief financial officer, 38 corporate social responsibility, 176 childhood illness and malnutrition, 119, 131 corruption and fraud child labor, 119­20, 171 combating, 143­44 China, 111 investigations of, 39­40, 58, 144 Cities Alliance, 114, 184 reporting of, 59b, 144 civil society organizations. See nongovernmen- Country Assistance Strategies (CASs), 54, 58, tal organizations (NGOs) 76­78, 100, 123 classification of member countries, 95­96 country offices, 27, 34 donors and borrowers, 96 Web sites for, 229 by income, 95­96 Country Policy and Institutional Assessment part I and part II, 96 scores, 58 classification of proposed projects, 56 Credit Risk, 38 Clean Air Initiative for Latin American Cities, Credit Union, Bank-Fund Staff Federal, 41 131 cofinancing, 69 D CommNet, 36, 37 Commonwealth Secretariat/World Bank Joint Danube Basin, 125 Task Force on Small States, 100 data and information, 75, 167­68 communications, 37, 167­68 See also publications Compliance Advisor/Ombudsman, 39 Doing Business Project, 177 compliance monitoring, 57 projects database, 75, 80­82, 81b, 84, Comprehensive Development Framework, 52 193­94 Index 235 public access to, 193­94 World Bank in, 110­11 Web site availability, 81b, 82, 147 Economic and Social Council, 43 databases. See data and information economics Debt Department, 146 chief economist, 37 debt relief, 98, 145­47 development economics, 37, 74 depository libraries. See libraries research, 72, 147­49 developing countries, 95, 96 education, 149­52 Bank Group objectives and, xv, 1­4 gender disparities in, 159 as donor countries, 60, 96 IFC sector, 35­36, 150­51 investments between, 23­24 initiatives, 86, 99 Development Committee, 41­42 Education Advisory Service, 151 annual meetings, 42­43 Education for All, 86, 149 Development Data Group, 147b Fast-Track Initiative, 99 development economics. See economics Education for the Knowledge Economy, 150 Development Gateway, 86, 168 effectiveness of aid. See aid effectiveness Development Grant Facility, 69 elections of executive directors, 215 Development Partnership for Africa, 104 e-library to Bank's documents, 75, 194 development policy lending, 68 "Empowering People by Transforming Insti- development topics, 139­86 tutions: Social Development in World See also specific topics Bank Operations," 179 disclosure policy, 57­58 empowerment and participation, 152­53 See also data and information Empowerment Sourcebook, 152 diseases. See specific diseases endangered species, 131 dispute arbitration. See arbitration; conflict energy and mining, 131, 153­55 prevention and reconstruction Web site, 169 distance learning, 40 Energy Help Desk, 154 diversity of Bank staff, 88 environment, 155­57 documents available. See information; publica- See also sustainable development tions; Web sites air quality, 120, 131 Doing Business Project, 148, 172, 176, 177 Brazilian rain forest, 132 Donor Committee for Enterprise Develop- endangered species, 131 ment, 177 forest law enforcement, 125 donor countries and IDA, 17, 18­19t, 60, 96 mineral resources and, 131 environmental and social safeguard policies, E 56 environmental assessments, 56, 78 Early Child Development, 150 Environment and Social Development East African Development Bank, 85 Department (IFC), 155­56 East Asia and the Pacific, 110­14 Environment Department (World Bank), 155 economic and social background, 110­11 ethical issues, 38 funding to, 112f See also corruption and fraud IFC in, 113 corporate social responsibility, 176 initiatives in, 113­14 EU. See European Union key facts, 111b European Bank for Reconstruction and Devel- MIGA in, 101, 113 opment, 85 publications on, 114 European Commission, 85 236 Index Europe and Central Asia, 121­26 IBRD voting power of, 216f See also specific countries IDA voting power of, 219f economic and social background, 122­23 IFC voting power of, 222f funding to, 124f MIGA voting power of, 225f IFC in, 123 fraud. See corruption and fraud initiatives in, 125 frontier markets, 23 key facts, 122b funding and lending, 59­61 MIGA in, 123 See also products and services; specific publications on, 126 country/region World Bank in, 122­23 "B-loan" program, 71 European Union (EU), 84, 122, 125 cofinancing, 69 evaluation development policy lending, 68 IFC project appraisal and evaluation, 83­84 grants, 68­69 independent audit of Bank projects, 58 guarantees, 70 Independent Evaluation Group, 10, 39, 80 IBRD, 13, 16, 60­61 Events Calendar, 76 breakdown, 2006, 50f executive directors, 8­9 cumulative, 2006, 62­66t constituencies of, 215­27 ICSID, 61 executive vice presidents, 10 IDA, 17, 19, 60­61 External Affairs, 37 breakdown, 2006, 50f Extractive Industries Review, 154 cumulative, 2006, 62­66t IFC, 20­21, 61, 70­72 IMF, 41­42 F information on, 82 Fast-Track Initiative compact, 99 investment lending, 67­68 feedback service, 193 lending instruments, 66­68 fellowship programs, 89 MIGA, 61 fiduciary policies, 58 private sector development, 70­72 Financial and Private Sector Development rates and terms, 67b Network, 35 reporting, 61 Financial and Private Sector Development risk management, 70 Vice Presidency (World Bank), 148, trust funds, 69, 71­72, 85 157­68, 176 financial management, 59­61, 157­59 G See also funding and lending World Bank, 37­38 GAVI Alliance (formerly Global Alliance for financial reporting, 61 Vaccines and Immunization), 86 Financial Sector Advisory Service, 158 Gender and Development Group, 159 forced labor, 171 gender disparities, 159­60 foreign direct investment, xv, 22, 23, 24, 74, Gender Entrepreneurship Markets Program 115, 131, 161, 169 (IFC), 159 Foreign Investment Advisory Service, 161, general services, 38 172, 176, 178 Germany, 19, 215 forest law enforcement, 125 IBRD voting power of, 216f founding documents. See articles of agreement IDA voting power of, 219f fragile states and LICUS initiative, 98­99 IFC voting power of, 222f France, 19, 215 MIGA voting power of, 225f Index 237 Global Business School Network, 151 health systems development Web site, 164 Global Development Learning Network, Heavily Indebted Poor Countries initiative 73­74, 131, 168 (HIPC), 52, 69, 98, 146 Global Environment Facility, 69, 86, 154, hedging products, 70 156 high-income countries, 95 Global Financial Markets (IFC), 35, 158 HIPC. See Heavily Indebted Poor Countries Global Fund to Fight AIDS, Tuberculosis, initiative and Malaria, 69 history of World Bank, 41, 43 Global Information and Communication chronological list of presidents, 203 Technologies, 36, 167, 169 timeline, 195­201 globalization, 160­61 HIV/AIDS Global Manufacturing and Services (IFC), 35, Africa, 108, 165 173­74 Europe and Central Asia, 123 Global Monitoring Report, 48­49 IFC Against AIDS program, 163 Global Partnership for Eliminating River Joint UN Programme on HIV/AIDS, 164 Blindness, 107, 164 Multi-Country HIV/AIDS Prevention and Global Strategy and Malaria Booster Program, Control Lending Program for the 164 Caribbean, 132 Global Telemedicine and Teaching Network, Multi-Country HIV/AIDS Program, 108, 131 165 Global Trade Finance Program, 105, 182 in South Asia, 119 Good Practice Note: HIV/AIDS in the Work- Web site, 164 place (IFC), 163 hotline for reporting fraud or corruption, 59b, Good Practices, 55 144 Governance and Anticorruption Strategy for human capital, improvement and protection the World Bank Group, 143 of, 170 Governance in the Middle East and North Human Development Network, 35, 163, Africa Initiative, 136 170­71 governance of client countries, 143, 161 human resources, 38­39 governance of corporations, 161­62 See also staff governance of World Bank, 7­10 grants, 68­69 I Group of Eight (G-8) Gleneagles Summit (2005), 98, 104 IBRD. See International Bank for Recon- guarantees for loans, 24, 70, 72 struction and Development ICSID. See International Centre for the H Settlement of Investment Disputes IDA. See International Development headquarters (Washington, D.C.), 9, 190 Association Health and Education Department (IFC), IFC. See International Finance Corporation 151, 163 illiteracy, 116 health and nutrition, 35, 163­66 IMF. See International Monetary Fund See also specific diseases immunizations, 86, 119, 165 Global Telemedicine and Teaching Net- Independent Evaluation Group, 10, 39, 80, work, 131 141­42 Health and Population Advisory Service, 164 Independent Evaluation Group Help Desk, Health, Nutrition, and Population unit, 163 142 238 Index India, 19, 116­17, 119 International Bank for Reconstruction and Indigenous Knowledge Program, 167 Development (IBRD), 12­16 indigenous peoples, 78, 166­67 See also World Bank Indonesia, 19 basic facts, 13b industrial countries, 95, 96 Board of Executive Directors, 8 Industries Vice Presidency (IFC), 176 contact information, 191 InfoCity: Connecting Cities to Global Knowl- funding and lending, 13, 16, 60­61 edge and Resources, 114 breakdown, 2006, 50f information. See annual reports; data and countries eligible for borrowing from, 13, information; publications 14­15t Information Solutions Group, 39 cumulative, 2006, 61, 62­66t Information Solutions Network, 36 hedging products, 70 InfoShop, 82 lending by region, 2006, 101f. See also infrastructure, 23, 168­70 specific regions See also energy and mining rates and terms, 67b IFC sector, 36, 169, 183 graduates, 96, 97b initiatives headquarters and staff, 11 Africa (Sub-Saharan), 107­9 history of, 12 Black Sea and Danube Basin, 125 media resources, 192 East Asia and the Pacific, 113­14 membership, 7, 94, 96, 205 Europe and Central Asia, 125 objectives of, 11, 12­13 Heavily Indebted Poor Countries (HIPC), procurement of goods and services by, 89 52, 69, 98, 146 risk management, 70 Landfill Gas-to-Energy Initiative for Latin voting power, 9, 9f, 216f, 216­18t American Cities, 131 International Centre for the Settlement of Latin America and the Caribbean, 131 Investment Disputes (ICSID), 25­26 Low-Income Countries under Stress Administrative Council of, 10, 26 (LICUS), 98­99 basic facts, 25b Middle East and North Africa, 136­37 conciliation and arbitration facilities, 26, 75 middle-income, 99­100 contact information, 191 Multilateral Debt Relief Initiative (MDRI), funding and lending, 61 98, 146 governance of, 8 small states, 100 history of, 26 South Asia, 117­19 information, disclosure, and evaluation, South Caucasus regional initiative, 125 81b South East Europe Social Development, media resources, 192 125 membership of, 7, 94 Inspection Panel, 10, 39, 80 policies and procedures, 58 Institutional Integrity Department, 39­40, secretary-general, 10 144 types of services, 26 institutional partnerships, 84­85 Web site, 25b institutions, 1, 2b, 11­26 International Development Association See also specific institutions (e.g., IBRD, IDA) (IDA), 17­20 Inter-American Development Bank, 85 See also World Bank Interest Bearing Notes Newsletter, 159 basic facts, 17b interest-free loans, 60 Board of Executive Directors, 8 Index 239 contact information, 191 Gender Entrepreneurship Markets funding and lending, 17, 19, 60­61 Program, 159 breakdown, 2006, 50f Global Financial Markets Department, 158 countries eligible for borrowing from, Global Manufacturing and Services, 35, 15­16t, 19 173­74 cumulative, 2006, 61, 62­66t Health and Education Department, 151, cumulative subscriptions and contribu- 163 tions, 17, 18­19t indigenous peoples, policy on, 167 lending by region, 2006, 101f. See also Industries Vice Presidency, 176 specific regions information, disclosure, and evaluation of rates and terms, 67b projects, 81b, 84 graduates, 19­20 infrastructure, 36, 169 headquarters and staff, 11 legal commitment to projects, 83 history of, 17 legal services, 40 IDA14, 19 media resources, 192 interest-free loans from, 60 membership, 94, 97 media resources, 192 organization structure diagram, 30­31f membership, 17, 94 regions, 34 Multilateral Debt Relief Initiative (MDRI), sectors, 25­26 98, 146 policies and procedures, 58 objectives of, 11­12, 17, 52 poverty reduction projects, 174­75 procurement of goods and services by, 89 Private Equity and Investment Funds voting power, 219f, 219­21t Department, 158 Web site, 17b private sector development, 176­77 International Finance Corporation (IFC), project cycle, 82­84 20­23 public notification of projects, 83 advisory services, 23, 73, 169, 183 resource mobilization, 22, 71, 83 Agribusiness Department, 140 social protection policies, 171 application for financing, 83 Strategic Directions Paper, 54 assessment of corporate governance, 162 supervision of projects, 83­84 basic facts, 20b sustainable development, 180­81 Board of Directors, 8, 83 technical assistance, 23, 73 chief economist, 37 trade enhancement facilities, 182 closing of project, 84 voting power, 222f, 222­24t Compliance Advisor/Ombudsman, 39 water resources, 185­86 contact information, 191 Web site, 20b corporate relations unit, 37, 191 International Monetary and Financial Environment and Social Development Committee, 42­43 Department, 155­56 International Monetary Fund (IMF) funding and lending, 20­21, 61, 70­72 Annual Meetings, 42­43 breakdown, 2006, 51f Development Committee, 41­42 disbursement of funds, 83 differences for World Bank Group, 41 investment projects by region, 2006, history of, 41 102f libraries, 194 project financing, 21­22, 82­84 as membership requirement for IBRD, 94, trust funds, 71­72 95, 205 240 Index International Monetary Fund (IMF) land management, 109 (continued) Latin America and the Caribbean, 127­32 objectives of, 41 economic and social background, 128 Poverty Reduction Growth Facility, 52 funding to, 130f PRSP role, 52 IFC in, 129­31 relationship with World Bank Group, initiatives in, 131 40­43 key facts, 128b international trade Web site, 182 MIGA in, 131 Internet access. See Web sites publications on, 132 internship programs, 88­89 World Bank in, 128­29 investment guarantees, 70 law and justice, 172­73 investment lending, 67­68 Legal and Judicial Reform Practice Group, Islamic Development Bank, 85 172 Italy, 19 Legal Help Desk, 173 legal services, 24, 40, 56, 74 J lending. See funding and lending libraries, 41, 82, 194, 229 Japan, 19, 169, 215 e-library to Bank's documents, 75 IBRD voting power of, 216f PovertyNet Library, 174, 194 IDA voting power of, 219f publications in depository libraries, 75, 229 IFC voting power of, 222f LICUS initiative, 98­99 Joint Japan­World Bank Graduate Scholar- Living Standards Measurement Study, 147b ship Program, 89 logging practices, 125 MIGA voting power of, 225f London Club, 146 job openings, 88 low-income countries, 95, 98­99 Joint Japan­World Bank Graduate Scholar- See also developing countries ship Program, 89 Joint Ministerial Committee of the Boards of HIPC, 98 the Bank and Fund on the Transfer of under stress initiative, 98­99 Real Resources to Developing Countries, Low-Income Countries under Stress (LICUS), 42 98­99 Joint UN Programme on HIV/AIDS, 164 Junior Professional Associates Program, 88 M justice, 172­73 malaria, 108, 164 managing director, 10 K manual, operational. See Operational Manual Knowledge Partnerships for Africa, 108 manufacturing and services, 173­74 knowledge sharing, xv, 72­76, 108, 140, 161, McNamara Fellowships Program, 89 168 MDGs. See Millennium Development Goals Kyoto Protocol, 154 MDRI. See Multilateral Debt Relief Initiative media, 43, 192 Medical Missions for Children, 131 L member countries, 94­102, 205­14 labor and social protection, 170­72 See also developing countries; donor Landfill Gas-to-Energy Initiative for Latin countries American Cities, 131 classification of, 95­96 Index 241 donors and borrowers, 96 water, 185 by income, 95­96 Web site, 49 part I and part II, 96 mining. See energy and mining dispute arbitration between, 26, 75 Mining Help Desk, 154 expelling of, 94 mission statement, xv initiatives for groups of countries Multi-Country HIV/AIDS Prevention and low-income countries under stress initia- Control Lending Program for the tive, 98­99 Caribbean, 132 middle-income, 99­100 Multi-Country HIV/AIDS Program, 108, small states, 100 165 membership requirements Multilateral Debt Relief Initiative (MDRI), IBRD, 94, 205 98, 146 ICSID, 94 multilateral development banks, 85 IDA, 94 Multilateral Investment Guarantee Agency IFC, 94 (MIGA), 23­25 MIGA, 94 basic facts, 24b ownership by, 7 Board of Directors, 8 purchase of shares, 60 capacity development, 74 regional groupings, 100­101 Compliance Advisor/Ombudsman, 39 relationship with Bank Group, 7, 8f contact information, 191 statistics, 94 corporate relations unit, 37 Web sites, 94b East Asia and Pacific, 101 mental health, 164 environmental and disclosure policies, 156 Mesoamerican Biological Corridor, 131 financial management, 38 Middle East and North Africa, 133­37 funding and lending, 24, 61, 72 economic and social background, 133­34 breakdown, 2006, 51f funding to, 135b portfolio distribution by region, 2006, IFC in, 136 102f initiatives in, 136­37 government deterrence, role in, 25 key facts, 134b information, disclosure, and evaluation, MIGA in, 136 81b publications on, 137 Investment Marketing Services Depart- World Bank in, 133­34 ment, 74 Middle East and North Africa Development Latin America and the Caribbean, 131 Forum, 136 legal services, 24, 40, 74 middle-income countries, 95, 99­100 media resources, 192 MIGA. See Multilateral Investment Guarantee membership, 94 Agency classification of, 96 Millennium Development Goals (MDGs), 3, objectives of, 23­24 3b, 12, 46­49, 139 organization structure, 34 Africa, 104 diagram, 32­33f health and nutrition, 163 policies and procedures, 58 list of, 47­48b political risk insurance and, 25, 72 Multilateral Debt Relief Initiative to assist private sector development, 176 poorest countries in achieving, 146 products and services, 24­25 Online Atlas of, 49 sectors, 36 242 Index South Asia, 117 Operations Policy and Country Services, 35, Sub-Saharan Africa, 107 58 voting power, 225f, 225­27t organizing principles, 27­40 Web site, 24b See also institutions Municipal Fund, 184 corporate secretariat, 36­37 development economics, 37 external affairs, 37 N financial management, 37­38 network vice presidencies, 34­36 general services, 38 Nile Basin Initiative, 108 human resources, 38­39 nongovernmental organizations (NGOs), information solutions group, 39 86­87, 152 legal services, 40 North Africa. See Middle East and North networks and regions, 34­36 Africa regional vice presidencies and country nutrition. See health and nutrition offices, 27, 34 Nutrition Advisory Service, 165 structure diagram, 28­29f vice presidential units. See vice presidential units O Oversight Committee, 58 Office of Ethics and Business Conduct, 39 offices, locations of, 37 P headquarters (Washington, D.C.), 9, 190 Pakistan, 117 Oil, Gas, Mining, and Chemicals Depart- Paris Club, 146 ment, 36, 153, 154 Part I countries, 96 Oil, Gas, Mining, and Chemicals Group, 169 See also donor countries Ombudsman, 39 Part II countries, 96 onchocerciasis, 107 See also developing countries Online Atlas of Millennium Development partnerships, 37, 84­87 Goals, 49 See also United Nations (UN) Operational Directives, 55­56 bilateral development agencies (trust Operational Manual, 55­58 funds), 85 compliance monitoring, 57 institutional, 84­85 disclosure of information, 57­58 NGOs, 86­87 fiduciary policies, 58 programmatic, 85­86 policy definitions and documentation, PICs. See Public Information Centers 55­56 Pilot Program to Protect the Brazilian Rain policy formulation and review, 56­57 Forest, 132 safeguard policies, 56, 156 policies and procedures, 55­59 Operational Policies, 55­56 ICSID, 58 operations, 45­90 IFC, 58 See also project cycle MIGA, 58 funding and lending, 59­61 Operational Manual, 55­58 policies and procedures, 35, 55­58 pollution. See environment products and services, 59­72 population and reproductive health Web site, strategies, 46­55 165 Index 243 Post-Conflict Fund, 145 programmatic partnerships, 85­86 PovertyNet Library, 174, 194 Project Appraisal Document, 79 poverty reduction, 174­75 project cycle Consultive Group to Assist the Poor, 85­86 IFC, 82­84 IDA focus on poorest countries, 17 World Bank, 76­82, 77f strategies, 52­54, 76­77 appraisal phase, 78­79 key steps, 53b evaluation and monitoring, 80 Poverty Reduction and Economic Manage- identification phase, 78 ment Network, 35, 159 implementation and supervision phase, 79 Poverty Reduction Growth Facility, 52 information about project, 80­82 Poverty Reduction Strategies Papers (PRSPs), negotiation and approval phase, 79 52­54, 77 preparation phase, 78 PREM Advisory Service, 148, 160, 162, 175 projects database. See data and information PREM Notes, 160 Prototype Carbon Fund, 156 president, 9­10 PRSPs (Poverty Reduction Strategies Papers), chronological list of, 203 52­54 as member of CEB, 43 publications, 75 office of, 40 See also specific country/region Princeton University's Woodrow Wilson agriculture and rural development, 141 School of Public Affairs, 89 aid effectiveness, 142 private education, 150­51 annual reports. See annual reports Private Enterprise Partnership conflict prevention and reconstruction, 145 for Africa, 105 contact information, 76b, 191 in Middle East and North Africa, 136 corruption and fraud issues, 144 in Russia and former Soviet republics, 123 debt relief, 147 Private Equity and Investment Funds Depart- in depository libraries, 75, 229 ment (IFC), 158 discounts for developing country private sector development, 176­79 customers, 230 IFC investment in, 70­72 East Asia and the Pacific, 114 strategy, 55 education, 151­52 Private Sector Development Blog, 178 empowerment and participation, 153 privatization, 169 energy and mining, 154­55 procedures. See policies and procedures environment, 156­57 procurement guidelines and procedures, 38, Europe and Central Asia, 126 58, 89­90, 143 financial sector, 159 products and services, 59­72 gender issues, 160 See also advisory services; funding and globalization, 160­61 lending governance, 162­63 resource mobilization. See resource health and nutrition, 166 mobilization HIPC Initiative, 147 World Bank, 72­73 how to obtain, 76b, 193, 229 analytic and advisory services, 72­73 indigenous peoples, 167 capacity development, 73­74 information and communication conferences and summits, 74­75 technology, 168 knowledge sharing, 72­76 InfoShop, 82 publications, data, and statistics, 75 infrastructure, 170 244 Index publications (continued) economic, 74, 147­49 labor and social protection, 171­72 of civil war and violence, 145 Latin America and the Caribbean, 132 education, 151 law and justice, 173 environment, 156 manufacturing and services, 174 financial sector, 159 Middle East and North Africa, 137 health, 166 poverty, 175 inequality, 153 private sector development, 178­79 international trade, 182 research, 148­49 private sector development, 178 social development, 179­80 social development, 179 South Asia, 120 social protection and labor, 171 Sub-Saharan Africa, 109 urban development, 185 sustainable development, 181 risk management, 25, 38, 70, 72 trade, 182­83 river blindness, 107 transportation, 183­84 Robert S. McNamara Fellowships Program, 89 urban development, 185 Roll Back Malaria, 108 water, 186 rural development. See agriculture and rural World Development Indicators, 96 development public health. See health and nutrition Russian Federation, 9, 122 Public Information Centers (PICs), 37, 82, 193, 229 S public notification of projects, 83 Public Policy for the Private Sector (online St. Petersburg Declaration, 125 journal), 178 scholarships, 88­89 Public-Private Infrastructure Advisory Facility, schools. See education 169, 178 sectors, 34­36 Public Sector Group, 161 lending breakdown, 2006, 50f strategies of, 35, 58 Q types of, 35­36 services. See advisory services; products and Quality Assurance Group, 39, 80, 142 services shareholders. See member countries R Small and Medium Enterprise Department, Rapid Response Web site, 178 177 regional groupings, 100­101 "small states," 100 Web sites for, 230b social development, 179­80 regional integration in Sub-Saharan Africa, Social Protection Advisory Service, 171 108 Social Protection Help Desk, 171 regional vice presidencies, 27, 34 A Sourcebook for Poverty Reduction Strategies, reports. See annual reports; publications 53 reproductive health, 163, 165 South Asia, 115­20 research economic and social background, 115­17 See also knowledge sharing funding to, 118f agricultural and rural development, 141 IFC in, 117 aid effectiveness, 142 initiatives in, 117­19 development indicators, 148 key facts, 116b Index 245 MIGA in, 117 World Bank in, 104­5 publications on, 120 Sub-Saharan Africa Transport Policy Program, World Bank in, 115­17 108 South Asia Enterprise Development Facility, summits, 74­75 117 sustainable development, 35, 153, 180­81 South Asia Urban Air Quality Management, Sustainable Development Network, 35, 140, 120 179, 180 South Caucasus regional initiative, 125 syndicated loans from IFC, 71 South East Europe Social Development Initiative, 125 T South East Europe Trade and Transport Facilitation Program, 125 Task Force on Low-Income Countries under staff Stress (LICUS), 98­99 Bank Group, 11, 87­88 tax liability of Bank staff, 87 directory orders, 191 technical assistance Exchange Program, 38 IFC, 23, 71­72, 73 internships and scholarships, 88­89 MIGA, 24 job openings, 88 WBI, 40 World Bank Group Staff Association, 39 Technical Assistance Trust Funds Program, statistics, 75 71­72 See also data and information technology Web sites, 147b See also Web sites Strategic Directions Paper, 54 communication, 39 Strategic Framework for Assistance to Africa, terminology of the World Bank, 11b 105 income terminology, 96 Strategic Partnership with Africa, 108 small states, 100 strategies of World Bank Group, 46­55 TerrAfrica, 109 CASs. See Country Assistance Strategies timeline history, 195­201 Comprehensive Development Framework, tobacco Web site, 165 52 toolkits for development practitioners, 73 framework and directions, 49 trade, 181­83 IFC, 54­55 Middle East and North Africa, 137 Millennium Development Goals, 46­49. South East Europe Program, 125 See also Millennium Development Trade and Investment Climate program in Goals (MDGs) Middle East and North Africa, 137 poverty reduction, 52­54 training services. See education; World Bank private sector development, 54­55 Institute (WBI) thematic and sector, 49, 50f, 52, 139 transportation, 183­84 Subnational Finance Department, 169 South Caucasus regional initiatives, 125 Sub-Saharan Africa, 103­9 South East Europe Program, 125 funding to, 105, 106f Sub-Saharan Africa Transport Policy IFC in, 105 Program, 108 initiatives in, 107­9 Transport Group, 170 key facts, 104b Transport Help Desk, 183 MIGA in, 107 Treasury, 38 publications on, 109 trust funds, 69, 71­72, 85 246 Index tuberculosis, 119, 165 Water and Urban Sector Board, 185 Turkey, 19, 20 Water Help Desk, 186 Water Supply and Sanitation Group, 170 U WBI. See World Bank Institute Web sites, 81b UN Commission on International Trade Law, country-specific sites, 229 26 data and statistics. See data and information UN Development Group (UNDG), 46 Development Gateway, 86 UN Development Programme, 86, 136 feedback service, 193 unemployment issues in Middle East, 135 IBRD, 13b UN Environment Programme, 86 ICSID, 25b United Kingdom, 19, 169, 215 IDA, 17b IBRD voting power of, 216f IFC, 20b IDA voting power of, 219f IFC voting power of, 222f loans, credits, and grants, 82 MIGA voting power of, 225f MIGA, 24b United Nations (UN) PRSPs, 53 See also heading starting with "UN" regional, 230b MDGs. See Millennium Development West African Development Bank, 85 Goals women and gender disparities, 159­60 relationship to Bank Group, 40­43 Woodrow Wilson School of Public Affairs, 89 United States, 19, 215 World Bank, 11­20 IBRD voting power of, 216f See also specific region, program, or service IDA voting power of, 219f contact information, 191 IFC voting power of, 222f development projects. See specific subjects MIGA voting power of, 225f external affairs, 37 UN System Chief Executives Board for Coor- financial management, 37­38, 61 dination, 43 funding and lending, 61­72 upper-middle-income countries, 95 rates and terms, 67b urban air quality, 120 general services, 38 urban development, 184­85 history of, 41, 43 Urban Development Group, 170 human resources, 38­39 Urban Help Desk, 184 institutions comprising. See International Bank for Reconstruction and Develop- V ment (IBRD); International Develop- ment Association (IDA) vaccines. See immunizations offices, locations of, 37 vendors. See procurement guidelines organization structure, 34 vice presidential units, 27, 34­36 diagram, 28­29f human resources, 38 origin of term "World Bank," 11b legal, 40, 56 products and services, 72­73 voting of member countries, 9, 9f, 205­14, 216­27f project cycle, 76­82, 77f regional vice presidencies, 34 sector boards, 34 W staff, 87­88 water, 185­86 The World Bank Annual Report, 96 See also environment World Bank Economic Review (journal), 148 Index 247 World Bank Group Staff Association, 39 socially sustainable development, 153 World Bank Institute (WBI) social protection and risk management, mission of, 40, 73, 150 171 publications of, 151 sustainable development, 181 specific learning programs urban and local government, 170, 184 corruption control, 143 World Bank Research Observer (journal), 148 financial sector, 159 World Trade Organization (WTO), 84, 181 health and AIDS, 166 poverty and growth, 175 private sector development, 178 Y public-private partnerships, 170 public sector governance, 162 Young Professionals Program, 88 ECO-AUDIT Environmental Benefits Statement The World Bank is committed to preserving Saved: endangered forests and natural resources. The · 45 trees Office of the Publisher has chosen to print A · 2,017 pounds of Guide to the World Bank, second edition, on solid waste recycled paper with 30 percent post-consumer · 16,407 gallons of waste, in accordance with the recommended waste water standards for paper usage set by the Green Press · 3,953 pounds of net Initiative, a nonprofit program supporting greenhouse gases publishers in using fiber that is not sourced from endangered forests. For more information, visit · 31 million BTUs of www.greenpressinitiative.org. total energy A GUIDE TO THE WORLD B ANK S E C O N D E D I T I O N "A wonderful resource..." -- C H O I C E M AG A Z I N E T he World Bank Group is a vital source of financial and technical assistance to developing countries around the world. Its focus is on helping the poorest people in the poorest countries by using its financial resources, staff, and extensive experience to aid countries in reducing poverty, increasing economic growth, and improving quality of life. In partnership with more than 100 developing countries, the Bank Group is striving to improve health and education, fight corruption, boost agricultural support, build roads and ports, and protect the environment. Other projects are aimed at rebuilding war-torn countries or regions, providing basic services such as access to clean water, and encouraging investments that create jobs. In addition to this critical groundwork around the world, various parts of the World Bank Group are involved in activities ranging from conducting economic research and analysis to providing financial and advisory services to governments and private enterprises. These activities reflect the emphasis the institution places on sharing development knowledge, which is gleaned not only from decades of experience but also from that of the Bank Group's 185 members--including both developing and developed countries. This completely revised and updated second edition of A Guide to the World Bank provides an accessible and straightforward overview of the World Bank Group's history, organization, mission, and purpose. Additionally, for those wishing to delve further into subjects of particular interest, the book guides readers to sources containing more detailed information, including annual reports, Web sites, publications, and e-mail addresses for various departments. It also provides information on how to work for or do business with the World Bank. A good introduction for anyone interested in understanding what the World Bank Group does and how it does it, this book shows readers who want to learn more where to begin. ISBN 0-8213-6694-7